Fire Detection Product Catalogue - Issue 7.7

Fire Detection Product Catalogue - Issue 7.7
Fire_Cat_Iss7_Covers:Layout 1 07/09/2010 10:05 Page 1
fire_content_page:Layout 1 14/07/2010 10:34 Page 2
Contents
CONTENTS
CONTENTS
Chapter 1 - Introduction
1.1
Chapter 8 - Fire Phones & Disable Refuge 8.1
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
2.1
• Minerva MZX Addressable Control Panels 2.2
• Minerva MX2 Range
2.4
• Minerva MX1000 & MX4000
2.5
• Battery & Expansion Boxes
2.6
• Minerva MX Repeaters
2.7
• MZX4000 Black Box
2.8
• Minerva T2000 & T2000 CV Marine Detection
Panels
2.9
• Minerva T2000R & T2000R CV Marine
Repeaters
2.10
• MX Panel Components
2.13
• DDA Compliant Pager
2.25
• MX Virtual Multi-Sensor Detectors
2.28
• Beam and Linear Heat Detectors
2.32
• Detector Bases & Accessories
2.35
• Detector Ancillaries
2.39
• Duct Probe Air Sampling
2.41
• MX Addressable Input/Output Modules
2.43
• MX Ancillary Housings
2.47
• Callpoints
2.49
• Sounders & Beacons
2.55
• Software Tools & Accessories
2.69
2.70
• MZX Interactive Training CD
• Programming and Service Tools
2.72
• Service & Spares
2.75
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
• Control Panels and Repeater Panels
• DDA Compliant Pager
• Point Detectors
• Beam Detectors
• Linear Heat Detectors
• Detector Bases and Accessories
• Duct Probes
• Callpoints
• Sounders & Beacons
• Service & Spares
3.1
3.1
3.9
3.11
3.16
3.18
3.19
3.23
3.25
3.32
3.46
Chapter 4 - Networks & Graphics
• Tyco Expert Graphics (TXG)
• MXNet
• MX Minerva - Bridge
4.1
4.1
4.4
4.6
Chapter 5 - Detector Test Equipment
5.1
Chapter 6 - System Accessories
• Batteries, PSU and Chargers
• Door Release Units
• Auxiliary Interface Relays
• Fire Resistant Cable
6.1
6.1
6.3
6.4
6.5
Chapter 7 - VESDA
• LaserFOCUS Aspirating Smoke Detection
• LaserCOMPACT and MX LaserCOMPACT
• LaserPLUS Standard Modular Range
• LaserPLUS Scanners
• ICAM IAS Air Sampling Smoke Detection
• Pipe and Fittings
7.1
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
7.7
7.8
Chapter 9 - Water Leak Detection
9.1
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
10.1
• Special Hazard Flame Detectors
10.3
• System 800 Fire Detection for Hazardous
Areas
10.7
• System 620 Fire Detection for Hazardous
Areas
10.13
• MZX SensorLaser Plus Fibre Optic Linear Heat
Detection System
10.24
Chapter 11 - Useful Information
• MX Addressable Detector, Mode Selection
& Design Charts
• Conventional Detector Selection & Design
Charts
• MKII Sounder Base Application Table
• Sounder Tone Tables
• Consultants Guide
Fire Catalogue
11.1
11.1
11.3
11.4
11.6
11.8
07/10
FIRE_Ch1_Introduction:Layout 1 18/02/2010 10:50 Page 1
Chapter 1 - Introduction
Fire Detection
Welcome to the latest issue of the Tyco Safety Products Fire Detection Catalogue of product available from our Letchworth
U.K. distribution centre. This catalogue is intended to assist all sellers and system designers involved in fire detection from
entry level conventional systems to extensive networked addressable systems and special hazard protection.
In line with our ISO 9000 accreditation, only those products that meet the highest quality criteria have been included.
Our goal is to despatch product on the same day as we receive your order. Our warranty and service returns policy is
second to none. We recognise that your business is highly dependant on excellence in customer service and to help
achieve this we offer extended warranty from many of our suppliers. Full credit is also available on a "No Question - No
Fuss" basis for any new in-warranty product returned to the distribution centre.
New Catalogue Layout
With an emphasis on ease of use, the contents of this Issue has been arranged to meet the specific needs of individual
users. Each section covers a different aspect of fire detection and contains all product associated with that subject. If a
particular product is used for example with both conventional systems and addressable systems, it will appear in both
sections. Each section can therefore be used independently and each section can also be downloaded separately from the
Tyco Safety Products website. The 11 sections covered are;
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
Introduction
Addressable Systems
Conventional Systems
Networks & Graphics
Detector Test Equipment
System Accessories
Aspirating Systems
Fire Phones and Disabled Refuge
Water Leak Detection
Special Hazard
Useful Information
Website
The Tyco Safety Products website is full of up-to-date information including a section dedicated to fire detection products
where you will find lots of useful information including;
Approval Certificates
AutoCAD Downloads
Catalogues
Datasheets
Forums
Marketing Bulletins
Presentations
Technical Information including;
User manuals
Application & Design Manuals
Installation Manuals
Commissioning Manuals
Service Manuals
Sales Information
Software Downloads
Contact Us
For further details on this catalogue, contact our customer telephone Help Line
at Letchworth Customer Services on + 44 (0) 1462 66 77 00.
TFS Technical Support Call Centre:Direct: +31 475 352 722
Fax: +31 475 352 725
Hours: 9:00 to 19:00 CET, 8:00 to 18:00 GMT, 7:00 to 17:00 EET
UK only: 08701-238 787
Toll Free: 0800 CALL TYCO or (0800 22 55 89 26)
E-Mail: TSPEuropeSupport@tycoint.com
Our web site can be found at: www.tycoemea.com
03/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 1 Page 1
FIRE_Ch1_Introduction:Layout 1 18/02/2010 10:50 Page 2
Chapter 1 - Introduction
This page is left intentionally blank.
Chapter 1 Page 2
Fire Catalogue
03/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 1
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
MZX Detection Panels
Tyco MX detection panels use all the features of Tyco MX Technology to provide the latest fire detection technology meeting
the latest worldwide standards in cost-effective, expandable packages.
Tyco MX detection panels support Tyco MX Technology:
•
•
•
•
MX VIRTUAL Multi-sensor detectors
MX DIGITAL high speed reliable digital protocol
MX FASTLOGIC fuzzy logic smoke detection algorithms
MX CCO universal carbon monoxide fire detection
algorithms
Tyco MX detection panels provide modular cost effective
solutions:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Networked panels from 1 to 792 detection loops
Powerful central loop processing functions
Powerful and modular user interface
MX REMOTE diagnostics and service functions
TXG graphical user interfaces
MZX, MX2 and designer housing options
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Menu driven
Multi-level password protected
Viewing 3000 event log
Detailed fault reporting
Isolate by point, zone or sector
Viewing and printing status
Viewing and printing isolated points
Manual and automatic walk test and reporting functions
Viewing and printing maintenance reports
Extensive diagnostic functions including simulation and
force outputs
• Text and configuration changes/Automatic battery test
• Detector service functions
Tyco MX detection panels include very powerful
event/action programming including:
Tyco MX detection panels provide long term fire detection
solutions including upgrade paths from earlier panel
models and a long term develop-ment strategy providing
future upgrade paths.
Tyco MX detection panels include:
• MZX for compact single loop solutions
• MINERVA MX for EN54 LPCB approved systems
• MINERVA T2000 for Marine approved systems
Tyco MX detection panels include a powerful user
interface:
• 640 Character display
• Displays first alarm and most recent alarm
• Permanently displays systems status including number
of alarms, number of faults, number of isolated points
• Scroll function allows details of all events and status to
be easily viewed
• Displays temperature, CO level and smoke level at point
in alarm
• Displays 95 character custom messages for emergency
procedures
09/10
Tyco MX panels include advanced manager and
engineer functions including:
• Seamless network wide event/action
• 240 x 240 Output map and output sequencing
algorithms
• Over 3000 event/action groups for the most complex
applications
• Templates for fast programming of standard applications
including:
- EN54/BS5839
- EN54 Marine
• User defined templates
• Time, date and special day programming
• Wide range of co-incidence, double knock and delay
functions
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 1
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 2
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Supports one or two MXDigital® loops with 125, 250 or
500 addresses (panel dependant)
• 2km loop length
• High level User Interface with “Front Panel Controls” to
reduce lifetime cost of ownership
• Wide range of detectors including the 3oTec triple sensing
detector providing early detection without false alarms.
• Wide range of ancillaries including door control to BS7273
category A
• DDA compliance using AVBase and loop powered
sounder beacons.
• Approved to EN54 the system is designed to be installed
to BS5839 Part 2
Minerva® MZX Addressable Control Panels
This range of digital addressable fire control panels uses
the well established MXDigital® Loop protocol, detectors, i/o
modules, user interface and software from the MX range of
panels. They provide a single box solution ideally suited for
small and medium sized installations up to 32 zones.
The following models are available :MZX125 Single Loop, 125 Addresses, 16 Zones
MZX250 Single Loop, 250 Addresses, 32 Zones
MZX251 Single Loop, 250 Addresses, 32 Zones
MZX252 Two Loop, 500 Addresses, 32 Zones
Repeaters
Two dedicated repeaters are available.
These repeaters offer the user full panel functionality. Up to
7 repeaters can be attached to the control panel’s 2 wire
remote bus, each repeater houses its own mains driven
power supply and batteries.
MZX16R 16 Zones with space for 7Ah or 12Ah batteries
MZX32R 32 Zones with space for 17Ah batteries
The MZX125 housing has space for 2 x 12Ah batteries
The MZX250 housing has space for 2 x 17Ah batteries
The MZX251 & MZX252 housings have space for 2 x 38Ah
batteries
Running the robust MXDigital® loop protocol the panels can
operate using most cable types. This makes them ideal for
upgrades as the existing cables can be utilised reducing
installation time and cost.
All panels are complete with an integral PSU which will
support a full compliment of loop powered sounders and
beacons.
The MZX250, 251 & 252 control panels can be fitted with the
TLI800 network interface module, This enables up to 99
control panels to be seamlessly networked, or to be added
to an existing network of MX Fire controllers.
Product Codes
557.200.501
557.200.502
557.200.503
557.200.506
557.200.520
557.200.521
557.201.502
557.201.501
557.201.503
557.201.504
557.201.307
557.201.505
Chapter 2 Page 2
Fire Catalogue
MZX125 1 loop 16 Zone Fire Controller
MZX250 1 loop 32 Zone Fire Controller
MZX251 1 loop 32 Zone Fire Controller
MZX252 2 loop 32 Zone Fire Controller
MZX16R 16 Zone Repeater (mains
powered)
MZX32R 32 Zone Repeater (mains
powered)
Semi-Flush Bezel for MZX125/MZX16R
Semi-Flush Bezel for
MZX250/251/252/MZX32R
Accessory mounting plate for std
modules, IOB800, LIM800 and TUD800
(MZX250/251/252 only)
Accessory mounting plate for CCU3
(MZX250/251/252 only)
MZX250 17Ah Battery Clamp
MZX251/ 252 38Ah Battery Clamp
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 3
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
MZX Addressable Control Panels
Technical Specifications
MZX125
Dimensions
H x W x D mm
370x325x126
Weight
7kg
Operating Temp
Storage Temp
Humidity
Housing Colour
Facia Colour
EMC/RFI
Supply Voltage
Input Current
0.9A
Charger Size
Note 1
2.5Ah
Max Battery Size 2 x 12V 12Ah
MZX250
MZX251
MZX252
MZX16R
480x410x140
9.7kg
1.6A
480x410x205 480x410x205
370x325x126
10.6kg
10.6kg
6.6kg
-5oC +40oC
-20oC +70oC
90% relative Humidity Non Condensing
RAL7035
Pantone Grey 431C
EN50130-4 & EN61000-6-3
230VAC 50/60 Hz
1.6A
1.6A
0.9A
5.0Ah
2 x 12V 17Ah
5.0Ah
2 x 12V 38Ah
5.0Ah
2 x 12V 38Ah
2.5Ah
2 x 12V 12Ah
MZX32R
40x410x140
9.3kg
0.9A
2.5Ah
2 x 12V 17Ah
Note 1 – Max PSE output current with the charger interrupted (I max b, EN54-4)
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 3
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 4
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Minerva MX2 Range
The Minerva MX2 range of panels are intelligent LPCB
EN54 compliant panels, which can be networked to provide
up to 396 detection loops and installed to BS5839:Pt1
2002.
The MX2 design philosophy is to have a single panel
housing that incorporates all the necessary components
required to satisfy the most comprehensive of
specifications. Additional matching ancillary housings can
accommodate a range of standard modules, adjacent to or
remote from the main controller.
The panel has a removable steel front door, which
incorporates the MX user interface and optional zonal
LED’s. The user interface has a 16 x 40-character backlit
LCD display, simple alphanumeric keypad and 5 softkeys.
All mandatory operator controls are provided with LED
functions including Day/Night switching. One control key
and 2 status indication LEDs are provided for site-specific
functions.
• MX2 panels support two MX DIGITAL detection loops with
up to 250 addressable devices per loop.
• MX2 panels can be expanded to eight loops supporting
up to 1000 addressable devices.
• MX2 consists of a strong steel enclosure incorporating a
removable chassis plate. The chassis plate holds:
• PSU830 5A 24Vdc battery back power supply and loop
booster to EN54:pt.4.
• FIM800 field interface PCB incorporating two MX DIGITAL
loops.
• CPU800 32 bit processor and memory card
• Optional network card and additional loop card(s)
• Optional IOB800 input/output expansion card
Product Codes
557.200.203
557.200.205
557.200.207
557.200.208
557.200.209
557.200.210
557.202.007
557.202.026
557.202.021
557.202.022
557.202.020
557.202.024
557.201.211
MX2-210 Two loop c/w LEDs shallow
housing
MX2-211 Two loop c/w LEDs deep
housing
MX2-XB0 Expansion Box Shallow
MX2-XB1 Expansion Box Deep
MX2-FB Panel/repeater flush mounting
bezel
MX2-FBX Expansion box flush mounting
bezel
XLM800 Loop expansion module
TLI800 MXNet network node
interface module
ANN840 LED Annunciator 40 way
bi-colour
ANN880 LED Annunciator 80 way
COM820 Status command module 20
way
PRN800 In-built thermal printer
(expansion box)
Ancillary/expansion board mounting kit
Chapter 2 Page 4
557.202.206
557.202.204
557.202.205
557.202.209
557.202.208
557.202.200
Fire Catalogue
MX battery expansion aperture
installation kit.
MX2 Battery housing
MX2 Battery and Expansion Housing
(65AH)
MX2 LCD Assembly (Spare)
MX2 8 Loop Expansion Kit
DCM800 (Display + Control Module)
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 5
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Compact
• MX Technology Digital Loop
• LPCB Approved
Minerva MX1000 & MX4000
The MINERVA MX panels are intelligent LPCB EN54
approved panels, which can be networked to provide up to
792 detection loops and installed to BS5839:Pt.1.
• The MX1000 supports one MX DIGITAL detection loop
with up to 250 addressable devices.
• The MX4000 supports two MX DIGITAL detection loops
and can be expanded to eight loops supporting up to
1000 addressable devices.
• The MX1000 and MX4000 each provide up to 240 zones
of detection
Both panels consist of a strong steel enclosure
incorporating a removable chassis plate. The chassis plate
holds:
• PSB800M 5A 24Vdc battery backed power supply and
loop booster to EN54:pt.4
• FIM800 field interface PCB incorporating one or two MX
DIGITAL loops
• CPU800 32 bit processor and memory card
• Optional network card and additional loop card(s)
• Optional IOB800 input/output expansion card
The panel has a strong cast aluminium front door, which
incorporates a modular user interface that fully complies
with EN54:pt.2. The user interface incorporates the
ODM800 operator display module with a 16 x 40-character
backlit LCD display, simple alphanumeric keypad, 5
softkeys. The OCM800 operator control module provides all
mandatory operator control keys and LED functions
including Day/Night switching. Two control keys and 2
indication LEDs are provided for site-specific functions.
Control keys and LEDs are labelled in English according to
the default LPCB functionality. The slide in decals can be
reversed and alternative text added.
A maximum of 1200 digital INPUT/OUTPUT points can be
provided via expansion boards connected to the remote
bus.
Product Codes
Standard Panels
MX1000 Single Loop Panel – Shallow
557.200.001
Back Box
557.200.002
MX1000 Single loop panel - Flush Back
Box
557.200.003
MX4000 Two to Four Loop
Panel – Shallow Back Box
557.200.004
MX4000 Two to Eight Loop Panel – Deep
Back Box
557.200.009
MX4000 Two to Four Loop Panel - Flush
Back Box
Options
557.202.006
IOB800 (8in/8out) expansion board
(Max. 24 I/O on main panel 8in/16out)
557.202.007
XLM-MX two loop MX DIGITAL
expansion card
557.202.026
TLI 800 ThornNet & MX-NET network card
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 5
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 6
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Compact
• Low Cost Option
• Rack Mounting Kit
Battery & Expansion Boxes
The batteries and any additional zone LED’s or operator
controls and fireman’s interface are mounted in a separate
housing which can be mounted below the main panel or
behind the panel. The matching battery and expansion box
is available with shallow (17Ah) or deep backbox (38Ah)
according to the batteries used.
The chassis plate in the battery box also has space for up
to 2 x IOB800 input/output expansion modules (maximum
24 I/O) or 1 x MX FILNET or 1 x PSM/PSB800M.
Product Codes
557.200.005
557.200.019
557.200.006
557.200.016
572.065
Chapter 2 Page 6
Fire Catalogue
MX-BBX 17Ah shallow expansion and
battery box
MX-BBX-F 17Ah shallow flush expansion
and battery box
MX-DPBX 38Ah deep expansion and
battery box.
MX-BATT Deep Battery Box
(322H x 442W x 217D mm)
MX Rack Mounting Kit for standard 19”
racks
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 7
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Fully Functional
• Flush or Surface Mounting
• Fully Monitored
Minerva MX Repeaters
The MINERVA MX full function repeater is an EN54 LPCB
approved repeater with optional addressable EN54:Pt.4
power supply. The repeater consists of a steel backbox and
cast aluminium front door which incorporates the ODM800
operator display module with a 16 x 40-character backlit
LCD display, simple alphanumeric keypad and 5 softkeys.
The OCM800 operator control module provides all
mandatory operator control keys and LED functions
including Day/Night switching. One control key and 2
indication LEDs are provided for site-specific functions.
The back box has a removable chassis plate with either the
RSM800 or the PSM800 power supply. APM800
addressable PSU monitor and provides space for 2 x 7 Ah
batteries to provide 72 h backup.
Control keys and LEDs are labelled in English according to
the default LPCB functionality. The slide in decals can be
reversed and alternative text added.
The operator control module (OCM800) can support up to
80 inputs and outputs in the form of LED annunciators,
IOB800 input/output modules, or com 820 command
modules.
The MINERVA MX repeater is connected to the Panel via
the remote bus (RS485, 1200 m distance). A maximum of
7 repeaters (including one MX REMOTE repeater) can be
linked to each MINERVA MX panel and can provide full
repeater functions for all panels on the system.
Two power supply options are available for repeaters. The
MXR incorporates an RSM800 repeater supply module for
connection to a 24 Vdc supply. Or the MXR-PSU which
incorporates a PSM800 power supply module for
connection to a 120-240Vac mains supply and an APM800
addressable power monitor for connection to an MX
addressable loop, providing power supply monitoring in
accordance with EN54-pt.4.
Product Codes
Standard Repeaters
557.200.012
MXR Repeater with shallow backbox
(24Vdc)
557.200.017
MXR-F Repeater with flush backbox
(24Vdc)
557.200.013
MXR-PSU Repeater and addressable
PSU (120-240 Vac)
Options
557.202.006
IOB-800 (8in/8out) expansion board
557.180.005
Mimic driver module
557.180.016
XIOM universal I/O module
557.202.028
RSM800 PSU Module (24Vdc)
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 7
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 8
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• 2 MZX detection loops as standard
• Expandable to 8 loops using XLM800
• Same loop power capability of standard MZX4000
panel/Reduces the cost of network systems
• Uses MXNet networks (network card supplied separately)
• Create a system of distributed loops to reduce installation
costs
• Alarm, fault, power and system fault status display
• Single deep surface mount enclosure
• Integral power supply and space for 38AH batteries
• Distributed power supplies reduce cabling costs
• On board dual sounder circuits/Printer support at each
black box
• Fully featured and supported remote bus at each black
box-drive repeaters and mimic displays
• Download MX Consys configurations from any panel or
black box on the network
MZX4000 Black Box
For situations where a networked MX TechnologyTM panel is
not required to have a user interface an MZX4000 black box
panel can be used. Black box panels consist of steel back
boxes which house the FIM, processor board, power
supply and optional network card and expansion loop card.
The front cover is of steel construction and has a simple
status display panel giving LED indication of alarm, fault,
power and system fault.
MZX4000 black box panels are fully featured MZX
TechnologyTM panels designed to be used on networked
systems in situations where a local user interface is not
required.
Technical Specification
Product Code
Dimensions (mm):
Aprox weight:
Colour, housing &
front cover:
Operating Temp:
Storage Temp:
Relative Humidity:
Supply voltage:
Input current:
542.098
Chapter 2 Page 8
640H X 440W X 230D
16Kg
MZX4000 Black Box
Dawn Grey (BS 4800 10A)
Range -8°C to +55°C
-20°C to +70°C
95% non condensing
120 to 240 Vac
0.8 to 2.2A
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 9
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• PSB800M 5A 24V DC battery backed power supply and
loop booster to EN54pt4
• FIM800 field interface PCB incorporating one or two MX
DIGITAL loops
• CPU800 32 bit processor and memory card
• Optional network card and additional loop card(s) (T2000
only)
• VDR (Voyage Data Recorder) Interface as standard
Minerva T2000 and T2000 CV Marine Detection Panels
The T2000 is a fully Marine approved EN54 compliant 1 to 8
loop networkable detection panel. The T2000 supports two
Tyco MX DIGITAL detection loops and can be expanded to
eight loops supporting up to 1000 addressable devices. The
T2000 consists of a strong stainless steel or mild steel
Marine approved enclosure incorporating the above
features.
The OCM800 operator control module provides all
mandatory operator control keys and LED functions
including Day/Night switching. One control key and 2
indication LEDs are provided for vessel specific functions.
Control keys and LEDs are labelled in English according to
the default Marine functionality. The slide in decals can be
reversed and alternative text added.
The T2000CV is a 3 loop marine approved panel housed in
a mild steel enclosure designed for use in commercial
vessels.
The batteries and any additional zonal LED’s or operator
controls are mounted in a separate housing which can be
mounted below the main panel or behind the panel. The
battery box incorporates a heavy duty backbox and battery
clamp.
All panels have a strong cast aluminium front door, which
incorporates a modular user interface that fully complies
with EN54 pt2. The user interface incorporates the ODM800
operator display module with a 16 x 40-character backlit
LCD display, simple alphanumeric keypad and 5 softkeys.
The chassis plate in the battery box also has space for up
to 2 x IOB800 input/output expansion modules (maximum
24 I/O) or 1 x PSM/PSB800M.
Product Codes
557.200.600
557.200.602
557.200.610
557.200.605
557.201.216
557.200.620
557.202.127
557.202.128
557.180.454
557.180.452
557.180.022
557.201.233
557.201.234
09/10
Fire Catalogue
T2000 Two To Eight Loop Marine Panel
(Stainless steel enclosure)
T2000B Battery Box (Stainless steel
enclosure)
T2000 Standard Two to Eight Loop
Marine Panel (Mild steel enclosure)
T2000 BM Battery Box (Mild steel
enclosure)
T2000 XLM 8-Loop Mounting Kit
T2000CV 3 loop marine panel (mild steel
back box)
VDR Cable For a Standalone panel, Com
port 3
VDR Cable for a networked system, Com
port 1
Marine Bulkhead Mount
Marine 19” rack mount kit for use with
surface mounting housings
Terminal chamber PCB assembly
PSU 830 T2000/T2000R Conversion Kit
PSU 830 T2000 120VAC Kit
Chapter 2 Page 9
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 10
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Fully Functional
• Optional Approved Mild Steel Enclosure
• Fully Monitored R-Bus
Minerva T2000R and T2000R CV Marine Repeaters
The T2000R full function repeater is an EN54 Marine
approved repeater with optional addressable EN54:Pt.4
power supply. The repeater consists of a steel backbox
and cast aluminium front door which incorporates the
ODM800 operator display module with a 16 x 40-character
backlit LCD display, simple alphanumeric keypad and 5
softkeys. The OCM800 operator control module provides all
mandatory operator control keys and LED functions
including Day/Night switching. One control key and 2
indication LEDs are provided for vessel-specific functions.
Control keys and LEDs are labelled in English according to
the default Marine functionality. The slide in decals can be
reversed and alternative text added The back box has a
removable chassis plate with the PSM800M power supply
and APM800 addressable PSU monitor and space for 2 x 7
Ah batteries to provide 72h backup.
The T2000R CV indicating repeater is an EN54 Marine
approved repeater (24Vdc Supply). The repeater consists of
a mild steel backbox and cast aluminium front door which
incorporates the ODM800 operator display module with a
16 x 40-character backlit LCD display, simple alphanumeric
keypad and 5 softkeys.Operator controls comprise a panel
buzzer silence button , status LED’s are provided for
fire, fault and power on indication.
Both repeaters are connected to the Panel via the remote
bus (RS485, 1200 m distance). A maximum of 7 repeaters
(including one MX REMOTE repeater) can be linked to each
control panel and can provide repeater functions for all
panels on the system.
The repeater can support up to 80 inputs and outputs in the
form of LED annunciators, IOB800 input/output modules,
XIOM universal I/O modules or the 80 LED mimic module.
Product Codes
557.200.601
557.200.604
557.200.611
557.200.612
557.200.621
557.201.233
557.201.234
Chapter 2 Page 10
Fire Catalogue
T2000R Marine Repeater with Power
Supply Unit 240Vac (Stainless steel
enclosure)
T2000R Marine Repeater without Power
Supply Unit 24Vdc (Stainless steel
enclosure)
T2000R Standard Marine Repeater with
Power Supply Unit 240Vac (Mild steel
enclosure)
T2000R Standard Marine Repeater
without Power Supply Unit 24Vdc (Mild
steel enclosure)
T2000R CV Marine Indicating Repeater
without Power supply unit 24Vdc (Mild
Steel enclosure)
PSU 830 T2000/T2000R Conversion Kit
PSU 830 T2000 120VAC Kit
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 11
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
MX Detection Panels - Technical Specifications & System Schematics
MX Detection Panels - Designer Housing Technical Specification
Dimensions (mm)
Approx Weight
Temperature (Storage)
Temperature (Operating)
Humidity
Colour (Housing)
Colour (Modules)
EMC/RFI
Shock
Vibration
Shallow Housing
320Hx440Wx120D
7Kg
-20oC to +70oC
-8oC to +55oC
Flush Shallow Housing
Deep Housing
380Hx500Wx120D
320Hx440Wx215D
7.2Kg
8Kg
-20oC to +70oC
-20oC to +70oC
o
o
-8 C to +55 C
-8oC to +55oC
up to 95% RH, Non-Condensing
Dawn Grey (BS 4800 10A - 03)
Pantone 431C
EN 50130-4
EN 54-2
EN 54-2
Marine
320Hx440Wx135D
14Kg
-20oC to +70oC
-8oC to +55oC
MX2 Detection Panels Technical Specification
Panel Shallow Housing
Panel Deep Housing
Dimensions (MM)
580H x 458W x 129D
580H x 458W x 209D
Approx Weight
Temperate (storage)
Temperate (operating)
Humidity
Colour (Housing)
Colour (Modules)
EMC/RFI
IP Rating
12.7kg
15.2kg
09/10
Expansion Housing
Shallow
357Hx 458W x 129D
6.2kg
-20 °C to + 70°C
-5°C to +55 °C
Up to 90 % RH Non Condensing
Dawn Grey (BS4800 10A-03)
Pantone 431C
EN50130-4 EN61000-6-3
IP30
Fire Catalogue
Expansion Housing
Deep
357H x 458W x 209D
7.5kg
Chapter 2 Page 11
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 12
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
DESIGNER HOUSING SCHEMATIC
24Vdc
Non-Resettable
24Vdc
Resettable
Field I/O
Network
PC/Modem
Printer
CPU
ODM
TLI
PSB
RBus
FIM
FRONT
DOOR
Loop C
XLM
Loop A
Loop D
110-240Va.c.
OCM
Loop B
XBus
MAIN PANEL HOUSING
TUD/
IOB
IOB
ANN880
ANN840
or COM820
PSB/PSM
MX
FILNET
17 or 38Ah
17 or 38Ah
FRONT
DOOR
MPM
BATTERY & EXPANSION HOUSING
ANN880
ANN840
or COM820
Remote bus up to 15 addresses a combination of
up to 7 x OCM and 15 x MPM Maximum
MX2 Schematic
NETWORK
FIELD
I/O
110-240 Vac
XLM
LOOP B
LOOP C
DCM
CPU
LOOP A
TLI
RBUS
PSB
FIM
LOOP D
PRINTER
NETWORK
PC MODEM
17AH OR 38AH
24Vdc
ANN881
17AH OR 38AH
FRONT DOOR
MAIN PANEL HOUSING
Chapter 2 Page 12
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 13
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
MX Panel Components
Features
• Full alarm and fault monitoring for up to 1000
addressable points including central loop processing of
MX Fastlogic expert algorithms
• Concurrent operation of the main user interface and 2
remote user interfaces including one remote dial up or
networked user interface
• Cause and core effect using up to 1000 input, output
groups, delay timers and logic functions
CPU Central Processor
The CPU-800 provides the main processing power behind
the MX detection panels. It is a multi-layer PCB and
contains the CPU, the memory and interface electronics.
The CPU-800 plugs into the Field Interface Module
(FIM800).
The CPU-800 contains a Data Memory (SRAM), a Program
Memory (Flash EPROM), a Configuration Memory (Flash
EPROM) and a Boot ROM (EPROM). The use of flash
EPROM allows program upgrades without the need for
changing chips.
Technical Specification
Product Code
32 bit Processor:
Data Memory SRAM:
Prog. Memory Flash
EPROM:
Config. Memory Flash
EPROM:
Boot EPROM:
Number of serial
Interfaces:
Quiescent Current:
Alarm Current:
557.202.002
09/10
Motorola 68331
1 MByte
CPU800 standard MX central processor
2 MByte
1 Mbyte
64 kByte
4
67mA
67mA
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 13
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 14
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• MX Digital Loop Protocol
• Extensive Loop Protection
• Interfaced to FIM 800 module
MX Loop Expansion Module
The XLM800 Loop Expansion Module fits “piggyback” style
onto the FIM or an existing XLM 800 and is used to:
• Expand the capability of the MX4000 C.I.E. two l
loop system to eight loops
• Replace the FIM loops in case of a failure on
either a two or four loop system.
The XLM800 Loop Expansion Module controls the
communications between the detectors (and other
ancillaries) connected on the 2-wire loop circuits and the
controller. In addition, the addressable interface contains
line isolation circuits which protect the loop driver circuit
from short-circuit conditions.
Technical Specification
Product Code
Dimensions:
Battery Requirements:
557.202.007
Chapter 2 Page 14
17.5H x 104W x 196Dmm
Standby 104.3mA+loop current
Alarm105.3mA + loop current
Loop Current 495mA maximum
Fire Catalogue
XLM-MX Two Loop MX Digital Expansion
Card
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 15
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Interfaces to CPU & XLM modules
• 3 Download/Network & Printer ports
• Up to 2 MX Loops
FIM800 Field Interface Module
The Field Interface Module FIM is the main interface for field
wiring on MX detection panels and contains plug-in field
wiring terminals, inter board connectors, EMC protectors
and filters and general I/O electronics.
The FIM801and FIM801CV provides 1 x MX DIGITAL loop
and the FIM802 provides 2 x MX DIGITAL loops. Each MX
DIGITAL loop can support several kilometres of loop wiring
using a mixed topology using multiple loops and spurs.
The FIM provides up to 495mA of loop power to each loop
to drive loop powered sounders and other loop power
devices. An optional plug-in additional loop cards(XLM800MX) provide up to 8 x MX Digital loops.
The FIM incorporates the following local I/O connections:
• 2 x reverse polarity monitored sounder outputs
• 2 x volt free outputs (Default alarm and fault)
• 1 monitored input (eg. Day/Night changeover)
• 1 emergency alarm input
• 1 unmonitored input (eg. Class Change or Tamper)
• Full monitoring of power supply
• Ground fault monitoring
The FIM incorporates a local I/O bus which allows the local
I/O connections to be increased by 24. A variety of I/O
expansion boards are available including:
• IOB800 (8 in/8 out) expansion board
• TUD800 German Transmission Unit
The FIM includes two connections to the RBUS one for the
local user interface and one for connecting up to 15 remote
addresses in the form of up to 2 x operator control modules
(OCM800) or up to 15 multi-purpose modules (MPM800).
The FIM provides 3 configurable external serial ports :
• Port 1 Local printer
• Port 2 Configuration PC or remote
diagnostics and upload/download
modem
• Port 3 FSI open protocol or Network
card/gateway (TLI-800 or MX-FIL) (not provided on FIM
800CV)
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Dimensions:
Weight:
Power Consumption:
557.202.000
Relay Outputs:
Monitored inputs:
RBUS:
Serial Ports:
Local I/O Expansion:
09/10
25H x 105W x 196D mm
156g
119mA (Quiescent excluding loops and
operator interface)
169mA (Alarm)
30Vdc @ 2A
10k Ohm EOL, 3KHz in parallel
RS-485 , default 19.6kB, up
to 1200m
RS232C, 19.6kB, up to 10m
Up to 2 modules, up to 24
I/O, max. 300mm
557.202.001
557.202.008
557.180.053
Fire Catalogue
FIM801 field interface module with one
MX loop driver
FIM802 field interface module with two MX
loop drivers
FIM801CV for Marine T2000 CV
MX RBUS Driver chip (spare)
Chapter 2 Page 15
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 16
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Universal Input Voltage
• Temperature Compensated
• Full Fault Monitoring
PSM800 and PSB800M Power Supplies
The MX power PSU800 and PBS800 supply module used
for the MX/ZX Range of fire controllers based on the
designer housing (not MX2) is a state-of-the-art integrated
switch mode system power supply and battery charger,
which can provide up to 5A external and auxiliary loop
power during alarm conditions. It has a universal input
allowing operation from 100 to 255 Va.c., 50 or 60 Hz. The
power supply is approved worldwide to EN54, UL864 and
Marine standards.
The charging voltage is temperature compensated. The
PSM recharges the batteries within 24h for the following
timings:
• 90hr stand by time and 15 min. alarm condition
• 72hr stand by time and 30min. alarm condition
The power supply provides full condition and fault
monitoring to the system via the FIM (used by the
PSB800M) or addressable power supply monitor APM800
(used by the PSM800). The PSB800M incorporates the
LBM800 booster module to provide the correct voltage
levels to maximise the performance of the MX DIGITAL
protocol.
Faults signals (Loss of AC, Battery charger fault, Battery
fault) and control inputs (Battery test, Output reset) are
provided. Battery voltage and charger current readings are
also provided to the FIM or APM for automatic battery
testing.
Screw terminals provide 2 x 24V outputs (24 V stabilised,
24V stabilised with reset control) and one 5V output.
The power supply is fitted in a steel cage with mounting
points to allow any of the following boards to be mounted:
• APM800 addressable power supply monitor
• FB800 fuse board with 15 x 24Vdc fused spurs
• IOB800 input/output expansion board
A PSB800MK Power Expansion Kit is required to power the
XLM800 pcb on 4 loop systems which require the extended
loop power capability. It consists of a PSM800 power
supply module, an APM800 addressable monitor module, a
battery connecting cable and an XLM800 to APM800
connecting cable and may be fitted onto the chassis plate in
the battery housing.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Dimensions:
Weight:
Input Voltage:
557.200.014
Input Current:
Max. charge current :
50H x 114W x 190D mm
0.9Kg
120-240 Vrms, 50/60Hz
(Auto ranging)
0.8-1.6ARMS Rated Load
Up to 3.8A (dependant on
standby current)
Max. battery size
(24hr charge):
38Ah
Max. total supply current: 5A@24Vdc
Maximum external current:4A@24Vdc
Output Voltages:
24Vdc
(22.8 -26.4V)
Non-resettable:
24Vdc @ 4A
Resettable:
24Vdc @ 4A
5Vdc @ 3A
Power Consumption:
PSB - 90mA
(quiescent & alarm)
PSM - 65mA
(quiescent & alarm)
Chapter 2 Page 16
557.200.015
Options
557.202.003
557.202.403
557.202.405
557.202.027
557.202.050
557.202.043
557.202.004
Fire Catalogue
MXAPSU17 Boxed Addressable PSU
(17Ah)
MXAPSU38 Boxed Addressable PSU
(38Ah)
PSM800 Power Supply Only
PSM800M Marine approved power
supply
PSB800M Marine Panel Power Supply
(spare)
APM800 Addressable Power Supply
Monitor
PSM800 Temp. Sensor Accessory kit
PSB800MK Marine Power Expansion kit
LBM800 Spare Loop Voltage Booster PCB
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 17
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
•
•
•
•
•
Universal Input Voltage
Temperature Compensated
Full Fault Monitoring
Can drive 4 fully loaded MX digital loops
When used with second PSU830 and MX2 8 loop
expansion kit can power 8 fully loaded MX digital loops
• Same footprint and fixings as the PSB821
• Replaces PSB820 and PSM820
• Meets the requirements of EN54 part 4 amendment 2
PSU830 Power Supply
The MX PSU830 power supply module is a state-of-the-art
integrated switch mode system power supply and battery
charger, which can provide up to 5A external and auxiliary
loop power during alarm conditions. It has a universal input
allowing operation from 100 to 264Vac 50 or 60 Hz.
The charging voltage is temperature compensated. The
power supply recharges the batteries within 24hr for the
following timings:
Battery voltage readings are also provided to the FIM and a
volt free fault o/p is also provided.
Screw terminals provide 2 x 27V outputs (one with reset
control) and one 5V output. The power supply is fitted in a
steel cage with mounting points to allow any of the following
boards to be mounted:
•90hr stand by time and 15 minute alarm condition.
•72hr stand by time and 30 minute alarm condition.
•APM800 addressable power supply monitor module.
•FB800 fuse board with 15 x 24Vdc fused spurs.
•IOB800 input/output expansion board.
•PTM800 power terminal module.
The power supply provides full condition and fault
monitoring to the system via the FIM or addressable power
supply monitor module APM800. The PSU830 incorporates
a booster module to provide the correct voltage levels to
maximise the performance of the MX DIGITAL protocol.
The MX2 PSU830 Dual PSU Kit is required to power the
XLM800 pcb on 6 to 8 loop systems which require the
extended loop power capability. It consists of the necessary
cables & connectors to enable an additional PSU830 to be
fitted to an MX2 controller.
Fault signals (Loss of AC, Battery charger fault, Battery fault
and earth fault) are provided.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Dimensions (HWD):
62 x 132 x 242mm
Electrical Characteristics:
Input Voltage:
120-240Vac 50/60Hz (auto
ranging)
Input Current Rated Load:
RMS
0.8-2.2A
Output Voltages
27.3Vdc @ +25°C
Non-reset:
27.3Vdc @ 2A
5Vdc @ 2.2A
40Vdc @ 2.2A
Reset:
27.3Vdc @ 2A
Rated Output
Maximum Alarm current 5A for 30 minutes
Maximum continuous load
current (excluding
charging):
2.5A
Battery Requirements
17Ah or 38Ah single PSU
65Ah dual PSU
Standby Current Consumption:
90mA @ 24Vdc
Battery Fault High Resistance:
Single PSU:
0.6 Ohms
Dual PSU:
0.3 Ohms
557.202.210
557.201.232
557.201.231
557.202.044
557.202.030
557.202.031
09/10
Fire Catalogue
PSU830 Power Supply Module
PTM800 Power Terminal Module
MX2 PSU830 Dual PSU Kit
PSU 830K Power Expansion Kit
PSU 830 Panel Fixing Conversion Kit
PSU 830 Small Chassis Plate Conversion
Kit
Chapter 2 Page 17
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:58 Page 18
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Changeable Legends
• Fully programmable
• Optional I/O via R-Bus
OCM800 Operator Control Module
The OCM800 is utilised by all MX detection panels and full
function repeaters to provide mandatory operator control
and LED indication functions to comply with EN54:pt.2. The
OCM800 is fully programmable but operates in default
configurations according to the software template used.
In addition the OCM800 can drive up to 80 inputs/outputs
using one of the following modules.
Most software templates allow several of the LED’s and
control buttons to be programmed for site-specific
functions. The LED’s and control buttons both have slide in
legends to suit the default configurations and language.
Standard panels include the appropriate legends for their
relevant markets.
• Up to 5 x IOB800 (8 in/8 out LPCB/VdS approved
. expansion board)
• Up to 5 x XIOM (16 way universal I/O board)
• One Mimic Panel (80 way LED mimic driver PCB)
• One 80 way ANN880 LED mimic
• One 40 way ANN840 LED mimic using red & yellow LED’s
• Two 20 way COM820 LED status/command modules
The OCM800 incorporates the functionality of an MPM800,
which allows it to drive an operator display module to
provide a complete panel user interface.
The following I/O and LED annunciator modules can be
slaved from an MPM800:
Up to 2 x OCM800 units can be connected to an MX panel
via the internal or external RBus communication port.
Technical Specification
Product Code
Dimensions:
Weight:
Power Consumption:
557.202.013
Control Buttons:
Indication LED’s:
Communications:
Expansion Bus:
Legends for LPCB
modules:
Chapter 2 Page 18
50H x 232W x 133D mm
0.272Kg
35mA (Quiescent)
36mA (Lamp test)
81mA (Alarm)
7
18
RS-485: RBus –Default
9.2Kb
MX X-Bus
OCM800 with Minerva MX Inserts
UK/English, Marine
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 19
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• 0-9 alpha-numeric phone style keypad
• Up and down scroll keys
• Five function keys
ODM800 Operator Display Module
The ODM800 operator display module provides a powerful
and flexible 40 x 16 character backlit LCD display used by
all MX detection panels and full function repeaters. The
ODM800 is used with the OCM800 to provide a fully
compliant and approved user interface EN54 fire detection
panels.
The ODM800 is powered and controlled by the OCM800
operator control module and provides various functions
according to the panel software.
Standard EN54 panels use the LCD display as five windows
on the system.
Window 1-Details of first detector in alarm
Window 2-Details of the most recent detector in alarm
Window 3-System Status including Alarm/Fault and Isolate
counters
Window 4-Full alarm/event details and lists including 95
character procedure plus full password controlled system
manager, service and engineering menu structure
Window 5-Function key legends (eg. Back, Enter, >>,<<)
Technical Specification
Product Code
Dimensions:
Weight:
Power Consumption:
557.202.019
25H x 232W x 133D mm
0.361Kg
50mA (Quiescent)
900mA (Alarm Backlit)
50mA (Alarm during mains failure)
ODM800 operator display module
OCM800 to IOB800 Connection Details
OCM800 TO IOB800 CONNECTION DETAILS
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 19
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 20
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
ANN840 LED Annunciator
The ANN840 is a standard LED
annunciator user interface module
which can be driven from an
OCM800 or an MPM800. The
MPM800 can be mounted remotely
or “piggy-backed” on the ANN840.
The ANN840 has removable legends
for 40 zone status indicators. Each
zone can indicate RED (eg. Alarm)
and YELLOW (eg. Fault & Isolate).
The functionality is programmed in
the MX detection panel.
The ANN840 operates as 80 outputs
(RED & YELLOW).
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
25H x 232W x 133D mm
Weight:
177g
Power Consumption:
1mA + MPM800
(Quiescent)
85mA + MPM800 (25%
zones in alarm (Alarm))
340mA +MPM800 (Lamp
test)
Product Code
557.202.021
ANN840 LED annunciator
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
25H x 232W x 133D mm
Weight:
177g
Power Consumption:
1mA + MPM800
(Quiescent)
85mA +MPM800 (25%
zones in alarm (Alarm))
340mA + MPM800 (Lamp
test)
Product Code
557.202.022
ANN880 LED annunciator
The COM820 is a standard user
interface module, which can be
driven from an OCM800 or an
MPM800. The MPM800 can be
mounted remotely or “piggybacked” on the COM820. The
COM820 has removable legends for
20 status command functions. Each
function includes a command button
and a red status LED. The
functionality is programmed in the
MX detection panel. Typical
applications include:
. Manual/OFF/Auto/Isolate
functions for evacuation or plant
control
. Selective isolate and evacuate
functions for fireman’s control
. Selective plant shutdown and
override functions
. Selective system delay and timer
functions
2 can be driven from 1 x MPM800.
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
25H x 232W x 133D mm
Weight:
204g
Power Consumption:
0.267mA (Quiescent - No
LED’s)
5mA (Alarm - 25% LED’s)
21mA (Lamp test)
Product Code
557.202.020
COM820 Status/Command Module
The 80-Way Mimic allows custommade display and presentation
panels to be incorporated in the
MINERVA MX addressable system.
It is supplied as a single PCB, which
may be mounted in an expansion
box or on the rear of a free-standing
panel, as required. It may be used to
drive up to 80 zonal LED indicators,
arranged in any configuration,
together with two FIRE LEDs, one
FAULT LED and one ISOLATE LED.
These indicators can operate in the
same manner as the corresponding
indicators on the panel.
A remote Mimic can be connected to
the MPM800’s configured as remote
Mimic drivers via the remote bus.
Up to 15 MPM800’s may be
connected on to the remote bus,
each with a unique address [set onboard]. The Mimic includes audible
and visible warning facilities.
Product Code
557.180.005
MINERVA 80 way mimic driver
module
ANN880 LED Annunciator
The ANN880 is a standard LED
annunciator user interface module,
which can be driven from an
OCM800 or an MPM800. The
MPM800 can be mounted remotely
or “piggy-backed” on the ANN880.
The ANN880 has 80 red LEDs
numbered 1 to 80. The functionality
is programmed in the MX detection
panel but is defaulted to zone alarm
LED’s.
COM820 Status Command Module - 20 Way
Remote Mimics
Chapter 2 Page 20
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
235H x
190Wmm
Operating Temp:
-10°C to +55°C
Storage Temp:
-20°C to +65°C
Relative Humidity:
Up to 95% RH
NonCondensing
Power Consumption: 11mA
(Quiescent) 200mA (25% Alarm)
800mA (Lamp Test)
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 21
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Drives up to 80 I/O points
• Direct Interface to Zonal Displays and other
Modules
• Interfaces to FIM Board
MPM800 Multi Purpose Interface Module
The MPM800 is used to provide various expansion
capabilities via the remote bus (RBUS). The MPM800 is
provided as a standalone module but is also incorporated
into the circuitry of the OCM800 operator control module to
drive the LCD display, LEDs, keyswitch and keys on the
OCM800 and the operator display module. The OCM800
and MPM800 have an XBUS which can be used to drive up
to 80 I/O. The MPM800 also has a printer interface for
connecting to a serial or parallel printer.
An additional printer driver kit is required to allow the
MPM800 to drive a printer - a serial isolation module
should be used to eliminate earth fault indications caused
by some mains connected printers.
Up to 15 x MPM modules can be connected to each panel
of which 8 can be in the form of OCM800 (including the
main OCM800 user interface). One OCM800 can also be in
the form of an emulated user interface on a remote PC
connected via the network or dial up modem.
The following I/O and LED annunciator modules can be
slaved from an MPM800:
•
•
•
•
•
Up to 5 x IOB800 (8 in/8 out expansion board)
Up to 5 x XIOM800 (16 way universal I/O board)
One Mimic Panel (80 way LED mimic driver PCB)
One 80 way ANN880 LED mimic**
One 40 way ANN840 LED mimic using red
& yellow LEDs**
• Two 20 way COM820 LED status/command modules**
The MPM800 is mounted by plugging directly onto the
back of those items marked **
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Dimensions:
Weight:
Power Supply:
Communications:
Printer Connection:
557.202.012
557.202.117
557.180.052
557.180.053
09/10
25.4H x 92W x 167.64D mm
98g
24Vdc (from PSB or PSM800)
RS-485, up to 19.6kB
Serial or Parallel
Fire Catalogue
MPM800 multi-purpose interface modules
Serial printer cable for MPM800 or FIM800
Serial Printer Driver Kit
Isolated RS485 IC (for U16)
Chapter 2 Page 21
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 22
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
IOB Input/Output Expansion Board
The XIOM is a 16 universal input/output expansion board.
The I/O on the XIOM can be set in
banks of 8 to operate as follows:
• LED driver outputs (10mA source)
• Relay Driver Outputs (100mA sink)
Features
• 16 I/P’s or 16 O/P’s or 8 I/P + 8
O/P
• 5 per MPM800 (80 I/O points)
• Fully configurable in MX consys
Product Code
557.180.016
XIOM MINERVA Input/Output
Expansion Module (16 Way)
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
144H x 85W x 15D mm
• Voltage Monitor Input (8 - 30Vdc
Normal)
• Volt Free Contact inputs
FB800 Fuse Board
The FB800 fuse board provides
terminations for 15 fused 24Vdc
output spurs from a single 24V d.c.
input. The FB800 is designed to be
normally mounted on the PSB800M
or PSM800 power supply. The fuses
are rated at 500mA.
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
93H x165W x 80D mm
Weight:
149g
Input:
24Vdc
Output:
15 x 24V d.c / 500mA
Terminations:
2.5mm
Product Code
557.202.100
FB800 fuse board (15 way)
IOB Input/Output Expansion Board
The IOB800 is an LPCB approved
board that provides 8 opto-isolated
digital inputs and 8 x 24V d.c. relay
outputs for providing I/O expansion
capabilities to MX detection panels
for interfacing to other subsystems
and signalling devices. The IOB800
also incorporates a connector, which
provides decoded signals for the 8
inputs and 8 outputs for specialist
interfacing.
The IOB800 can be mounted in the
top of a battery box or repeater.
The IOB800 has two expansion bus
connectors which allow them to be
daisy chained together.
Product Code
557.202.006
IOB800 Expansion Board and cables
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
15H X 164W X 80D mm
Weight:
153g
Terminations:
1.5mm
The IOB800 can be used to provide
expansion I/O to the following MX
panel components:
. FIM801/802 field interface
modules (maximum 24 I/O
8IN/16OUT)
. OCM800 operator control
modules (maximum 80 I/O)
. MPM800 multi-purpose interface
(maximum 80 I/O)
Chapter 2 Page 22
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 23
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• High level interface to building automation systems
• Meet interfacing requirements for large integrated
projects
MZX BACnet Interface
BACnet can be provided from a stand-alone MZX
Technology panel or from an MZX or FILnet network via the
MZX BACnet converter.
The MZX BACnet converter is a mini RISC-based
embedded computer which converts fire data to the
BACnet communications protocol. The converter needs
special firmware that is simply uploaded from a PC.
Technical Specification
Product Code
Mechanical
Weight:
Dimensions:
Mounting:
Operating Temperature:
Operating Humidity:
Storage Temperature:
Electrical
Input Voltage:
557.202.135 BACnet Converter for MZX
09/10
130 g
67 x 22 x 100.4 mm
DIN-Rail, wall
-10 to 60°C
5 to 95% RH
-20 to 80°C
12 to 48 VDC
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 23
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 24
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Desktop Printer
The printer is designed as a low
cost business printer ideally suited
for mounting adjacent to the fire
control panel.The LQ-300+
combines high performance with
paper handling flexibility and quiet
operation.
Features
• 300 cps draft/ 90cps LQ.
• Quiet operation
• Lightweight and compact design
• 9 LQ fonts
• 2 paper feed paths
• Convertible push/pull tractor
• Paper guide
• Auto loading
• Paper park
• Cable feed recess
• Epson LQ standard terminal
emulation available
• Parallel and serial interface
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
159H x 366W x
275D mm
Weight:
4.4kg
Operating Voltage: 180V to
264Va.c.
Product Codes
557.180.239
MINERVA printer LQ-300+
557.180.220
LQ 300+ Printer Ribbon (spare)
557.202.117
MX FIM/MPM to serial printer lead
In-Built Printer
The PRN800 Printer Kit is designed
for use with the designer range of
MX Controllers (MX1000, MX4000
and T2000). It is fitted to the front
cover of the MX battery housing and
is powered from the PSB 800 power
supply via an FB800 fuseboard in
the MX Controller housing.
Features
• A thermal printer mechanism
which ensures high reliability.
• Quiet Operation
• Lightweight and Compact Design
• High Speed Printing: 40mm per
second.
• High quality printing: 384 dots.
• 40 Columns
• Friction paper feed
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
230H x 137W x
85D mm
Weight:
0.38Kg
Operating Temp: +5°C to +45°C
Storage Temp:
-20°C to +70°C
Relative Humidity: Up to 80% noncondensing
EMC:
61000-6-3 for
emissions
BS EN 50082-1
for immunity
Product Codes
557.202.024
PRN 800 Printer c/w front cover
module
557.301.014
Spare Paper Roll (pk of 5)
Remote LCD Display
The Remote LCD Repeater Module
is designed to provide an
independent scrolling log of system
status at numerous points within a
building or site. The module
interfaces directly to a serial printer
port of the MX addressable fire
panel. If a local printer is already
connected to the Panel’s MPM800
serial port, a second MPM800 must
be used.
Features
• Uses a backlit 4x20 character
alphanumeric display.
• Provides an internal log of up to
330 events.
• Provides internal audible warning
of an event.
• Allows the event log to be
scrolled.
• Local internal buzzer silence.
• Connects to host panels RS232
port (maximum cable length
between panels and first repeater
of 15m).
• Provides an external sounder to
mimic the internal buzzer.
• Can be connected to an
unlimited number of other LCD
Repeaters by using the
RS232/RS422 converter (Up to
1200m between repeaters).
Chapter 2 Page 24
The LCD repeater must not be used
in the primary fire path. It must not
be used as the sole warning that a
fire exists.
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
150H x 200W x 75D mm
Material:
Bayblend
polycarbonate/ABS alloy
Operating Temp:
-10 C to +55 C
Relative Humidity:
Up to 95% RH
Non-Condensing
Power Supply:
200mA
@24Vdc
Ext. Sounder Relay: 500mA@24Vdc
EMC:
Product Family Standard EN50130-4
in respect of Conducted
Disturbances, Radiated Immunity,
Electrostatic Discharge, Fast
Transients and Slow High Energy.
EN61000-6-3 -1 for Emissions.
Fire Catalogue
Product Codes
557.200.030
Remote LCD Repeater MKII
(compatible with Version 4.1 and
above for UK/UL/Marine/Western
European Countries)
557.202.128
MX FIM com1 to RS422 Lead
557.180.151
RS232/422 converter for LCD
Repeaters.
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 25
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
DDA Compliant Pager
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
UHF radio link for maximum licensable protection
Unique coding avoids neighbouring system clashes
Self monitoring of system health
Rugged steel enclosure to IP65
Backlit 2 line text display continuously reports system
status
Additional audible & visible status indicators
Prioritised Fire Alarm Inputs
Automated test calls alert pagers to loss of radio signal
Fault Notification to the lost fire panel via a monitored link
Key operated "System Test" facility for routine confidence
checking
Over 90 hour's backup operation with internal battery
Achieves Disability Discrimination Act (DDA) compliance
Fire Tek Pro Paging System
The FireTek Pro paging system is designed for use with
professional Fire Systems installed in commercial, industrial
and educational premises. The system is primarily designed
to alert the "hearing impaired" in the event of a fire or other
emergency where an audible sounder is the normal means
of indication.
The FireTek Pro has been designed to comply with the
recommendations detailed in BS5839-1: 2002 for alerting
the "hearing impaired" to the activation of a fire alarm
system.
High Integrity Pagers
To complete the system the alphanumeric pagers have
added features specifically incorporated for the "hard of
hearing" when used with the FireTek Pro. These features
include distinct vibrate alerts for emergency messages, a
vibrating out of range indicator which displays "No Service"
on the pager when the radio link is lost, and a vibrating low
battery indicator.
Antenna Options
Mini Dipole Antenna - remote internally mounted antenna for
large sites or areas of difficult signal propagation.
The system can also be used in conjunction with a security
panel to alert guards who might be located remotely from
the main premises.
Folded Dipole Antenna - remote externally mounted antenna
for maximum signal coverage e.g. campuses and multibuilding sites.
The interface to the fire panel comprises of three Prioritised
Fire Inputs and two Fault Inputs. For ease of installation, a
monitored cable assembly is provided with each system
which includes a "common fault" relay output back to the
host fire panel. This output will activate if the FireTek Pro
suffers a mains failure, transmitter fault, antenna mismatch,
interface link failure, or low battery state.
Upon activation of any one of the Fire Inputs, the FireTek Pro
will enter the fire alert condition, prioritising and transmitting
the Fire message to all enrolled pagers. The transmissions
will be repeated until the fire condition is reset. The FireTek
Pro Pagers ensure that users are alerted by distinct vibration
patterns and clear text messages.
UHF Radio Operation
Any alerting system is only as good as its weakest link. The
FireTek Pro utilises UHF radio frequencies, the main benefits
being superior in-building radio signal propagation and the
option of a manual frequency co-ordinate license issued by
OFCOM. Licensing the FireTek Pro provides a higher degree
of protection from interference. This fact is acknowledged in
Section 18.1 of BS 5839-1:2002.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 25
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 26
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Supply Voltage:
557.200.071
557.200.074
557.200.076
557.200.077
557.200.078
557.200.079
557.200.080
Operational Current:
Inputs:
Outputs:
Fault Notification:
Visual Display:
Enclosure:
Dimensions:
Chapter 2 Page 26
230V AC 50-60 Hz
12v 7Ah standby battery
250mA
3 Prioritised Volt Free (Fire)
Input 1 - Fire Alarm - Evacuate
Building
Input 2 - There is an Incident Leave Building
Input 3 - Prepare to Evacuate Await Instructions
2 Volt Free (Fault)
1 off volt free relay output
Mains Failure
Transmitter Fault
Antenna Mismatch
Panel Link Failure
Low/Missing Battery
2 Line Backlit LCD
Steel Enclosure rated to IP65
380 x 320 x 110 mm (H x W x D)
(No antenna fitted)
Fire Catalogue
Paging Transmitter
40 Character Alpha Numeric Pager
1/2 wave dipole antenna
Wall mounting folded dipole antenna
Pole mounting folded dipole antenna
5 metre antenna feeder cable
10 metre antenna feeder cable
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 27
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
The pagers:• Display messages sent out by the MX as displayed
on the MX LCD
• Internal log of up to 40 events
• Audible and/or vibrate warning of event
• Allows the event log to be displayed
The transmitter:• Connects using a 9 way D type MX interface lead to MX
printer port
Pager Interface
The MX pager system is designed to provide a facility to
signal all text messages or alarm/fault messages from a
local transmitter to the pagers.
The Type A alarm pager can display alarm/fault messages.
The Type B maintenance pager displays all messages sent
by the fire controller.
The transmitter connects to the serial printer port of an
MPM800, if a local printer is connected to the controllers
MPM800 serial port, a second MPM800 must be used. The
pager system requires a +12V d.c. connection (from a
remote psu) and a serial port connection. If the transmitter
needs to be located further than 2 m from the MX Panel,
then a non-standard serial printer cable may be used, up to
a maximum distance of 14m.
CAUTION: Before any installation is carried out, an on site
radio paging license must be obtained by the customer.
Care should be taken when designing pager systems.
Normal practice indicates that a site survey should be done.
Contact Product Management for additional advice on site
surveys.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Dimensions:
System operating
voltage:
Effective radiated
power:
Frequency range:
Channel spacing:
TX baud rate:
Type approval
557.200.029
577.002.002
577.002.003
577.002.007
328H x 190W x 75D mm
12 to 13.8Vdc
500mW
50-470 MHz
25KHz
512 or 1200
ETS 300 224, MPT1383 Cert No.
13249, EC type approved to ETS
300 682 Approval No. 13331
577.002.008
1381N
Pager Transmitter
Type A alarm pager
Type A maintenance pager
Pager aerial 60 db gain up to 1km (c/w
mounting bracket)
Optional feeder cable (10m long)
Elmdene 12V 1A PSU in Housing
Manual - Vol17A-2-Pager
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 27
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 28
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
MX Virtual Multi-Sensor Detectors
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Multiple Fire Detection modes
Tyco MX FASTLOGIC Expert Algorithms
MX HPO detection algorithms
Tyco CO fire detection technology
Up to 250 detectors per loop
Optional bi-directional line isolation with every detector
Remote detector verification & temperature read-out
Highly featured MX SERVICE tool
Programmable Alarm LED with 360° viewing angle
Optional detector locking pin
Variety of sounder and relay detector bases
Address flag stays with the base
Internationally approved
800 Series Detectors
The 800 Series are addressable multi-sensor fire, smoke
and heat detectors, which can be implemented as several
MX VIRTUAL detectors by the MX detection panel. The 801
and 811 Series are designed and approved to EN54, the
801 Series carry land based approvals and the 811 Series
also carry Marine approvals.
The 800 Series of MX VIRTUAL detectors provide the latest
fire detection technology in an attractive cost effective
package.
The detectors are constructed from hardwearing Fire
Resistant FR110 plastic.
The multi-sensor detectors are environmentally friendly.
They use no radioactive parts and can be returned to the
factory for recycling at the end of their life.
All 800 Series detectors are supplied with integral dust
covers as part of the packaging. Dust covers are retained
throughout installation and removed at commissioning time.
Installation & Service Features
The 800 Series MX VIRTUAL detectors include a host of
installation and service features which are provided to
reduce installation and service costs and reduce repair
times.
• Standard bases with multiple mounting options
speed and simplify installation
• Unique ‘park’ position for commissioning and service
procedures.
• Detector Addressing programmed from the MX
SERVICE Tool or MX Panel
• Address flag – fixed to the base to prevent mix ups
during service
• Compatible with Tyco 600 and 900 Series bases – for
easy upgrade
• Panel Auto-Config and Self learn functions – supported
by the detectors
• Detector Service functions allow 800 Series detectors to
be automatically addressed
• Full range of remote installation and service tools
• Dirty Detector Read-out can be viewed on the MX
SERVICE tool or panel.
Construction & Technical Specification
The 800 Series detectors are supplied in an extremely
robust and reliable fully sealed construction, which has
undergone stringent environmental and Marine type testing.
Electrical contacts are moulded into the plastic to eliminate
any movement.
Chapter 2 Page 28
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 29
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Combined optical, heat and carbon monoxide detector
• Operate simultaneously as a fire and CO toxic gas
detector
• Early detection of all fire types from smouldering to fast
flaming
• Minerva® Expert algorithms use elements for positive false
alarm detection
• Optical, CO and Heat can operate independently for
sequential alarm systems and CO toxic gas alert
• All 3 elements are independently monitored for faults
• Universal mode for maximum fire protection
• Resilient mode for false free operation in challenging
environments
• Use with standard or loop powered sounder base for
reduced installation costs
3oTec Multi-Sensor Smoke, Heat and Carbon Monoxide Detector
The 3oTec detector is a combined optical, carbon monoxide
and heat detector for use with MX Technology® controllers.
The 3oTec can be used in combination with other MX
Technology® detectors with a maximum total of 250
detectors connected to a single 2 wire MXDigital loop.
Single-Mode and Multi-Mode Operation
Each individual 3oTec detector will be operating in either
single-mode or multi-mode. This will be set at the time of
commissioning for each 3oTec detector dependant on the
application.
Single-Mode
As a single mode detector the 3oTec uses a single address.
All the user control features currently applicable to other
detectors can also be used with 3oTec. This includes the
ability to switch between modes, either automatically or
manually.
Multi-Mode
As a multi-mode device the 3oTec takes three addresses
form the available 1000 per MX/ZX panel. The choice of
modes used in multi-point will depend on the application.
As far as the user is concerned, each address is an
individual detector with its own attributes and settings.
The user can also switch between modes for each of the
addresses used.
Heat Sensing Element
High quality thermistor with very low thermal mass for
added responsiveness.
Optical Chamber
The optical chamber has many advanced features that
improve performance and reliability.
High intensity, short pulse width infrared light source for
heightened responsiveness.
Optical feedback will verify the total optical path on every
poll of the detector.
Precision optics eliminate nuisance from small insects such
as thrips, without the need for a filter.
Carbon Monoxide Cell
High efficiency electro-chemical CO detection cell
Cell integrity is continuously monitored
Increased cell capacity for durability
Cell is electronically calibrated for IS07240.6 fire
applications or EN50291 toxic gas applications
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Mechanical
Detector Material
Weight
Colour
FR110 "Bayblend" Fire resistant
0.2Kg detector and base (approx)
White
516.800.800
516.800.800.A
516.800.800.Y
516.800.801
Environmental
Operating Temp.
Storage Temp.
Relative Humidity
Range -10oC to +55oC
-20oC to +55oC
90% non condensing
801PC
801PC
801PC
811PC
Unbranded
ADT branded
Tyco branded
Marine Approved
801PC
Mode 1
Mode 2
Mode 3
Mode 4
Mode 5
Mode 6
Certification
09/10
Universal multi-criteria sensor
false alarm immunity multi-criteria
A1R
Enhanced Optical
Enhanced CO
CO Toxic Gas
LPCB \ VdS
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 29
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 30
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
800PH Multi-Sensor Smoke and Heat Detectors
The 800PH is a state-of-the-art
smoke and heat detector which
allows a full set of detection modes
to be implemented in the MX
detection panel to suit most smoke
and heat detection applications.
The 800PH incorporates a unique
“mousehole” design optical chamber
with an unrivalled signal to noise
ratio providing high resilience to dust
and dirt which means reduced
service costs. In addition a unique
chamber cover actually draws slow
moving smoke into the chamber to
provide a more responsive detector.
The unique design provides
immunity to small insects and thrips
without the need for a separate thirp
filter.
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
109dia x 43H mm
Operating Temp.:
-20 to +70oC
Storage Temp.:
-40 to +80oC
Relative Humidity: 95% (non
condensing)
Standards:
EN54 pt 5,
EN54 pt 7
Product Codes
801PH
516.800.500.A
516.800.500.T
516.800.500.Y
ADT
THORN
TYCO
811PH
516.800.507
THORN
801PH
Optical
Yes*
Enhanced Optical (HPO) Yes*
Normal Ambient ROR
A1R
Fixed Heat
A2S 60oC
Certification
LPCB
* Approved with MX Fastlogic algorithms
The 800PH provides all the features
of MX VIRTUAL detectors including
self verification, temperature and
smoke level indication and unrivalled
service functions.
811PH
Yes*
Yes*
A1R
A2S 60oC
Marine
800H Heat Detectors
The 800H is a flexible cost-effective
addressable heat detector with all
the features of MX VIRTUAL
detectors. The 800H returns the
temperature to the MX detection
panel which allows various detection
modes to be implemented. The 800H
uses a high quality thermistor with
very low thermal mass. This allows
the detectors to provide fast accurate
temperature detection as well as
heat detection.
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
109dia x 43H
mm
Operating temp:
-25 to +70°C
(-40 to +90°C
for short
periods)
Storage temp:
-40 to +80°C
Standards:
EN54: pt.5
Product Codes
801H
516.800.502.A
516.800.502.T
516.800.502.Y
811H
516.800.509
High Ambient ROR
Normal Ambient ROR
Fixed Heat
Certification
801H
CR
A1R
A2S 60°C
LPCB/VdS
ADT
THORN
TYCO
THORN
811H
CR
A1R
A2S 60°C
Marine
800CH Multi-Sensor Carbon Monoxide Fire Detectors
The 800CH is a state-of-the-art
carbon monoxide and heat detector
which allows a full set of detection
modes to be implemented in the MX
detection panel to suit most fire and
heat detection applications. The
800CH is particularly well suited to
sleeping risks, storage areas and
applications where smoke detector
positioning is difficult or where
smoke detectors are prone to false
alarm.
The integration of heat detection into
the 800CH allows the detector to
operate in a wide variety of
applications where combined risks
mean that CO detection alone would
be insufficient.
The 800CH incorporates a reliable
electro-chemical CO detection cell
and high specification low thermal
mass thermistor for accurate
temperature detection.
Chapter 2 Page 30
The 800CH provides all the features
of MX VIRTUAL detectors including
self verification, temperature and CO
level indication and unrivalled
service functions.
Product Codes
801CH
516.800.501.A
516.800.501.T
516.800.501.Y
ADT
THORN
TYCO
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
109dia x 43Hmm
Operating Temp:
0 to +55oC
Storage Temp:
-20 to +55oC
Relative Humidity: 95% (noncondensing)
Standards:
EN54 pt 5
EN54 pt 7
811CH
516.800.508
THORN
Carbon Monoxide
Enhanced CO (CCO)
Normal Ambient ROR
Fixed Heat
CCO plus ROR (A1R)
Certification
Fire Catalogue
801CH
Yes
Yes
A1R
A2S 60oC
Yes
LPCB
811CH
Yes
Yes
A1R
A2S 60oC
Yes
Marine
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 31
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
800F Flame Detectors
The 800F is a digital addressable,
low cost infrared flame detector with
some high end features such as
‘Solar Blind’ operation for false alarm
free reliability and an automatic
health check feature. Will detect a
0.1m2 flaming fire at a range of 20m.
Uses the standard MX detector
bases and MX base accessories. An
Intrinsically safe version is available
as part of the System 800 I.S. range.
Technical Specification
Dimensions (mm): 108Dia x 21.2H
Weight:
74g
Operation Temp:
-20°C to+70°C
Storage Temperature: -40°C to+80°C
Relative Humidity:
90% RH
continuous (non-condensing)
2
Range: 0.1m n-heptane at 50m
Field of View:100°
Standards EN54 pt10 Certification
Product Codes
516.800.006
801F
LPCB
516.800.007
811F
Marine
compensation for detector condition
monitoring. The 801I is LPCB
approved.
Product Codes
801I
516.800.515.A
516.800.515.T
516.800.515.Y
800I Ionisation Smoke Detector
The 800I ionisation detectors are
offered for old specifications which
still call for ionisation smoke
detectors. The 800CH and 800PH
detectors offer improved
performance, significantly lower false
alarms and environmental
compatibility for smoke detection
applications. The 800I nevertheless
offers state-of-the-art ionisation
smoke detection with self verification,
smoke level indication and threshold
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
109dia x 43Hmm
Operating Temp:
-20 to +70°C
Storage Temp:
-40 to +80°C
Relative Humidity: <95% (non
condensing)
Standards:
EN54 pt 7
ADT
THORN
TYCO
801PS High Sensitivity Smoke Detector
The 801 PS high sensitivity smoke
detector is designed for applications
which require a detector with a
greater sensitivity than specified
within EN54-7.
Having a response to smoke of
0.6%/m makes this device suitable
for use in locations where early
smoke detection is required, ie
cabinet protection and areas where
aspirating systems would have
previously been considered.
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
109 Dia x 43Hmm
Operation temp:
- 25oC to + 70o C
Storage temp:
- 40oC to +80oC
Relative Humidity 95%
non-condensing
Product Code
516.800.518
801PS High sensitivity smoke
detector
Line Shorting Adaptor
Low profile line shorting adaptor
commissioning tool (shorts terminals
together enabling cable resistance
checks to be carried out) - ADT
Branded
Product Code
517.050.002.A
Line Shorting Adapter
GD210 Gas Detector
The GD210 flammable gas detector
is designed for use in non-hazardous
areas where flammable gas
detection is required, typical
locations include kitchens, gas fired
boiler rooms, meter rooms, sub
basements and cable chambers.
Product Codes
516.100.050
GD210 Flammable Gas Detector
4 - 20mA interface
516.100.013
Test Gas Kit - 20 L can of 2.5%
methane (50%LEL) c/w adaptor and
tube
516.100.014
Test Gas - 20 L can of 2.5% methane
(50%LEL)
This detector connects via a 4-20mA
interface to the DDM800 Universal
Fire and Gas Module
Voltage 12-30 VDC
Power 3.5 watts
Output 4-20mA 3 wire Source
Load resistance 250 ohms (max)
Operating temp - 40 to +65oC
IP rating – 55
Cable entry 1 x M20
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 31
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 32
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Beam and Linear Heat Detectors
Beam type smoke detection is ideal for large open span buildings where point type detection is unsuitable i.e.
warehousing & sports halls. The range of Linear Heat Detection is of particular use in tunnels and cable ducts and other
similar areas.
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Motorised Auto-Aligning
Up to 4 Detectors per System Controller
Each Detector configurable from 8m to 100m
Integral LASER
Auto-Align Fast Automatic BeamAlignment
Auto-Optimise Building Movement and Contamination
Compensation
Low Level System Controller
20mm Cable Gland Knockouts on System Controller
2-wire interface from System Controller to Detector
Worldwide Approvals including EN54:12 and UL268
Up to 4 Detectors per System Controller
FIRERAY 5000 Multi Head Auto Aligning Infrared Optical Beam Smoke Detector
The FIRERAY® 5000 motorised, auto aligning infrared optical
beam smoke detector can now be installed with up to four
detector heads per system, thus saving on installation time
and costs. This innovative system has been designed from
the ground up to include pioneering technology that fully
addresses the needs of the installer and user, both now and
in the future.
With its industry leading optics, the FIRERAY 5000 is ideally
suited for the protection of large areas where the use of
traditional detection technologies would prove to be too
difficult and/or costly to install. The FIRERAY 5000 combines
an infrared transmitter and receiver in the same discrete unit
and operates by projecting a well-defined beam to a
reflective prism, which returns the beam to the receiver for
analysis. Smoke in the beam path causes a drop in power,
which, if below a pre-determined level, results in an alarm
signal.
The system can be fully customised, according to local
conditions; both alarm thresholds (sensitivity) and time to
Alarm/Fault can be set from the ground level System
Controller.
Each detector head is independently configurable from 8m
through to 100m and has its own individual fire threshold.
The System Controller retains one set of Fire and Fault
relays that is common to all detectors that are installed.
The FR5000 MultiHead is supplied with one detector head
and reflector for single beam operation from 8 to 50 meters.
Up to 3 additional detector heads can be added to the
controller to enable larger or more complex areas to be
protected (Subject to local codes and standards).
The Fireray 5000 when used in its low power mode can be
interfaced to the MZX Fire Controller using the BDM800
module.
Getting the system operational is simplified by a number of
groundbreaking features that combine to make the FIRERAY
5000 the quickest and easiest detector of its type to install.
Once the detector heads are connected, using the Easifit
First Fix system, an integral LASER, which is aligned along
the optical path of the beam, can be activated. This allows
the reflective prism to be sighted quickly and with
confidence. Once the LASER has been used to coarsely
align the beam, the AutOptimise beam alignment system
takes over and automatically steers the beam into the
optimum position.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Controller:
202w x 230h x 81d mm 0.9 Kg
Detector:
134w x 135h x 134d mm - 0.5 Kg
Additional detector head 2mA @ 24VDC
Operating Current
(low power mode):
10mA @ 24VDC
Operating Voltage:
14 to 28VDC
IP Rating:
IP54
Operating Temp:
-20 to +55oC
Humidity:
93% RH (non condensing) max
516.015.020
516.015.021
516.015.007
Chapter 2 Page 32
Fire Catalogue
FireRay 5000 System (50m)
FR 5000 Detector Head (50m)
FireRay Reflector 100 x 100mm
4 reflectors are required for distances from
50 to 100m
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 33
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Range 5 metres up to 100 metres
Area coverage up to 1400m2
Selectable sensitivity
Self-check and automatic compensation
Manual or automatic reset
Optional Mx Technology loop powered interface module
(BDM800)
Suitable for both conventional and addressable fire
systems
Fire/fault interface to MX controller
Low current consumption
Flexible system design options
Robust metal construction
Designed to conform to BS5839 Part 5
Optical Beam Smoke Detectors
The FIRE-RAY 2000 is an active infra-red smoke detector.
The system comprises of three base elements i.e. a
transmitter, receiver and Control Unit.
Analysis of the modulated infra-red beam by the Control
Unit determines whether smoke is present, and if so
generates an alarm signal.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Technical Specification
516.015.006.A
Transmitter/Receiver
Control Unit
BDM800 (with M520 encl.)
Dimensions(mm)
Height Width Depth
95
75
115
260
210
80
87
148
14
Voltage Range-
Fireray 2000
BDM800
Fireray 2000 Quiescent Current
Fireray 2000 Alarm Current
Operating Temp. Range Humidity
(Fireray 2000 & LPBD521)
Fireray 2000 Enclosure
Fireray
BDM800
Weight
(Kg)
0.4
2.25
0.1
516.015.006.T
920450
516.015.007
516.015.008
+11.5 to +28Vdc
40V Loop Power
<13mA
<20mA
FireRay2000 optical beam smoke detector
VdS approved, ADT Branded
FireRay2000 optical beam smoke detector
VdS approved, Thorn Branded
FireRay2000 -UL Optical beam smoke
detector - UL approved
FireRay2000 Retro-Reflector 100 x100mm
FireRay2000 Alignment tool
-10oC to +55oC
-10oC to +55oC
up to 95% RH
(Non-condensing)
IP54
FireRay Optical Beam Smoke Detector Mounting Accessories
There are a range of mounting accessories available for use with FireRay® Optical Beam Smoke Detectors. These
accessories will help reduce installation times and provide a professional mounting solution when faced with challenging
building internals.
The large prism plate will securely
The Universal Mounting bracket can be used
mount 4 prisms and is designed
with the Fireray 5000 detector head and the 1
to be used in conjunction with the
or 4 way prism plates to enable the detector
Universal Mounting Bracket (not
head or prism plates to be easily mounted
included)
and adjusted when fixing to angled walls or
cladding.
The Flat Mounting plate is a metal plate
which will support a single prism or 4 prisms,
the side mounting holes are compatible with
Unistrut® racking systems.
The small prism plate will securely
mount a single prism and is
designed to be used in
conjunction with the Universal
Mounting Bracket (not included)
Product Codes
5000-005
5000-006
5000-007
5000-008
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Universal Mounting Bracket
Flat Mounting Plate for 1 to 4 Prisms
Prism Mounting Plate for 4 Prisms
Prism Mounting Plate for 1 Prism
Chapter 2 Page 33
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 34
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Linear Heat Detectors
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
Easy and cost effective installation
Good sensitivity with adjustable alarm threshold
Open and short circuit monitoring
Suited for outdoor and indoor applications
Can be used in hazardous areas
Mechanical protection is provided for cables in areas
where damage may occur
• Chemical resistance sheathing is available for areas
where petro-chemical corrosion may occur.
Linear Heat Detection
The LD40 linear heat detection system is used to monitor
fire (or overheat) conditions in confined or polluted areas or
where there are adverse or unusually variable environmental
conditions.
The sensor cable is unaffected by dust, moisture or
vibration and requires little maintenance.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Dimensions:
Weight:
Operating Temp:
Relative humidity:
Rating:
Operating Voltage:
Quiescent Current:
516.016.005
Ceiling Clip
Pipe Clip
178H x 130W x 75D mm
0.55Kg
-25°C to +70°C
Up to 98% RH non-condensing
IP55
+8 to +30Vdc
60-80μA
Edge Clip
516.016.006
516.016.010
516.016.011
516.016.012
516.016.201
516.016.202
516.016.203
516.016.204
516.016.205
516.016.206
516.016.207
516.016.208
516.016.209
516.016.210
LD40 High resistance sensor cable
blue - 200M reel
LD40 High resistance sensor cable
black - 200M reel (Nylon sheath suitable
for petrochemical exposure)
LD40 EOL Termination kit (PK10)
LD40 In-line Jointing kit
LD40 Analyser module with conventional
detection zone interface
B6782-003 EDGE CLIP 2-3mm WEB
B6782-024 EDGE CLIP 3-8mm WEB
B6782-025 EDGE CLIP 8-13mm WEB
B6782-026 EDGE CLIP 14-20mm WEB
B6782-004 'T' CLIP
B6782-005 PIPE CLIP
B6782-023 'V' CLIP
B6782-008 NEOPRENE SLEEVE
B6782-151 THERMAL SPACER
B6782-152 THERMAL SPACER
Thermal Spacer
V Clip
Chapter 2 Page 34
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 35
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Detector Bases & Accessories
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
Optional short circuit isolator in each base
Loop powered sounder bases
Remote indication LEDs
Standard and stainless steel duct probes
Optional conduit entry backboxes
Protective wire cages
Detector Bases and Ancillaries
The 800 Series of low profile detectors provides a
comprehensive range of highly effective and aesthetically
pleasing fire, smoke and heat detectors with worldwide
approvals.
The unique design and leading edge technology of the
detectors goes beyond the detection technology itself.
The range of detector bases is designed to make low profile
detector installations cost effective, aesthetically pleasing
and easy to install and maintain – thus minimising
disruption.
09/10
The detector bases include standard universal bases, which
have no integral electronics, thus making them low cost and
low maintenance. Alternatively, a range of functional bases
incorporates sounders, relays and line isolators to provide a
cost effective method of adding functions and flexibility to
the fire detection installation.
Duct probe units are specially designed to enable optimum
performance even at low air velocity and are also available
in stainless steel.
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 35
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 36
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
The standard universal detector bases are compatible with new 800 Series MX detectors as well as the Series 600 low
profile detectors. The standard bases have no electronics and even when the detectors are connected to the bases, they
can be electrically disconnected and left in a ‘park’ position. This enables wiring integrity tests to take place without any
damage to electronics. When used with 800 Series MX VIRTUAL detectors the address flag automatically transfers to the
base, thus the address label remains with the base even if the detector is changed or replaced. An optional, tool
removable locking pin allows the detector to be fixed in place to prevent tampering.
5B-5” Universal Detector Base
This is the most commonly used
base for MX applications. It is fully
EN54 and Vds approved for use with
the MX detector range and can also
be used for the Minerva M900
addressable and Series 600 conventional ranges of detectors.
If used it will require a separately
supplied tool to remove a detector
from the base. Optional address
label flags are automatically transferred from detector to base when
the detector is inserted. Following
detector removal flags are retained in
the base to provide a permanent
address indicator.
Features
• Drive a remote indicator
• Detector locking pin with every
base
• Temporary Park position
• The 5’ Universal Detector Base
accepts an address label flag
from the Detector when used with
MX Detector Ranges
• Fit directly to a British or
European conduit box or directly
onto the ceiling.
• Break-outs for surface installation
Product Code
517.050.017
5B 5” Universal Base LPCB
4” Universal Base
4” Universal base. Used where
space is limited or compatibility with
older systems is required
Product Code
517.050.401
4” base
5BI-5” MX Isolator Base
The 5BI isolator base incorporates all
the features of the 5B but it is used
exclusively with digital addressable
MX Technology® detection loops.
They allow any or all detectors to be
upgraded to incorporate bidirectional short circuit isolation.
Used with every detector, they will
ensure that no detector is lost in the
event of an open or short circuit loop
fault. A built in amber LED indicates
when isolation has been activated.
Isolation will automatically reset
when the fault is removed.
Chapter 2 Page 36
Features
. All of the mechanical features of
the 5B 5” Universal detector
base.
. Provides upstream and
downstream isolation as
appropriate
. LED indication of isolation in
operation
Fire Catalogue
Product Code
517.050.018
5BI 5” Isolator Base LPCB
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 37
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
The range of standard bases is supplemented by this selection of sounder bases, relay bases and accessories, including
loop powered sounder base for use on MX technology controllers. In addition, changes to the building during it’s life can
be easily adapted to, by retrofitting sounders and relay outputs to existing detection points.
When functional bases are fitted to universal bases, they automatically lock into position. Removal is then achieved using
the detector removal tool. This feature ensures that the detector and functional bases are removed separately.
Tyco MKII Sounder Base
A new low current range of sounder
bases for use with Conventional and
Addressable Fire Alarm Control
Panels.
Product Codes
516.800.911
901SB Universal Sounder Base
516.800.910
802SB MX Loop Powered Sounder
Base
516.800.913
812SB MX Loop Powered UL
Sounder Base
516.800.912
912SB Universal UL Sounder Base
517.050.022
Volume Pot Spare Cover (1 sheet of
144)
517.050.005
4” Detector Base Locking Pin Kit
(PK100)
Features
• Manufactured to EN54 part 3
• Integral sounder and detector
base
• Volume and tone adjustable after
installation
• Low Power Synchronisation
• Do not require use of a standard
base (maybe installed directly
onto a standard besa box)
SAB 801 Sounder Addressable Beacon
The SAB 801 Sounder Addressable
Beacon is an MX Addressable
Beacon that fits into the Standard
Minerva Universal Base. Alternatively
the SAB may be fitted to the 802SB,
812SB, 901SB and 912SB Sounder
Bases to enable the MX Control
Panel to communicate with and
control these sounder bases and
also provide a Flashing Beacon
effectively turning the 802SB, 812SB,
901SB and 912SB into a combined
addressable loop powered sounder
and beacon.
09/10
The SAB is suitable for wall or ceiling
mounting. Sound selection and
tones will be as per the 802SB,
812SB, 901SB and 912SB.
Fire Catalogue
Product Code
516.800.956
SAB 801 Low Power Sounder
Addressable Beacon (Compatible
with Consys Version 8.1 and above)
Chapter 2 Page 37
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 38
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
801RB - Functional Relay Base
The 801RB provides dual relay
contacts for signalling external
devices on MX addressable systems.
A very low operating current even
when the relay is energised enables
the relay base to be used without
any additional power. The dual
contacts are under the control of a
programmable output, through the
powerful cause and effect software.
Features
• Dual pole 24V DC relay contact
(60VA)
• Very low power consumption
(<20μA except startup)
Product Code
516.800.905
801RB Relay base
Sounder volume can be easily varied
between the maximum 90dBA and
minimum 68dBA-volume settings,
using this simple, functional tool.
Product Code
517.050.015
Volume Adjustment Tool
Volume Adjustment Tool
A simple Volume Adjustment Tool,
specific to the task of sounder
volume selection on the “variablevolume” range of Tyco MKII Sounder
Bases.
Note: Sounder Bases are supplied
with the volume pre-set to maximum
volume.
Chapter 2 Page 38
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 39
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Detector Ancillaries
Features
• Provides clear identification of address
• Colour coded
• Flag remains on base
800 Series MX Address Flag
Most MX detection panels incorporate additional fail safe
software features to ensure that incorrect detector
positioning does not compromise the system. Address flags
are supplied in packs of 100. Labels are provided on sheets
of 250 in eight colours to enable quick identification
between different loops.
The 800 Series detectors incorporate a feature, which
automatically transfers the address flag to the detector
base, when the detector is plugged into the base. On
removal of the detector the address flag remains on the
ceiling, thus ensuring that detectors are not accidentally
returned to the wrong detector base following service
routines.
Product Codes
516.800.915
516.800.931
516.800.932
516.800.933
516.800.934
MX Address flags (pack of 100)
Address flag labels Loop A - White
Address flag labels Loop B - Yellow
Address flag labels Loop C - Purple
Address flag labels Loop D - Green
516.800.935
516.800.936
516.800.937
516.800.938
Address
Address
Address
Address
flag
flag
flag
flag
labels
labels
labels
labels
Loop
Loop
Loop
Loop
E - Grey
F - Blue
G - Orange
H - Red
Features
• Colour coded for Easy Loop Identification
• Space for Zonal Label
• Strong Adhesive Backing
Callpoint & Ancillary Address Labels
Detectors have a special address flag for carrying the
address labels - detailed in the detector section. For other
devices or on detectors where zone information is also
required a series of address labels are available.
Numbered 1 to 250, the address labels are available in 8
different colours to distinguish between different loops. In
addition small zone labels can be fixed to the address
labels.
Product Codes
Zone Labels
599.047.011
599.047.012
599.047.013
599.047.014
599.047.015
599.047.016
599.047.018
599.047.019
599.047.020
599.047.021
599.047.022
09/10
Zone
Zone
Zone
Zone
Zone
Zone
Zone
Zone
Zone
Zone
Zone
labels
labels
labels
labels
labels
labels
labels
labels
labels
labels
labels
-
Zones
Zones
Zones
Zones
Zones
Zones
Zones
Zones
Zones
Zones
Zones
1 - 16
17 - 32
33 - 48
49 - 64
65 - 80
81 - 100
101 - 120
121 - 140
141 - 160
161 - 180
181 - 200
599.047.023
599.047.024
Zone labels - Zones 201 - 220
Zone labels - Zones 221 - 240
Address Labels
599.047.030
599.047.031
599.047.032
599.047.033
599.047.005
599.047.006
599.047.007
599.047.008
Address
Address
Address
Address
Address
Address
Address
Address
Fire Catalogue
Labels
Labels
Labels
Labels
Labels
Labels
Labels
Labels
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
-
250
250
250
250
127
127
127
127
Loop
Loop
Loop
Loop
Loop
Loop
Loop
Loop
A - White
B - Yellow
C - Purple
D - Green
E - Grey
F - Blue
G - Orange
H - Red
Chapter 2 Page 39
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 40
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
801RIL - Remote Indication LED
All detector bases have the ability to
drive a remote LED in the event that
the installed position of the detector
is not easily visible. The 801RIL is
primarily designed for LPCB
influenced markets but is compatible
with all 800 Series detectors.
Features
• UK Single gang mounting
• High intensity red LED
Product Code
516.800.908
801RIL remote indication LED
800HL - Indication Lamp
The 800HL remote indicator lamp
provides a larger indicator for use in
place of the RIL when longer
distances are involved or in VdS
influenced markets. Typically used to
indicate the source of an alarm in
buildings with long corridors eg.
Hotels, hospitals, apartments.
Product Code
516.800.909
800HL indication lamp
EM-5B Euro Mounting
The euro-mounting base provides a
matching back box, which allows the
5” bases to be ceiling mounted with
conduit entries for standard 18 and
21mm conduit.
Features
• 2 x 18mm conduit entries
• 2 x 21mm conduit entries
• Fits all 5” Bases
• Fitted with terminal, if more are
required use optional accessory
kit
Product Codes
517.050.604
EM5B mounting base
517.050.612
Base Accessory terminal kit
(pack of 10)
with 1 terminal. If more are required,
use the optional base accessory kit.
Product Codes
517.050.603
Deckhead mounting
517.050.612
Base accessory terminal kit
(pack of 10)
DHM-5B - Deck Head Mounting
Where the detectors are mounted in
humid and environmentally
challenging situations such as
marine or offshore installations, the
DHM 5B deck head mount provides
a sealed waterproof mounting which
protects the base electrical
connections. Can be screwed, bolted
or welded to the deckhead. Supplied
Features
• 4 x 20mm gland entries
• Fits ALL 5” bases
• IP55 with supplied gasket
Protective Detector Cage
Robust steel protective cage for
Series 800 detector ranges using the
5” bases. Ideal for schools and
sporthalls or whenever detectors
need protection.
Product Code
517.050.614
CW-5B Detector Cage
Strong coated steel construction with
4 point fitting.
Protective Detector Sounder Base Cage
White powder coated steel protective
cage for Series 800 Detectors fitted
with a sounder base. Internal
dimensions: 120mm dia x 80mm
deep.
Chapter 2 Page 40
Product Code
517.050.011
Steel Protective Detector Cage
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 41
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Duct Probe Air Sampling
Where smoke within duct work needs to be detected these duct probe units provide an economical solution, for use
with 800 series detectors.
SMP Duct Probe Units
The SMP Duct Probe Units are designed to be installed in air conditioning
supply and exhaust ducts for the purpose of monitoring the airflow for
smoke and combustion products.
The SMP69 probe units are designed to accept and operate with the 800
series detectors. For general applications it is recommended that
photoelectric smoke detectors rather than ionisation smoke detectors are
used.
Warning
Duct probe units sited in the common duct work
to several extract grills may fail to respond to
smoke from any one extract due to the effect of
dilution. The SMP units will not respond to airflow
of less than 1.5m/sec.
Height
Width
Length
Weight
The SMP stainless steel probe unit is designed to withstand the more
demanding environments of the offshore oil and gas industries.
The units are designed to operate in airspeeds of 1.5 to 25 metres per
second. A range of sampling tubes from 525mm to 1575mm is available
SMP69
90mm
150mm
225mm
1.2Kg
Technical Specification
Operating temperature:
-20°C to +70°C
Storage temperature:
-25°C to +80°C
Relative Humidity:
0 to 95%
SMP69
Stainless steel 316 housing
with transparent
polycarbonate cover
SMP69 Duct Probe Air Sampling - Stainless Steel
Product Codes
517.025.035
SMP69 Stainless Steel Duct Probe
unit and universal detector base for
Series 600/800 Detectors.
517.025.028
DPS450 Probe tube stainless steel
450mm and exhaust
517.025.029
DPS600 Probe tube stainless steel
600mm and exhaust
517.025.030
DPS750 Probe tube stainless steel
750mm and exhaust
09/10
517.025.031
DPS900 Probe tube stainless steel
900mm and exhaust
577.025.032
DPS1200 Probe tube Stainless Steel
1200mm and exhaust
517.025.033
DPS1500 Probe tube stainless steel
1500mm and exhaust
Fire Catalogue
Datasheet - Product Code PSF92
“SMP69 Duct Probe Unit”
Manual - Vol01B-06-D1 “Detectors
Fire Manual
Chapter 2 Page 41
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 42
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Built-in MZX Detector base
DPK4 - with built-in MZX detector base 5" - 5B
DPK4I - with built-in MZX detector base 5" - 5BI
• DPK4 is suitable for addressable and conventional
systems
• DPK4I with built-in line isolator for use with MZX
Technology® systems
• Suitable for air velocities from 1 m/s to 20 m/s
• Can be used in combination with a wide range of optical
smoke detectors e.g. 801PH, 813P, 601P or 601PH
• One-pipe air sampling system simplifies installation
• Range of aluminium probe tubes are available for ducts
up to 2700 mm
• Transparent lid allows detector to be seen
• Test hole on cover
• Sensitive flow indicator
• Simple service and maintenance
• Installer friendly connection of cables
• Easy installation of duct probe tubes
DPK4 Duct Probe
The DPK4 and DPK4I duct probe units have been
developed to detect smoke in ventilation ducts. They offer
significant benefits in terms of performance and installation.
The system comprises a single duct probe tube and
housing specially designed for optimum airflow through the
smoke detector and suitable for use in incoming, outgoing
and circulation air ducts of ventilation and conditioning
systems.
The duct probes can operate across a wide range of airflow
speeds and are especially recommended for installations in
ducts with air flow velocities between 1 m/s and 20 m/s.
Unlike more traditional duct probe units that employ an inlet
and exhaust tube with sampling holes, the DPK4 and DPK4I
units uses a highly efficient single sampling tube that is
slotted along its length. This allows the sampling tubes to
be cut to the desired length whilst maintaining maximum
efficiency.
The transparent cover gives clear visibility of the detector,
its LED indication and airflow indicator. A red plastic flag is
fixed inside the housing providing a simple but effective
confirmation that there is no leakage and that the air flow
from the air duct is in fact passing through the housing.
In order to reduce the time required to test the duct probe
detector during routine maintenance, an aperture is
provided that allows aerosol test gas to be directed at the
detector without having to dismantle the unit.
Accessories
Tyco Safety Products offer 3 lengths of the duct probe
tubes. The tube is made of aluminium and can easily be
shortened to suit the span of the air duct. Where the unit is
mounted on insulated or circular air ducts, the DPKM
mounting bracket is required.
Product Codes
517.025.049
517.025.050
517.025.051
517.025.052
517.025.053
517.025.054
517.025.055
DPK4 - Duct Probe with MZX detector
base 5" - 5B
DPK4I - Duct Probe with MZX detector
base 5" with isolator - 5BI
DPK600 - Duct Probe Tube 600 mm
DPK1500 - Duct Probe Tube 1500 mm
DPK2800 - Duct Probe Tube 2800 mm
DPKM - Duct Probe Mounting Bracket
Spare Filters for DPK4/DPK4I (PK of 10)
Detector supplied separately
Chapter 2 Page 42
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 43
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
MX Addressable Input/Output Modules
APM800 Addressable Power Supply Monitor
The APM800 is an MX addressable
power supply monitoring module
which is usually used with the
PSM800/820/821 power supply
module to make an addressable
power supply. The APM800 is
designed to fix to studs on the top of
the PSM800/820/821 The APM800
monitors the PSM800/820/821 for
mains failure, earth fault, battery
charger fault and battery fault. It can
reset the PSM800/820/821 resettable
24Vdc output and initiate a battery
test which then reports battery
voltage and current to the controller.
Technical Specification
EMC/RFI:
Equal or
exceeds
EN50081- 1 &
EN50130-4
Operating Temp.:
-20oC to +70oC
Relative Humidity:
up to 95% RH
non-condensing
Dimensions:
24H x 127W x
57D mm
Weight:
0.794Kg
Product Code
557.202.027
APM800 addressable power supply
monitor
Technical Specification
EMC/RFI:
Equal or
exceeds
EN500811 & EN50130-4
Operating Temp.:
-20oC to +70oC
Relative Humidity:
up to 95% RH
non-condensing
Dimensions:
13H x 48W x 57D mm
Weight:
100g
EOL resistor:
200 Ohm
Monitor Resistor:
100 Ohm
Product Code
555.800.001
MIM800 mini-input module
MIM800 Mini-Input Module
The MIM800 is a small MX
addressable module designed for
monitoring a single input circuit. The
MIM800 can monitor normally open
or normally closed inputs and
provides open and short circuit
monitoring of the line. The MIM800 is
designed for fitting in small devices
such as flow switches, special
detection devices and explosion
proof callpoints. A variant of the
MIM800 is used in all callpoints and
pullstations.
CIM800 Contact Input Module
The CIM800 is a flexible addressable
input-monitoring device that fits in the
standard ancillary housings. The
CIM800 provides two inputs to
current MX panels though this can be
implemented as two separately wired
spurs (Style B) or as a loop (Style A).
Both spur and loop input wiring can
be configured to monitor normally
open or normally closed inputs. In
addition both can be configured to
initiate an alarm or short circuit fault
message in the event of a short circuit
on normally open monitoring circuits.
Technical Specification
EMC/RFI:
Equal or
exceeds
EN500811 & EN50130-4
Operating Temp.:
-20oC to +70oC
Relative Humidity:
up to 95% RH
non-condensing
Dimensions:
14H x 148W x 87D mm
Weight:
100g
EOL & monitor resistor: 10k Ohms
Product Codes
555.800.002
CIM800 contact input monitor
555.800.032
CIM800 Module c/w Front Cover
Series , S100 Series, H Series,
S231F, S231F+, CP200, Series
600Compatible Zettler detectors:
M613 Series.
Product Codes
555.800.012
DIM800 detector input monitor
555.800.042
DIM800 Module c/w front cover
DIM800 Detector Input Module
The DIM800 is designed to power
and monitor a circuit of low voltage
conventional detectors and
callpoints. The detection circuit is
powered from an external 24V d.c.
supply and is reset by the MX
addressable panel. The DIM800
monitors the external 24V d.c. and
provides a fault signal if it is lost. The
input detection circuit can be wired
as one or two spur circuits (Class B),
one loop configured circuit (Class A)
or one 4 wire detection circuit.The
DIM800 is designed to be
compatible with most conventional
detection products. Compatibility
has been tested to date on the
following products: Compatible
Thorn detectors: M300 Series , M601
09/10
Technical Specification
EMC/RFI:
Equal or
exceeds
EN500811 & EN50130-4
Operating Temp.:
-20oC to
+70oC
Relative Humidity:
up to 95% RH
non-condensing
Dimensions:
14H x 148W x
87D mm
Weight:
100g
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 43
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 44
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
LIM800 Line Isolator Module
The LIM800 Ancillary Line Isolator
Module is designed to be used on all
MX addressable loops. It monitors
the line condition and upon
detection of a short circuit it isolates
the affected section whilst allowing
the rest of the addressable loop to
function normally. The LIM800
Ancillary Line Isolator Module
ensures that on a looped
addressable system a short circuit
fault cannot disable more detection
devices than would be lost on a
conventional non-addressable
system in accordance with BS5839
Part 1.
Technical Specification
EMC/RFI: Equal or exceeds
EN61000-6-3 & EN50130-4
Operating Temperature: - 25°C to
+70°C
Relative Humidity: Up to 95% RH
non-condensing
Dimensions: 14H x 148W x 87D mm
Weight: 100g
Product Codes
545.800.004
LIM800 Ancillary Line Isolator
Module
545.800.033
LIM800 Ancillary Line Isolator
Module c/w front cover
are active, and shows a yellow LED
when the timer is counting down. To
provide a warning that the delay is
nearly over, the red LED and the
buzzer will pulse 5 minutes before
the end of the delay .
The TM520 requires a separate 24V
DC supply to operate. The module is
not addressable and will therefore
not take an address on the loop.
Technical Specification
Powered:
24Vdc
Temperature Range: -10°C to +70°C
Operating Humidity: <95% RH
Dimensions:
87H x148W x
14D mm
TM520 Timer Module
The TM520 provides 2 x outputs that
can be activated based on a delay
time. If either the key-switch on the
module is activated, or a predefined
event within the control panel occurs
then a timed delay (set between 10
minutes and 2 hours 10 minutes) is
started. When the delay reaches zero
the TM520 outputs are activated. The
unit sounds an internal buzzer and
shows a red LED when the outputs
Product Code
557.180.423
TM520 timer module - non
addressable
SIO800 Single Input/Output Module
The SIO800 Single Input/Output
Module is designed to provide a
monitored input and a volt free relay
changeover output. It consists of an
input for monitoring the status of a
normally open contact and a single
changeover relay contact. The relay
is controlled by a command sent
from the Minerva MX Fire Controller
via the addressable loop.
The state of the relay
(activated,deactivated or
stuck) is reported to the Minerva MX
Fire Controller. The LED may be
turned ON or OFF by the controller
during a relay activated condition.
Technical Specification
EMC/RFI:
Product Family standard EN50130-4
in respect of Conducted
Disturbances, Radiated Immunity,
Electrostatic Discharge, Fast
Transients and Slow High Energy.
61000-6-3for Emissions.
Operating Temperature: -25°C to
+ 70°C
Relative Humidity: Up to 95% RH
non-condensing
Dimensions:
14H x 148W x
87D mm
Weight:
105g
Product Codes
555.800.063
SIO800 Single Input/Output Module
555.800.064
SIO800 Single Input/Output Module
c/w Front Cover
4-20mA interfaced device.
Compatible with MXConsys version
15 or later
Product Codes
577.800.006
DDM800 Universal Fire and Gas
Module
577.800.036
DDM800 Universal Fire and Gas
Module c/w front cover
577.800.056
DDM800 Universal Fire and Gas
Module housed in IP55 D800
enclosure
557.800.057
DDM800 Detector Removal End of
Line Resistor (pack of 10)
DDM800 Universal Fire and Gas Module
The DDM800 provides the ability to
connect and interface 2 zones of
conventional 2 wire fire detectors or
two 4-20mA sensors to the MX Fire
alarm controllers.
When used to interface conventional
detection devices, Open & Short
circuit and device removal
monitoring is provided.
Intrinsically safe (IS) detection is
supported when used with a
galvanic isolator
An integral line isolator is
incorporated in the module.
Loop powered or 24vdc operation.
The 4-20mA interface can be used to
monitor devices such as gas
detectors, temperature alarms or any
Chapter 2 Page 44
Technical Specification
EMC/RFI Equal or exceeds
EN61000-6-3 & EN50130-4
Operating Temperature -25ºC to
+70ºC
Operating Humidity Up to 95% RH
non-condensing
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 45
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
RIM800 Relay Interface Module
The RIM800 provides a single
programmable relay output from the
MX DIGITAL addressable loop which
can be programmed for a variety of
applications including signalling fire
conditions to plant, machinery, fire
doors, dampers & security systems.
The RIM800 relay coil is monitored.
The RIM800 relay contact is rated for
2A @ 24V d.c. but can be used to
switch mains voltage when used with
the HVR800. This unit has two optoisolated terminals specifically for
driving the HVR800.
Technical Specification
EMC/RFI:
Equal or
exceeds
EN61000.6.3& EN50130-4
Operating Temp.:
-20oC to +70oC
Relative Humidity:
up to 95% RH
noncondensing
Dimensions:
14H x 148W x
87D mm
Weight:
100g
Quiescent Current: 200μA
Relay contacts:
2A @ 24V d.c.
Product Codes
568.800.003
RIM800 relay interface module
568.800.033
RIM800 Module C/W Front Cover
Technical Specification
EMC/RFI:
Equal or
exceeds
EN61000.6.3 &
EN50130-4
Operating Temp.:
-20oC to +70oC
Relative Humidity:
up to 95% RH
noncondensing
Dimensions:
26.5H x 42W x
74D mm
Relay Contacts:
Up to 10A @
250Va.c.
Product Codes
568.800.004
HVR800 high voltage relay
568.800.034
HVR800 in isolated D800 housing
Technical Specification
EMC/RFI:
Equal or
exceeds
EN61000.6.3
& EN50130-4
Operating Temp.:
-20oC to +70oC
Relative Humidity:
up to 95% RH
noncondensing
Dimensions:
14H x 148W x
87D mm
Weight:
100g
Output rating:
2A @ 24V d.c.
EOL resistor:
27k 1/2W
Product Codes
577.800.005
SNM800 sounder notification module
577.800.035
SNM800 Module c/w Front cover
Dimensions:
Product Codes
577.800.011
LPS800 Loop Powered Sounder
module
577.800.041
LPS800 Module c/w front cover
HVR800 High Voltage Relay Module
The HVR800 module is a
non-addressable device which
allows a low current mains rated
relay to switch up to 10A.
Alternatively a low voltage drive
signal such as that provided by
the RIM800 or 80 way mimic can
be used to switch the integral mains
relay via the opto-isolated input.
SNM800 Sounder Notification Module
The SNM800 is a remote
addressable sounder circuit output
device capable of switching sounder
and speaker circuits up to 2A @ 24V
d.c. or provide a monitored output
facility for other applications. These
can be used in addition to the two
circuits provided as standard on
most MX detection panels.
The SNM800 can support sounder
circuits wired as a spur (Class B –
Style Y) or in a loop configuration
(Class A – Style Z).
The SNM800 can be configured with
a RIM800 to provide a secure
monitored extinguishing release
solenoid control.
LPS800 Loop Powered Sounder Module
The LPS800 provides a single
monitored sounder output circuit
with up to 75mA of power sourced
from the MX panel.
Weight:
Output rating:
14H x 148W x
87D mm
100g
75mA @ 24V
d.c. max
Technical Specification
EMC/RFI:
Equal or
exceeds
EN61000.6.31
& EN50130-4
Operating Temp:
-20oC to +70oC
Relative Humidity:
up to 95% RH
non- condensing
NOTE: Each MX Digital Loop can
provide up to 495mA for loop
powered sounders and modules
SB520 Sounder Booster Module
The SB520 sounder booster module
enables the SNM800 to drive circuits
with higher currents whilst
maintaining the reverse polarity
integrity line monitoring.
Technical Specification
EMC/RFI:
Equal or
exceeds
EN61000.6.31
& EN50130-4
Operating Temp.:
-20oC to +70oC
09/10
Relative Humidity:
Dimensions:
Weight:
Output rating:
up to 95% RH
non--condensing
14H x 148W x
87D mm
100g
15A @ 24V
d.c./10A Max.
per terminal
Product Codes
577.001.023
SB520 Sounder Booster Module
577.001.033
SB520 Module c/w Front Cover
Non addressable
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 45
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 46
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
BDM800 Beam Detector Module - Loop Powered
The BDM800 Beam Detector Module
is designed to interface the FIRERAY
50R or the 100R reflective beam
detector to the MX Digital
Addressable Loop. The BDM800
provides power from the loop,
monitors the Fire and Fault outputs
of the detector and also monitors
inter-connections for open and short
circuit faults. The BDM800 can also
be used with the FIRERAY 2000
active infrared beam detector.
Supplied fitted in a standard double
gang ancillary housing, the BDM800
greatly simplifies the wiring normally
associated with beam detection.
The considerable cost of providing
local power supplies that satisfy the
stringent requirements of BS5839
part 1 is eliminated.
Features
• Power Beam detectors directly
from the MX Digital loop
• Reduced wiring and installation
costs
• Monitors beam detector for fire
and fault
• Inter-connection monitored for
open and short circuit faults
• LPCB and VdS approved (pend
ing)
• Can be installed to BS5839 part 1
2002
• On board LED indicates polling
and active
• Use with reflective beams
FIRERAY 50R or 100R for greater
savings on installation
• Compatible with FIRERAY 2000
+ FIRERAY 5000 beam detectors
• Optional BTM800 beam terminal
tion module to further simplify
installation
Product Code
555.800.066
BDM800 Beam
Detector Module c/w Cover
BTM Beam Termination Module
In many cases it will be necessary to
site the BDM800 Beam Detector
Module some distance from the
beam detector itself. To minimise
and simplify wiring in such cases an
optional unit, the BTM800 beam termination module is available. The
BTM800 is also housed in a standard double gang ancillary cover
and has all the connections and
components required to minimise
installation time.
Features
• Simplifies the wiring between
Beam detector and BDM800
• Allows BDM800 to be sited up to
40m from the beam detector
Product Code
555.800.067
BTM800 Beam Terminal Module c/w
Cover
Features
• Normally open or normally closed
inputs
• Inputs monitored for open or
short circuit faults.
• STYLE B (short circuit gives an
alarm) or STYLE C (short circuit
gives a fault) selectable for inputs
• Provides four digital outputs
• All four outputs can drive a selfpowered high voltage relay HVR800
• Two outputs have both volt free
change over contacts and HVR
Drivers.
Operating Humidity
Up to 95% non-condensing
Dimensions (HWD):
Module 72 x 110 x 18mm
Boxed: 124.5 x 166.5 x 84.5mm
Weight:
Module 70g
Boxed 271g
MIO800 Multi-Input Output Module
The MIO800 is a general purpose
interface module for use with MX
technologyTM fire detection systems.
It allows multiple input and output
connections to be made between
external equipment and the MX
Digital loop. Three input and four
outputs are provided. Each input
and output can be programmed
independently using the MX Consys
configuration tool to provide
customised functionality.
An IP55 rated D800 style housing is
used as the standard enclosure with
the option of a DIN-rail mounting kit
for in-cabinet installations.
Technical Specification
Operating Temperature
-25°C to + 70°C
Storage Temperature
-40°C to +80°C
Relay Contact Rating
DC - 2A @ 24V dc
Product Codes
555.800.065
Multi I/O Module
557.201.401
D800 Ancillary Housing
557.201.303
Din Rail Mounting Kit
TSM800 Door Control Module
The TSM800 is used to control fire
doors in accordance with BS7273
Part 4. When activated, either by a
fire signal or by a fault or isolation
within the fire door zone, the
TSM800 will interrupt the supply to
the door holders and the doors
under control of the module will
close. The module has the provision
to monitor a contact to report to the
fire controller if the door fails to
close. The module also includes a
built-in line isolator.
This module requires MX Consys 10
or later to function.
Technical Specification
EMC/RFI: Equal or exceeds
EN61000.6.3 & EN50130-4
Operating Temp: -20oC to +70oC
Relative Humidity: up to 95% RH
non-condensing
Dimensions: 14H x 148W x 87D mm
Weight: 100g
Relay contacts: 2A @30VDC
Product Code
555.800.069
TSM800 PCB
VIO800 MX Vesda Interface
The VIO800 MX Vesda Interface will
enable all versions of the popular
LaserPLUS Detectors and 7 relay
versions of the Laser SCANNER
Detectors to be interfaced directly to
the MXDigital detection loops. 3
configurable inputs and 1 output
signal are available from the interface
enabling it to integrate fully with the
Vesda detector.
Chapter 2 Page 46
This module is designed to fit in bay
one of the Vesda Detectors.
Fire Catalogue
Product Code
516.018.014
VIO800 MX VESDA Interface
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 47
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Connects directly to the MX Digital Loop.
• Reduced installation time and cost since no external
module is required.
• Easier Programming and Commissioning – predefined in
MXconsys.
• EN60950:2000 Compliant PSU.
• EN50130-4:1996 & EN50081-1:1992 Compliant PSU.
• Mains and Fault LED Indicator on front cover.
• Output fuse protected.
• 24VDC Voltage Door Release Relay.
• Specifically designed for the safe actuation of release
mechanisms for doors.
• Satisfies the requirements of BS7273 Part 4 for category
A actuation of Fire Doors.
• Built in line isolator.
• Self monitoring operation.
• Approved to EN54-18 (Input/Output Devices) and EN5417 (Line Isolators).
MZX Compatible 4 Amp 24VDC Addressable Door Holder PSU
The MZX compatible ELM24TSM 4 Amp 24VDC
Addressable Door Control & Power Supply Unit, is designed
to provide monitoring and activation in compliance with the
most stringent local door control standards.
This Door Holder PSU is interfaced to the MZX Panels via an
integral TSM800 Door Control Module which is field
mounted inside the Door Holder PSU and connects to the
MZX Detector Loop.
Technical Specification
Product Code
Input Voltage:
Output Voltage:
Output Current:
Temperature:
Relative Humidity:
IP Rating:
Material:
Dimensions:
558.004.011
09/10
230VAC +10%/-15% 50Hz
24VDC
4 Amps Continuous
-10C to +40C
95% RH
IP41 (excluding rear face)
1.2mm white powder coated steel
230mm (W) x 200mm (H) x
80mm (D)
Fire Catalogue
ELM24TSM 4 Amp 24VDC Addressable
Door Holder PSU
Chapter 2 Page 47
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 48
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Housings
MX Ancillary Housings
A variety of ancillary housings are available to fit the 800 Series MX ancillaries. The standard sized modules are
mechanically compatible with all options. LPCB approvals are with the M520 double gang cover plate or ancillary housings.
The M520 double gang cover provides external access for the MX SERVICE TOOL to plug into the ancillary module which is
mounted in the cover. All options allow the ancillary to be programmed and tested when the cover is removed.
M520
M520 Ancillary cover for use with
800 series modules. Will fit onto a
MK style double gang back box.
Product Code
517.035.007
M520 Ancillary Cover
D800
D800 IP55 ancillary housing
140W x 120H x 70mmD incorporates
window to view module LED
Product Code
557.201.401
D800 IP55 Ancillary Housing
ANC-3 Ancillary Housing
ANC-3 MINERVA ancillary
housing - for use with M800 ancillary
modules (can accommodate up to 3
M800 modules).
340W x 290H x 90mm D
Product Code
557.180.097.A
ADT Branded
ANC-8 Ancillary Housing
ANC-8 MINERVA ancillary
housing - for use with M800 ancillary
modules, houses 8 modules,
expandable to 16 using the STK8
stacking kit.
440W x 320H x 140mm D
Product Codes
557.180.096.A
ADT Branded
557.180.095
STK8 stacking kit
DIN Rail Mounting Bracket
DIN Rail mounting bracket enables
any module which can be mounted
to a M520 ancillary cover to be DIN
rail mounted using this bracket.
Clip-on PCB mounting pillars are
included. Will fit standard 35mm DIN
Rail bracket.
Chapter 2 Page 48
Product Code
547.004.002
DIN rail mounting bracket
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 49
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
QFB/2
QFB/2 Dry lining flush mount (for
plasterboard etc) MK backbox for
use with 800 Series addressable
ancillaries using 517.035.007 cover.
Product Code
517.035.015
QFB/2 Dry lining flush mount
backbox
K2214 ALM Metal surface mount MK
backbox for use with 800 Series
addressable ancillaries using
517.035.007 cover.
Product Code
517.035.011
K2214 ALM Metal Surface Mount MK
backbox
MK K2142 White plastic surface
mount MK backbox for use with 800
Series addressable ancillaries using
517.035.007 cover.
Product Code
517.035.010
MX K2142 White plastic surface
mount backbox
8621C Steel flush mount MK backbox
for use with 800 Series addressable
ancillaries using 517.035.007 cover.
Product Code
K2214 ALM
MK K2142
8621C
517.035.014
8621C Steel Flush Mount MK
Backbox
Technical Specification
Product Code
517.035.011
517.035.010
517.035.014
517.035.015
09/10
MK Ref
K2214
K2142
8621C
QFB/2
Mounting
Surface
Surface
Flush
Flush/
Dry Lining
Dimensions
146x86x40mm
146x86x34mm
132x72x26mm
146x85x38mm
Knockouts
1x20mm rear/7x20mm sides
One rear (25x35mm)
4x20mm rear/12x20mm sides
2 top & bottom
Earth Screw Material
Yes
Steel
N/A
Plastic
Yes
Steel
N/A
Plastic
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 49
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 50
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Callpoints
Features
•
•
•
•
•
Integral LED indicator for easy identification of operation
Surface or flush mounting
Extensive range of digital addressable callpoints
Test key facility, speeds maintenance visits
Hazardous areas models available (See Special Hazards
Section)
• IP67 Waterproof models for external applications
CP Series Callpoints
A comprehensive range of callpoints for use with
addressable systems. All the callpoints are designed to
enable an alarm signal to be given by breaking a glass
element.
This operates a switch and is indicated by an LED indicator.
If required, an optional transparent hinged cover may be
installed to guard against accidental operation.
Technical Specification
(Indoor & Outdoor)
Housing:
Operating Temp.:
Outdoor
Indoor
Relative Humidity:
Chapter 2 Page 50
PC/ABS
-25oC TO +70oC
-10oC TO +55oC
up to 95% RH (non-condensing)
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 51
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Callpoints CP820/CP830 Indoor/Outdoor
Indoor Callpoint
Weight: 110g
Outdoor Callpoint
Weight: 240g
73mm
CP820 Indoor Callpoint
The CP820 is an indoor MX
addressable manual callpoint with
programmable status LED. The
CP820 is designed for LPCB
approvals and the CP820M for Marine
approvals. The CP820 provides high
speed communication to the MX
panel of a manual fire alarm.
Technical Specification
Meets BS5839 Pt.2 and pr EN54
Pt:11
EMC/RFI:
EN50130-4/
EN61000-6-3
Operating Temp.:
-10°to +55°C
Relative Humidity:
up to 95% RH
non-condensing
Dimensions:
93H x 89W
x 59.5D
(27.5 mm flush
mount)
Weight:
110g
IP Rating
24D
Product Codes
514.800.603.T
CP820 Indoor Callpoint
(Thorn Branded)
514.800.603.A
CP820 Indoor Callpoint
(ADT Branded)
514.800.603.Y
CP820 Indoor Callpoint
(TYCO Branded)
514.800.605.T
CP820M Marine Indoor Call Point
(Thorn Branded)
Technical Specification
Meets BS5839 Pt.2 and pr EN54
Pt:11
EMC/RFI:
EN50130-4/
ENG61000-6-3
Operating Temp.:
-25° to +70°C
Relative Humidity:
up to 95% RH
non-condensing
Dimensions:
93H x 97.5W x
73Dmm
Weight:
240g
IP Rating
67
Product Codes
514.800.604.T
CP830 Outdoor Callpoint
(Thorn Branded)
514.800.604.A
CP830 Outdoor Callpoint
(ADT Branded)
514.800.604.Y
CP830 Outdoor Callpoint
(TYCO Branded)
514.800.606.T
CP830M Marine Outdoor Callpoint
(Thorn Branded)
CP830 Outdoor Callpoint
The CP830 is an outdoor MX
addressable manual callpoint with
programmable status LED. The
CP830 is designed for LPCB
approvals and the CP830M for Marine
approvals. The CP830 provides high
speed communication to the MX
panel of a manual fire alarm.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 51
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 52
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Callpoint Ancillaries
Product Codes
90-107
Red M141 spacer for red CP200/800
KAC callpoints
515.001.045
Test keys for all MCP and CP style callpoints
515.001.128
Callpoint hinged cover for use on
MCP callpoints models (Colour Clear)
515.001.026
Black callpoint bezel for CP200/800
models.
Ancillaries - Back Boxes
Product Codes
515.001.021
Standard Red surface mounting back
box for MCP & CP indoor callpoints
Unless stated the indoor callpoints are supplied
as flush mount units. The range is approved for
use with the standard backbox. However, SR2-T
backboxes are also available.
10-115
SR2-T Optional Back Box (2
terminals)
Callpoint Spare Glasses - Current
Product Codes
515.001.119
EN54 Part 11 Spare Glass for MCP
and CP series Callpoints (Pack of 5)
515.001.127
Deformable operating unit "glass" for
use in place of glasses, for kitchens
or other areas where glass is not
acceptable. For MCP callpoints only.
515.001.025
CP200/500/900 Glasses, clear English
text on white background. No logo
(Pack of 5).
Chapter 2 Page 52
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 53
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Prevents accidental operation of callpoints
• Strong polycarbonate construction
• Optional break seal kit
STOPPER
The callpoint STOPPER provides protection from malicious or
accidental activation of manual callpoints. Available for flush or
surface mounted callpoints the ‘STOPPER’ is also available
with optional high pitch sounder which is activated when the lid
is lifted.
An optional ‘Break-Seal’ fitting kit allows ‘Break-Seals’ to be
used to provide extra protection.
Product Code
515.001.029
515.001.030
515.001.036
515.001.034
515.001.035
515.001.031
515.001.032
Ref
STI6530
STI6531
STI6535
STI1230
STI3150
STI6532
STI6533
STOPPER
Flush
Surface
4
4
4
4
WARNING:- Break seals only to be fitted by agreement with
relevant fire authorities.
The STOPPER is suitable for all callpoints up to 100mm
square.
STOPPER II
4
4
4
STOPPER Dimensions
With Sounder
Weatherproof
4
4
4
4
Product Code
515.001.033
IPO36 Break Seal Kit
(pack of 1)
Flush Fit
Surface Fit
(+30mm)
Stopper
STI6530
Stopper with Sounder STI6532
Millimetres
A 137
B 140
C 104
D
45
E 12.5
F 12.5
G 185
H 12.5
STI6531
STI6533
STOPPER
STOPPER II
Max. Callpoint Size 100 x 100mm 160 x 160 mm
Max. Callpoint Depth
57.5
120
(+30mm Surface)
STOPPER II Dimensions
Millimetres
A
70
B
16
C 197
D
50
E 178
F 146
G 228
H 254
09/10
Stopper II Surface Fit - STI1230
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 53
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 54
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Strong polycarbonate construction
• Will accommodate weatherproof callpoints
• Tamper resistant
STOPPER II
STOPPER II is constructed as the STOPPER from tough
injection moulded polycarbonate. Physically larger than the
STOPPER the STOPPER II extends the number of products
to which these tough multi-purpose covers can protect.
STOPPER II can also be fitted with an integral battery
powered sounder which activates if the cover is lifted.
The STOPPER II is suitable for callpoints up to 160mm
square.
It consists of a strong tamper-proof clear polycarbonate
cover and frame that fits easily over such products as break
glass callpoints.
Product Code
515.001.034
STI1230 Surface Fit STOPPER II
Features
• Strong polycarbonate construction
• Provides environmental protection
• Ideal for offshore environments
Weather STOPPER & Weather STOPPER II
The Weather STOPPER and Weather STOPPER II extends
the life of weather exposed devices, such as break glass
callpoints, by offering protection against harsh conditions
and environments. Experience has shown that this
protective cover can extend the life of products installed in
saline atmospheres, such as oil rigs and ship decks.
While offering environmental protection the Weather
STOPPER and Weather STOPPER II are constructed from
tough durable polycarbonate which will also guard against
tampering, vandalism or accidental operation of devices
such as emergency switches.
Product Codes
515.001.036
515.001.035
Chapter 2 Page 54
Fire Catalogue
STI6535 Surface fit Weather
STOPPER
STI3150 Surface fit Weather
STOPPER II
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 55
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Smoke Beam/CCTV Guard
The Smoke Beam/CCTV Guard is
manufactured from tough coated
steel rod and is designed to protect
projected beam detectors or CCTV
cameras from vandalism or
accidental damage.
Suitable for use with System Sensor,
Hochiki and Fireray 2000 detectors.
Product Code
516.015.009
STI9625 Smoke beam/CCTV guard
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
260H x 200W x
321D mm
Keybox
This tough polycarbonate breakglass
keybox is available to protect
emergency keys.
09/10
Product Code
515.001.043
STI6720 Keybox with printed glass
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 55
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 56
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Sounders & Beacons
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wide range of both bells and electronic sounders
High sound output characteristics
Low current consumption
Clean lines, modern styling
Easy to install, low installation costs
Weatherproof units for outdoor use
Distinct sounds are available
Motorised and Solenoid bells available
Wide range of voltages available
Sounders
A range of sounders to meet a wide variety of alarm
applications where loud, penetrating and distinctive
warnings must be given to alert people of fire situations.
In addition, multi-tone electronic sounders can give a variety
of sounds to signal other conditions e.g.“extinguishing gas
release imminent,” etc.
Note: For I.S. & Flameproof sounders, please see the special hazards section in Chapter 10.
Chapter 2 Page 56
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 57
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• High output programmable sounder base and sounder
beacon base
• One point of installation for detector, isolator, sounder &
beacon
• Loop powered from the MX Technology® Digital Loop
• High brightness Multi-LED Beacon
• Software programmable
• 15 Tones and 2 Flash Rates
• Integral line isolator
• RSM (Reflective Sound Monitoring)
• Can be used as a standalone device using the sounder
blanking cap
• Optional surface mount plastic conduit adaptor
Sounder/Beacon and Sounder Bases
One Point of Installation – Unique Solution with Huge
Savings
Combining a detector base, sounder, beacon and line
isolator in one low cost unit will result in a dramatic
reduction in the final installation cost. Typically 40% to 55%
of the installation costs per point can be saved. This
presents an exciting opportunity for sellers in the DDA
compliant market. This is achieved without the need for
specialist high cost detector heads as standard 800 series
Minerva® MX detectors are used.
Unique
When used with the 801PC 3oTec detector ADT can provide
a completely unique solution combining fire detector, toxic
gas detector, isolator, sounder and beacon into a single very
cost effective point of installation.
Reflective Sound Monitoring (RSM) – Patented* Solution
significantly reduces Risk
Reflective Sound Monitoring is employed to monitor the
audio output of the LPSB3000 and LPAV3000 by listening to
the output and reporting any sounders that are not working.
RSM is a Tyco patented* technology and was successfully
introduced with the Minerva® MX Loop powered Symphoni
sounders. It is particularly beneficial during regular weekly
sounder tests where users can be satisfied that all their
sounders are working, even if the building is not fully
occupied at the time of the test. Failure of the beacon would
also generate a fault at the Minerva® MX control panel.
Technical Specification
System
Environment
Temp- Operating
Temp - Storage
Dimensions
Weight:
Materials
EMC
09/10
For use with MX/ZX fire alarm
controllers
Up to 95% RH (non condensing)
IP Rating 21 C EN60529
-20°C to +70°C
-25°C to +70°C
102 mm dia x 42 mm high
LPSB3000 0.160 kg
LPAV3000 0.170 Kg
Housing ABS FR & Polycarbonate
The range complies with the
following:
Product family standard EN50130-4
in respect of conducted
disturbances, radiated immunity,
electrostatic discharge, fast
transients and slow high energy
EN61000-6-3 for emissions
Loop Power Capacity
The advanced 3000 series sounders and beacons are
independently addressed and are therefore separately
controllable from the Minerva® MX Digital loop. The
maximum number that can be driven from a single loop is
dependant on the number of addresses available, the
volume selected and the flash rate of the beacon.
MXDesigner version 5.0 should be used to accurately
determine loop loading and battery size. Typically, at full
volume of 90dBA, 50 x LPSB3000 sounders or 35 x
LPAV3000 sounder beacons at 0.5Hz flash rate can be
driven by a single 1Km loop. That gives a typical maximum
of 280 sounder beacons at full volume from a single 8 loop
Minerva® MX panel.
Built-in Isolation
As the line lsolator is now integral to the device the need for
separate line isolation devices is reduced.
Tones
15 Tones are available from the sounder, which include
tones compatible with the LP Symphoni range, 802SB
sounder base and the LPBB520 (loop powered Besson
Banshee). 4 sound levels 60dB to 90dB (±3dB) and 2 flash
rates 1/2Hz & 1Hz are available
MXConsys
The AV base range of devices are fully supported by Consys
Version 14 and later, the point input dialog box provides an
easy method for setting the Tones, Volume and Flash rate of
the device. The only operation required at the device is to
set the address using the 801AP device programmer.
Product Codes
516.800.957
516.800.958
516.800.959
557.001.040.A
557.001.040.Y
LPSB3000 Sounder only L/P addressable
base
LPAV3000 Sounder beacon L/P
addressable base
DAB3-4 Mounting flange – type B for
conduit (supplied in packs of 10)
Mark 2 Sounder Cap (ADT Branded)
Mark 2 Sounder Cap (Tyco Branded)
Note: Detectors supplied separately
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 57
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 58
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Loop Powered – Reduced installation costs
• High Output/Low consumption – Lower lifetime costs
• Indoor and Outdoor models – Same sounder tones in all
areas
• Sounder/LED Beacon Version – DDA Compliant
• 16 Tones and 2 Flash rates – Suits individual
requirements
• Reflective Sound Monitoring RSM - Reassurance that ALL
sounders are working
• Integral Line Isolator – Saves cost and installation time
Loop Powered Symphoni Sounders and Sounder Beacons
Models Available
The Sounder only models are available with a red or white
housing suitable for indoor use and an IP65 rated red
housing for outdoor applications.
Built-in Isolation
As the line lsolator is now integral to the device the need for
separate line isolation devices is reduced.
Tones
16 Tones are available from the sounder, which include
tones compatible with the 802SB sounder base and the
LPBB520 (loop powered Besson Banshee). Dutch slow
whoop and the DIN 1Hz sweep are included.Two sound
levels 103dB & 90dB (±3dB).
The Audio / Visual models, which incorporate a highly
efficient LED beacon, are also available with a red or white
housing for indoor use and an IP65 rated red housing for
outdoor applications.
Reflective Sound Monitoring
Up to now sounder circuits have been monitored up to the
EOL but not the individual sounders, fault detection has
relied on human feedback from the weekly tests that should
be carried out to meet the requirements of BS5839.
The LP Symphoni utilising Reflective Sound Monitoring
(RSM) employs a transducer to actively monitor the units
sound output during the weekly sounder test and will report
back to the MX controller if it fails to detect the sounder
operating when it has been commanded to, this ensures
that the LP Symphoni range of sounders will in the unlikely
event of a fault, display it immediately on the fire controller
and is therefore not dependant upon the staff within a building reporting a sounder failure.
MXConsys
The LP Symphoni range of devices will be fully supported by
Consys Version 10 and later, the point input dialog box
provides an easy method for setting the Tones, Volume and
Flash rate of the device. The only operation required at the
device is to set the address using the 801AP device
programmer.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Operating temp
Indoor devices -10°C to +55°C
Outdoor devices -20°C to +70°C
516.800.960
IP rating
Indoor devices IP21C
Outdoor devices IP65
516.800.962
EMC
Product family standard EN50130-4 in respect of
Conducted Disturbances, Radiated Immunity,
Electrostatic Discharge, Fast Transients and Slow High
Energy
EN61000-6-3 for Emissions
516.800.964
Chapter 2 Page 58
516.800.961
516.800.963
516.800.965
Fire Catalogue
LPSY800-R L/P Symphoni (indoor
use) red
LPSY800-W LP Symphoni (indoor
use) white
LPSY865 L/P Symphoni IP65 (out
door use)
LPAV800-R L/P Symphoni
Sounder/Beacon (indoor use) red
LPAV800-W L/P Symphoni
Sounder/Beacon (indoor use) white
LPAV865 L/P Symphoni Sounder/
Beacon IP65 (outdoor use)
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 59
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Tyco MKII Sounder Base
A new low current range of sounder
bases for use with Addressable
Alarm Control Panels.
Product Codes
516.800.910
802SB MX Loop Powered Sounder
Base
516.800.913
812SB MX Loop Powered UL
Sounder Base
517.050.022
Volume Pot Spare Cover (1 sheet of
144)
517.050.005
4” Detector Base Locking Pin Kit
(PK100)
Features
• Manufactured to EN54 part 3
• Integral sounder and detector
base
• Volume and tone adjustable after
installation
• Low Power Synchronisation
• Do not require use of a standard
base (maybe installed directly
onto a standard besa box)
SAB 801 Sounder Addressable Beacon
The SAB Sounder Addressable
Beacon is an MX Addressable
Beacon that fits into the Standard
Minerva Universal Base. Alternatively
the SAB may be fitted to the 802SB,
812SB, 901SB and 912SB Sounder
Bases to enable the MX Control
Panel to communicate with and
control these sounder bases and also
provide a Flashing Beacon effectively
turning the 802SB, 812SB, 901SB and
912SB into a combined addressable
loop powered sounder and beacon.
The SAB is suitable for wall or ceiling
mounting. Sound selection and tones
will be as per the 802SB, 812SB,
901SB and 912SB.
Product Code
516.800.956
SAB 801 Low Power Sounder
Addressable Beacon (Compatible with
Consys Version 8.1 and above)
Volume Adjustment Tool
A simple Volume Adjustment Tool,
specific to the task of sounder
volume selection on the “variablevolume” range of Tyco MKII Sounder
Bases.
Sounder volume can be easily varied
between the maximum 90dBA and
minimum 68dBA-volume settings,
using this simple, functional tool.
Product Code
517.050.015
Volume Adjustment Tool
Note: Sounder Bases are supplied
with the volume pre-set to maximum
volume.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 59
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 60
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Solenoid Operated
• Designed for Long Life
• Stove Enamelled Dome
6” Red Solenoid Operated Friedland Bell
The bells are the underdome type, with a high resonance
pressed alloy-steel gong to ensure a loud clear ring tone.
The operating mechanism is fully enclosed and the gong is
red stove enamelled for long life. The bells are designed
for internal use, but gasket sealed conduit boxes can be
provided for external use.
Product Codes
576.500.014
576.500.015
577.001.002
240V Red bell 6” 240Vac solenoid
operated. ‘Fire’ text
24V Red bell 6” 24Vdc solenoid
operated. ‘Fire’ text
Weatherproof gasket box for use with
Solenoid operated bells
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
CE marked
Low current 6” bell (ONLY 11mA)
Low cost
Extra high 95dBA/m
Slim profile (53mm)
Fully suppressed and polarised
Quick and easy to install
LPCB approved to EN54 Pt 3
6” & 8” Motorised Bells
Product Codes
Model
MBF-6EV
MBF-8EV
MBA 8EV
Rated Voltage 24V d.c.
24V d.c.
24V d.c.
Rated Current
11mA
17mA
18mA
Sound output 90-95dBA
90-97dBA
91-97dBA
Operating Temp
-12 to +50°C
-10 to +50°C
Colour
Red
Weight
410g
640g
1100g with back box
576.501.039.A
576.501.039.T
576.501.040.A
576.501.044.A
576.501.044.T
576.501.045
Chapter 2 Page 60
Fire Catalogue
MBF-6EV ADT Branded
MBF-6EV Thorn Branded
MBF-8EV ADT Branded
MBA-8EV ADT Branded
MBA-8EV Thorn Branded
BBX4 (2) W/P Backbox for MBA-8 Bell
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 61
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Weatherproof Option
• Flexible Mounting Option
• Attractive Design
Electronic Solenoid Bell
Unique patented alarm bell with miniature solenoid and
integrated electronic control. No backbox required for
surface wiring.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Dimensions:
Voltage:
Typical Current:
Typ. Sound Output:
20-100 6” 24Vdc Electronic bell, weatherproof
20-101 6” 24Vdc Electronic bell - red
20-111 6” 24Vdc Electronic bell - white
09/10
6” diameter
18-30Vdc
24Vdc@30mA
94dB (A)@1m
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 61
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 62
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
•
•
•
•
•
New Aesthetic Design
32 Selectable Tones
3 Volume Settings
Push and Twist Mount
Low Current Consumption
Banshee Multi-Tone Sounder
The Banshee Multi-Tone Sounder replaces the well
established range of Banshee and Bedlam sounders.
The new range provides a compact unit capable of 32 tones
and also incorporating a volume control.
The Banshee is easily installed and is fitted with robust loop
through terminations. The design incorporates a bayonet
push and fit feature for easy installations.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
LPCB and Vds approved to EN54 pt 3
Low Current consumption
32 Tones
3 Volume settings
Rated at IP66 or IP45
Operating temperature:
-40°C to +70°C
Operating Voltage:
9 to 30 Vdc
576.501.005.A
576.501.005.T
576.501.016.A
576.501.016.T
576.501.025.A
Chapter 2 Page 62
Fire Catalogue
Banshee Multi-Tone Sounder Red, Low
profile base (ADT) (Replaces
576.501.004.A & 576.001.008.A)
Banshee Multi-Tone Sounder Red, Low
profile base (Thorn) (Replaces
576.501.004.T, 576.501.008.T &
576.501.019)
Banshee Multi-Tone Sounder Red,
Weather Proof base (ADT)
(Replaces 576.501.015.A &
576.501.024.A)
Banshee Multi-Tone Sounder Red,
Weather Proof base (Thorn) (Replaces
576.501.015.T & 576.501.024.T)
Banshee Multi-Tone Sounder White, Low
Profile base (ADT) (Replaces
576.501.033.A)
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 63
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Accessories
The combined mounting bracket for
the Besson Multi-tone Banshee and
Xenon Beacon allows quick and
neat installation of combined
sounders and beacons. The
bracket allows the following
electronic sounders to be mounted
with the range of 1W Xenon
Beacons:
• Besson Banshee
• MINERVA FIRECRYER voice
enhanced sounder
The bracket can be used with any of
the 24Vd.c 1W Xenon beacons in
red, clear, amber or blue (Part no.'s
540.001.030/031/032 & 033)
Product Code
576.501.047
Banshee/Xenon bracket
Technical Specification
Current:
4mA to 15mA
Temperature Range: -40°C to + 70°C
Dimensions:
Dia 103mm,
Height 22mm
(excluding
coverplate)
Product Code
576.501.038
Besson wafer sounder and blank
cover in white
Meeting the requirements for
BS5839 part 1, the Bedroom
Sounder range is well suited to
hotels and residential environments
where aesthetics is a prime
concern. Matching the sound
output of the Banshee range of
sounders so therefore they can be
mixed on the same site.
Features
• Low current consumption 7mA
• Dual sound options selected via
a jumper switch: ‘Continuous’
and ‘Fast Sweep’ 90dB
• Can be both Flush and Surface
mounted
• Robust terminal connectors to
accommodate up to 2.5mm2
conductors
Product Codes
576.501.032.A
Flush Mount Sounder ADT Branded
576.501.032.T
Flush Mount Sounder Thorn
Branded
This versatile range of sounders are
ideally suited for fire, safety and
security hazard warning.
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
YO3:
89H x 89W x 85D mm
YO5:
134H x 134W x 128D mm
YO8:
216H x 216W x 153D mm
Product Codes
576.501.001
YO3 Yodalarm 3” 24Vdc 100dB @
1Mtr
576.501.002
YO5 Yodalarm 5” 24Vdc 106dB @
1Mtr
576.501.003
YO8 Yodalarm 8” 24Vdc 112dB @
1Mtr
Besson Wafer Sounder
The standard Besson Wafer
sounder is supplied in white with a
blank cover included. The
specification is as follows:
Input voltage: 24V d.c. (+/-25%)
Sound Output: 60dBA/90dBA at 1m
typical (pot. Adjustable) offering the
same sound formats as the
Banshee sounder range. It can
therefore be used in conjunction
with the Banshee sounders on the
same site.
Flush Mount Bedroom Sounder
Yodalarms
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 63
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 64
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
24Vdc Symphoni Sounder
The 24Vdc Symphoni Sounder is a
general purpose internal sounder,
available either as a very high output
sounder for noisy areas, or a high
output low current sounder for
applications where power is limited.
Both versions share the same horn
and backbox which has double
cable entries for ease of installation.
The low power version has 3
selectable tones which may be
employed for one, two or three stage
alarm applications. The high output
version has 32 selectable tones and
retains full tone compatibility with the
Roshni, Squashni and Askari product
ranges.
Product Codes
576.501.200
SY/R Low Power Red Symphoni
Sounder (3 tone)
576.501.201
SY/W Low Power White Symphoni
Sounder (3 tone)
576.501.202
SYHO/R High Output Red Symphoni
Sounder (32 tone)
576.501.203
SYHO/W High Output White
Symphoni Sounder (32 tone)
Technical Specification
Model
Operation
Operating Voltage Range
Sound Output @ 1m
Volume Control
Current Consumption
Tones
Symphoni High Output
2 Hours Continuous
9-28Vdc
Up to 120dB(A)
Synchronisation
Frequency Stability
Operating Temperature
Line Monitoring Method
Construction
Ingress Protection
Weight
Synchronised Start
+/- 0.15%
-25 °C to +55°C
Polarised Input
ABS Plastic Case
IP42
0.58Kg
240mA +/- 20mA on Tone 3
1 to 32
Symphoni (Low Power)
Continuous
12-30Vdc
100dB(A) +/- 2dB(A) @24Vd. c.
Down to 80dB approx.
5mA +/- 1mA at all volumes
Alternating 990Hz/650Hz@2Hz
Continuous 990Hz
Intermittent 990Hz, On/Off@1Hz
Synchronised Start
+/- 0.5%
-25°C to +70°C
Polarised Input
ABS Plastic Case
IP42
0.212Kg
Roshni
A flexible alarm sounder for Fire and
Security applications complete with
volume control and dil switch to
provide 32 tones.
Low profile Roshni with Deep base
offers IP65 protection. All Roshni
sounders have synchronised start for
self synchronisation without third
wire.
Chapter 2 Page 64
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
93 Dia x
105D mm
(Deep base)
Colour:
Red or white
Output Voltage:
9-28Vdc
Typical Current:
24Vdc@16mA
Typ. Sound Output: @1m 102dB
Fire Catalogue
Product Codes
ROSHRDSR
ROSHNI Sounder c/w deep base red
576.501.220
ROSHNI Sounder c/w shallow base red
576.501.221
ROSHNI Sounder c/w shallow base white
576.501.222
ROSHNI/Flashni Deep Base - Red
576.501.223
ROSHNI/Flashni Deep Base - White
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 65
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• 4 predefined voice messages
• Custom messages available
• Low current consumption
Firecryer
The FIRECRYER is an electronic sounder which provides as
default the same electronic sound as the MT Besson
Banshee and in addition, provides 4 predefined voice
messages, which can be synchronised across a zone of
sounders.
The FIRECRYER offers an excellent service upgrade
opportunity in the UK for systems installed to BS5839pt1
and may also provide opportunities elsewhere.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Dimensions:
576.501.042
Operating Voltage:
Current Consumption:
Sound output:
Voice message:
Polarity D.C.
Operating Temp:
Humidity:
Weatherproofing:
IP45 - 92dia 61.3 Hmm
IP66 - 92dia 85.5 Hmm
Nominally 24Vdc
Min. 18Vdc Max. 30Vdc
Average 19mA
Min. 10mA
Max. 23mA
(Subject to message)
Fast sweep - 100dBA
97dBA approx
reverse polarity protection
-25°C to +70°C
90% relative humidity
(non-condensing)
Standard base - IP45
Special base - IP66
Red Flame-retardant ABS
576.501.052
576.501.051
576.501.035.A
576.501.104.A
576.501.105
Banshee IP66 backbox for Firecryer
Sounders
Mini Fire Cryer Voice Enhanced Base
Sounder Cable Spacing Ring
Multi Message Synchronised Mini Fire
Cryer Voice Enhanced Base Sounder
MFC4SUA 4 message Red ADT Branded
Fire Cryer Sounder
MFC4SCA Custom Message Red ADT
Branded Fire Cryer Sounder
MFC-CM Fire Cryer Custom Message
Chip
Housing Material:
Standard Messages:
AK - “Fire Emergency, please remain calm and evacuate
the building immediately.”
AB - “This is a fire alert. This is a fire alert. Await further
instructions. Await further instructions.”
SP - “This is an ADT fire alarm test. No action required.”
AD - “Fire Alarm Test Now Complete.”
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 65
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 66
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
FIRECRYER cont’d
Additional Features
Four Message
With four messages fire tests can be easily differentiated
from alert and evacuate messages.
Two Wire Connection
The FIRECRYER uses a standard 2 wire 24V d.c. connection to carry power, message switching and message
synchronisation. This enables a quick and easy upgrade
to existing bells and sounders.
MINERVA MT Banshee Compatible
The electronic alarm sound and mechanics of the FIRECRYER are the same as other Banshee sounders in the
range. This allows them to be mixed with other sounders
in a zone. It also means that existing Banshees can be
very quickly upgraded to FIRECRYERs.
Multi Message Variants
Multi-message versions only require a multi-message
switching PCB added at the fire panel which then allows
all FIRECRYERS on two sounder circuits to be synchronised.
Low Power
The FIRECRYER takes marginally more power than an
equivalent electronic sounder. This enables voice
enhanced sounders to be offered without the high additional cost of large battery backups.
Standard Products
The FIRECRYER is available in ADT branding with predefined English messages and 100dBA fast sweep alert
sound to comply with BS5839Pt1. Other variants with
different branding, languages, messages and different
tones are available upon request.
Product Codes
Product
Message
Brand
Synchronised
Reference
1
2
3
4
576.501.035.A
MFC4SUA
AK
AB
AD
SP
ADT
Yes
576.501.104.A
*MFC4SCA
Customer Defined
ADT
Yes
576.501.051
F/C/4A
AK
AB
AD
SP
Yes
* For recording of special messages there is a charge. This can be ordered under product code
576.501.105 MFC-CM. This includes the supply of a different timer chip for the F/S/VMC
synchronisation board.
Chapter 2 Page 66
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 67
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Single Gang Lamp/Buzzer Units
Lamp Buzzer units may be used for
local alarms when high level audible
warnings may not be appropriate.
Available in flush and surface mount
versions to fit standard single gang
backboxes.
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
90H x 90W
x 40D mm
Current Rating:
15mA at 24Vdc
nominally
Features
• Low Current
• Flush or Surface Mount
•Hi-Brightness LED
Product Codes
540.011.012
Single gang flush mount LED
(red)/Buzzer Unit labelled ‘Fire
Alarm’
540.011.013
Single gang surface mount LED
(red)/Buzzer Unit labelled ‘Fire
Alarm’ c/w surface backbox.
Solista LED Beacon
Ultra low power requirement 3mA
or 6mA at 24Vdc. Long life low
profile design. Protected to IP54,
supplied complete with base.
Product Code
576.501.230
Solista LED Beacon (Red)
Easy AVTM Retrofit LED Beacon
This low power LED beacon is
designed to be retrofitted to existing
Banshee electronic sounders. Easy
and fast installation typically 3 min.
Low power 6mA max at 24Vdc.High
Output LEDs.
09/10
Product Code
576.501.012
Easy AV strobe for Banshee
Sounders
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 67
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 68
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
•
•
•
•
Available in 1, 2, 3 and 5 watts
Protected to IP65
Attractive low profile design
Optional bracket for mounting both Beacon and
Banshee Sounder
Xenon Beacons - 24V Including Surface Mount Adaptor
This high quality range of Xenon beacons are tested to IP
65 making them ideal for the most stringent applications.
Each beacon incorporates a low profile Fresnel lens
designed to give maximum light output.
Technical Specification
Voltage
V d.c.
24
24
24
24
Power Output Alarm Current
Watt(s)
mA
1
42
2
84
3
126
5
210
Flash Rate
60/min
60/min
60/min
60/min
Rating
IP65
IP65
IP65
IP65
Temp. Range
Height
-30 to +70°C
-30 to +70°C
-30 to +70°C
-30 to +70°C
Dimensions (mm)
Diameter
51
75
51
75
51
75
75
90
Product Codes
540.001.030
540.001.031
540.001.032
540.001.033
20-112
20-113
20-120
Low
Low
Low
Low
Low
Low
Low
profile
profile
profile
profile
profile
profile
profile
clear 24Vdc 1 watt
blue 24Vdc 1 watt
amber 24Vdc 1 watt
red 24Vdc 1 watt
red 24Vdc 2 watt
red 24Vdc 5 watt
red 24Vdc 3 watt
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
High Power – 10 Candela
Current Surge Suppression
High Efficiency – 88mA at 24VDC
1 Hz Flash Rate
Protected to IP54
Wide Operating Voltage – 10 to 60 VDC
Operating Temperature -25oC to + 70oC
Solex 10 cd Xenon Beacon
A Solex 10 Candela Xenon Beacon with a red lens and a
white shallow base which can be used wherever a high
power xenon beacon is required.
Due to the high power output and current consumption it is
recommended that this device is not used with the MZX-c,
MZX-c+ or similar small panels (an SB520 sounder booster
module and PSU may be required in some cases).
Product Code
576.501.232
Chapter 2 Page 68
Fire Catalogue
Solex 10 cd Beacon with red lens and
white base
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 69
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Combined strobe & sounder
• Matches Roshni sounders
• Weather Resistant to IP65
Flashni
A combined sounder and beacon which combines the
features of the Roshni electronic sounder with a fully
integrated Xenon beacon.
These sounders are fully compatible with all Roshni tones.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Dimensions:
20-118
Output Voltage:
Typical Current:
Typ. Sound Output:
93 Dia x 92D mm
(Shallow base)
93 Dia x 121D mm
(Deep base)
18-30Vdc
68mA@24Vdc
101dB (A)@1m
576.501.224
576.501.227
Combined Roshni sounder/strobe
complete with deep base (IP65).
Combined Roshni Sounder/Strobe, Red
Body/Red Lens complete with shallow
base & tone switch.
Combined Roshni Sounder/Strobe, Red
Body/Red Lens, deep base, tone switch &
separate sounder/strobe operation.
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Combined Sounder and LED Beacon
Low Current -10mA @ 24VDC
6 selectable tones
Volume control (2 levels)
White housing, clear lens with red LED’s
DDA compliant audio visual solution for UK
Neat unobtrusive design
Ideal for hotels, care homes, schools & offices
Independent power cables allow a large number of AV
platform sounders to be driven from a single 24V circuit
• 90dB sound output
• >1Cd light output at 1 Hz
• Approved to EN54-3 (pending)
.
Squashni G3/AV Sounder Beacon
This low current combined sounder/beacon is ideal for
standalone usage utilising the optional blanking cap or can
be used in conjunction with a 4” base and detector. When
used with a detector it will provide a single point of
installation for the detector, sounder and beacon.
This is a conventional sounder / beacon and needs to be
powered from the panel sounder outputs or a sounder
module.
Product Codes
576.501.250
576.501.255
517.050.401
517.050.005
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Squashni G3/AV Sounder Beacon
Squashni G3/AV Blanking Cap – Pack of 5
4” Universal Base
4” Detector Base Locking Pin Kit (PK100)
Chapter 2 Page 69
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 70
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Software Tools & Accessories
MX Technology Fire controllers are supported by a
comprehensive suite of software programmes which provide
key features to enable fast and accurate configuration and
commissioning of the MX systems.
MXChecker
MXConsys
Connection to a panel directly, or indirectly via the
MXNetwork (in the same way Consys does to perform a
download/upload).
MXConsys, the highly flexible and extremely powerful
programming tool that has been used successfully with MX
systems since day one. Specially designed for MX it is
constantly being extended and refined to meet ever
changing demands. Available for free download from the
Tyco Fire and Security Website but requires a dongle and
license to operate.
Incorporated into MXConsys is MXConsys-Express – An
alternative approach to system configuration that simplifies
the programming effort by automating many of the
processes. Its heart lies in a number of pre-defined
templates that have been expertly designed to match a
selection of building types. The demands on users in terms
of experience and training are considerably reduced.
MXDesigner
MXDesigner is a sophisticated engineering design tool that
not only ensures system parameters and design rules are
obeyed but are key to the ordering and documentation
processes. Battery calculations, loop loading calculations,
remote bus parameters, system schematics and parts lists
are all included. The extensive use of graphics and 'drag
and drop' techniques makes the system easy and quick to
use. In addition, a design module for the intrinsically safe
MXDigital detectors and associated system 800 components
is included. Available for free download from the Tyco Fire
and Security Website.
MXFlow
MXFlow - If you have ever been involved in the configuration
process for a complex 'cause and effect' programme, you
will appreciate the benefits of an automated method of
documenting your work. MXFlow does just that; it takes your
MXConsys 'event action' and transcribes it into a graphical
format that is comprehensive and easy to follow. It can be a
valuable commissioning tool that saves time and effort as
well as an easily understood form of documentation for
future service use.
Available for free download from the Tyco Fire and Security
Website to authorised personnel.
MXChecker - MXChecker replaces, in software, all
configured MX loop devices on a single panel. It offers a
user the following major functionality:
Provides the input status of each and every device
configured on the Loops, e.g. make a Sounder go ’No
Response’, a detector appear active, etc.
The ability to display the General Status of each and every
Point configured on the Loops, e.g.indicate a Sounder is
Isolated, a Callpoint is Disarmed, a Detector is Resetting,
etc. The ability to display the Output Status of each and
every Point configured on the Loops, e.g. indicate a
Sounder is being driven to P1, a Relay Module is not being
driven, etc.
MXLogger
MXLogger – MXLogger enables the engineer to selectively
monitor any device or devices on the addressable loops.
The returned values are displayed on a PC screen and can
be saved to a file for later analysis. Available for free
download from the Tyco Fire and Security Website.
MXRemote
MXRemote - Remote communications software provides a
fast and efficient means of diagnosis without anyone having
to leave the office. In situations where access to a site may
be difficult or where an attending technician requires high
level assistance then MXRemote is the tool for the job. Using
modems, MXRemote can link to the MXDigital fire system via
PSTN or IP and once connected, becomes an integral part
of the fire system, acting as a fully functional repeater. All
system functions are then available to the MXRemote
operator. Available for free download from the Tyco Fire and
Security Website but requires a dongle and license to
operate.
MXService Tool
The TYCO MXService tool is a powerful and flexible tool for
assistance in the installation, commissioning, diagnostics
and service of Tyco MX detection systems. The MXService
tool allows all MX addressable devices to be interrogated,
tested and programmed. Suitable for desktop or single
handed operation the MXService tool is battery operated
using standard rechargeable batteries.
MXLoop Tester
The MXLoop Tester can test, commission and fault-find a
loop of up to 250 MX analogue addressable
detectors/devices, without a fire panel. A laptop is generally
used for operation & display, but a “One Person Installation
Mode” is automatically enabled on power up.
Identifies all devices on the loop, determining addresses
and types. Over-addressed (>250), unknown device types,
and, generally, duplicate addressed devices are recognised.
Monitors analogue values of all detectors/modules on the
loop to determine device status: normal/alarm/fault/dirty etc.
Chapter 2 Page 70
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 71
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
MZX Product Line Overview.
Key Terms & Conditions.
Key Functions & Features.
System Display and Controls.
Set Time and Date.
Enter Pass Codes
Customer Operator Access Levels.
Accept Fire Alarm Events.
Accept Incoming Events.
Walk Test.
Isolate Detectors.
Isolate Field Devices.
View Status of a Loop Device.
View Event Log.
Interpret System Faults.
Carry out Routine Testing.
MZX Interactive Training CD
An Operator Training CD which contains an interactive
training programme that provides information on the MZX
Fire Detection System.
Product Code
TCD-1
09/10
Fire Catalogue
MZX Interactive Training CD
Chapter 2 Page 71
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 72
Chapter 2 - MZX Technology
Features
• Programs the system across multiple sub-panels
• Downloads to the system from one point
• Provides Firmware download as well as configuration
download
• Dongle protected
• Provides full project configuration printouts. Includes MX
consys express
MXConsys
MXConsys is a powerful Windows programming tool which
provides full system programming functions and project
configuration and issue control. MXConsys is used on
MINERVA MX, MX2,T2000 & MZX panels.
It also supports automatic data transfer to MXGraph & TXG
graphical mimic and alarm management systems.
MXConsys is available under document control from
authorised personnel in the Tyco businesses.
Product Codes
557.203.001
557.203.003
557.202.118
MXConsys Dongle and license (parallel)
MXConsys Dongle and license (USB)
MXConsys Download lead
Features
• Facilitates remote diagnostics
• Display identical to panel view
• Remote Assistance
MXRemote
MXRemote is a Windows based software tool for remote
service and support of MX detection panels. MXRemote
provides a full function fire panel repeater running on a PC
either locally or over dial up telephone lines or via the
internet. Providing the operator has the correct passwords
MXRemote allows all operator, manager, service and
engineer functions available at the panel to be provided at
the PC.
This allows the customer or the Tyco service organisation to
provide remote assistance, service and limited configuration
assistance to the installation.
MXRemote is available as a stand-alone software
application for Tyco service operations. Alternatively Tyco
Safety Products are able to provide consultancy and
assistance in implementing MXRemote as an integrated part
of a central station and service centre system.
Product Codes
557.203.002
557.203.004
557.202.116
UDS1100
Chapter 2 Page 72
Fire Catalogue
MXRemote dongle and license (parallel)
MXRemote Dongle and license (USB)
MX-FIM Modem Lead
Lantronics Device Server LAN
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 73
Chapter 2 - MX Technology
Programming and Service Tools
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Read/write the detector/ancillary address
Display date of manufacture and commissioning
Display serial number
Display temperature/ CO levels / smoke obscuration
Programming of the LED
Testing the detector remote LED and control outputs
Perform the detector self verification test function
Displaying detector dirtiness level
Controlling ancillary outputs
Reading ancillary statuses
Power management options
MXService Tool
Product Codes
The TYCO MXSERVICE tool is a powerful and flexible tool
for assistance in the installation, commissioning,
diagnostics and service of Tyco MX detection systems. The
MX SERVICE tool allows all MX addressable devices to be
interrogated, tested and programmed.
516.800.918
516.800.922
516.800.924
516.800.926
516.800.927
516.800.929
801AP MXService tool
Spare ancillary programming lead
Pack of Spare Pins (Pk 10)
MXService Tool PMS Dongle Parallel
MXService Tool PMS Dongle (USB)
PMS Programming Lead
Suitable for desktop or single handed operation the
MXSERVICE tool is battery operated using standard
rechargeable batteries. An accessory pack provides
alternative straps, and cigarette lighter adaptor. The
MXService tool has a finite life time after which the software
must be recharged by an MX authorised administrator.
Features
• Compact
• Organises Tools
• Sturdy Construction Protects Tools
MXService Accessory Kit
Product Code
A carry case which contains the following items:Car Lighter Adapter
Shoulder Strap
516.800.923
MXService accessory kit
This provides space for the following:801AP MXService Tool
Ancillary Programming Lead
Mains Charger
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 2 Page 73
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 74
Chapter 2 - MX Technology
Features
• Pre-Programmed with latest AVR firmware
• Powered from XLM Loop card or FIM, No external power
required
• Simple to operate
• Compact handheld device
• Complete with ribbon cable and connector
MXService Tool
This unit will allows the MZX Technology® Fire Controller
Loop Drivers to be updated to the latest software version.
When required upgrades can be performed easily and
quickly in the field with minimal system downtime. The MZX
AVR Programmer is designed for use with MX,MZX,ZX and
T2000 addressable fire controllers, please check document
17-05-AVR for compatibility details.
Technical Specifications
Product Code
2 Button Keypad
3 Status LEDs
Operating Temperature 0°C to 50°C
Size 189 x 80 x 31
516.800.941
Chapter 2 Page 74
Fire Catalogue
Tyco MZX AVR Programmer
09/10
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 75
Chapter 2 - MX Technology
Features
• Ability to commission loops without a panel
• Verify installed loops before connection to panel
• Fault find loops whilst disconnected from panel
MXLoop Tester
The MX Loop Tester can test, commission and fault-find
a loop of up to 250 MX digital addressable detectors/devices,
without a fire panel. A laptop is generally used for operation
& display, but a “One Person Installation Mode” is
automatically enabled on power up.
Identifies all devices on the loop, determining addresses
and types. Over-addressed (>250), unknown device types,
and, generally, duplicate addressed devices are recognised.
Monitors analogue values of all detectors/modules on the
loop to determine device status: normal/alarm/fault/dirty etc.
Provides alarm test for detectors that support it.
Allows Walk Test. Any device going into alarm is shown on
the laptop with address and time. Walk Test Status (devices
not tested yet) can be requested. Walk test mode overrides
detection algorithm delays for fast testing.
Monitors loop current and status, identifying open / short
and over-current conditions. Details devices present on each
side of break (so that position of break or tripped isolator
can be determined).
Includes commands to operate device LED and control
output modules (relays and sounders).
Turns on LED of faulty detectors (when there is no alarm) to
aid visual identification.
Automatic addressing mode allows un-programmed devices
to be added in sequence and be automatically addressed.
Detailed diagnostics and commissioning modes via laptop.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Powered from 110V/230V mains supply via 24V, 3A plug
pack, or from 24V batteries (batteries not included).
Dimensions
Unit:
200mm x122mm x 46mm
Carry Bag:
250mm x 250mm x 70mm
Weight:
2 kg (without battery)
557.203.021
557.203.022
557.203.023
557.203.024
557.203.026
MXLoop tester with EUROPEAN/UK
MAINS to IEC CABLE
SPARE ECM prog DB6 (FEM) - DB9
(FEM) null modem
Spare carry bag with 2 pockets and
strap
Spare PSU 90-264VAC IN/24VDC 3A
out
Spare MX loop tester battery lead set
Features
• Lightweight
• Convenient
• Compact
MX Service Case
There are 12 main circuit boards shared between the
Minerva® MX1000, MX4000 and MX2 Control Panels,
Repeater Panels and Black Box Panels. The Engineers
Minerva® MX Service Kit is designed to hold one of each
board in a convenient lightweight and portable case that will
protect the boards whilst taking the minimum amount of
space in a service engineer’s vehicle. The case also
contains a fault finding manual and list of spares part
numbers for re-order.
The Engineers Minerva® MX Service Kit allows a service
engineer to carry onto site, sufficient spares to effect a panel
repair efficiently and in a professional manner. It will avoid
unnecessary return trips to the service vehicle or branch to
collect spares and negates the need to carry cumbersome
panels & enclosures in service vehicles.
The contents of the case are detailed in the Service and
Spares section of this catalogue.
Product Code
557.202.299
09/10
Fire Catalogue
MX Service Case
Chapter 2 Page 75
eft intentionally blank.
FIRE_Ch2_MX_Technology:Layout 1 03/09/2010 13:59 Page 76
Chapter 2 - MX Technology
Service & Spares
Keys & Keyswitches
557.203.005
Set of spare keys for MX Panel (AL102)
557.180.209
Keyswitch assembly for use with MX2
controllers (spare)
557.180.208
MX2 Spare Keys
557.201.508
MZX Spare Key Set
MX Service Tool
516.800.922
MX Service tool, Spare programming lead
516.800.924
MX Service tool, Spare pins for
programming lead pk of 10
Housings & Metalwork
BFP801Blank Half Module - Grey Overlay
557.201.300
557.201.306
Standard MX Expansion backbox and
chassis plate
557.201.310
Deep MX Expansion backbox and chassis
plate
557.202.206
MX2 expansion aperture installation kit
MX Loop Tester
MX
557.203.022
557.203.023
MX
557.203.024
MX
557.203.026
MX
Loop
Loop
Loop
Loop
Tester ECM Prog Null Modem
Tester Carry Bag
tester PSU
Tester Battery lead set
MX Service Kit
The Engineers Minerva MX Service Kit
557.202.299
The Engineers Minerva MX Service Kit consists of an MX
Service Case and the following MX Spare Service PCB’s:-
CPU FIMs & Loop Cards
FIM801 1-Loop Field I/F Module
557.202.000
557.202.001
FIM802 2-Loop Field I/F Module
557.202.008
FIM801CV – T2000CV only
557.202.007
XLM800 2-Loop Expansion Card
557.202.002
CPU800 Central Processor Unit
Power Supplies
557.202.003
PSM800 Power Supply Unit
557.202.004
LBM800 Loop Booster Module PCB
557.202.403
PSM800M Marine approved PSU
557.202.405
PSB800M Marine approved PSU c/w Loop
Booster
557.202.210
PSU830 Power Supply with Loop Booster
557.202.208
MX2 8 Loop Expansion kit
557.201.210
Dual power supply mounting kit
557.202.050
PSM800 Temp Sensor Accessory Kit
557.202.113
PSB to FIM Cable
557.202.608
PMM800 Power monitor module
557.202.609
BAQ60T24 2.5A MZX PSU
557.202.610
BAQ140T24 5A MZX PSU
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
Minerva 16 way input/output module
FIM802 2 loop field interface module
CPU800 1MB CPU PCB
PSB800M panel power supply c/w loop booster module
IOB800 8 Input/8 Output Expansion Board
XLM800 2 Loop Expansion Module + Cable
OCM800 Operator Control Module
ODM800 Operator Display Module
DCM800 Display & Control Module
PSU830 Panel Power Supply C/W Loop Booster Module
MX2 LCD Assembly
MPM800 Multi Purpose Interface Module
Indication & Expansion
557.202.013
OCM800 Operator Control Module
557.202.019
ODM800 Operator Display Module
557.202.021
ANN840 40-Way Alarm/Fault LED Module
557.202.022
ANN880 80-Way Alarm LED Module
557.202.020
COM820 20-Way Status/Command
Module
557.202.200
DCM800 MX2 Display Control Module
(without LCD assy)
557.202.201
ANN881 80 Way Zonal Display (for MX2
Panels)
557.202.601
DCM816 16 zone display PCB for MZX125
557.202.602
DCM832 32 zone display PCB for
MZX250/251/252
557.202.209
MX2 LCD assembly
557.202.028
RSM800 Power Supply
557.180.053
RBUS Driver Chip
557.180.052
Serial Printer Driver Kit
Callpoint Key & Glasses
515.001.045
MCP test key
515.001.119
MCP EN54 Spare Glasses pk of 5
Chapter 2 Page 76
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 1
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Control Panels and Repeater Panels
Features
• 2, 4 and 8 zone versions available.
• Supports the complete range of EN54 approved series
600 detectors including photo multi-sensor and CO
multi-sensor.
• Supports Tyco twin wire sounders on all eight detection
zones.
• Drives up to 3 repeater panels (4 and 8 zone panels).
• Access to controls via key switch.
• Space for 2 x 3.4 A/H batteries providing up to 72 hour
standby.
• Remote control inputs for class change, alert, evacuate,
silence alarms and reset.
• Zone 1 configurable for latching or non latching.
• Selectable zonal or general alarm sounder operation.
• Alert sounder option.
• Configurable zone co-incidence for automatic detectors.
• Fully monitored fire signalling output.
• Single pole volt free change over fire relay output.
• Single pole volt free change over fail safe fault relay
output.
• Short circuit fire option.
• Auxiliary 24VDC 250mA power supply output.
• Open collector output for buzzer active, disablement
active and evacuate active.
• Earth fault monitoring.
• Zone/Output disablement for each zone, fire signal
output and all sounders.
• Buzzer disable feature.
• One man zone test.
• One man sounder test.
• Automatic fire detector and manual alarm call point fire
event discrimination.
• Alarm counter.
• Compatible with diode bases for detector removal.
Minerva® MZX-c
The Minerva MZX-c range of conventional twin wire fire
alarm control panels will satisfy a wide range of
applications from 2 to 8 zones and have many features
that are normally associated with more expensive
addressable systems.
The range consists of 2, 4 and 8 zone panels together
with an 8 zone repeater which is compatible with the 4
and 8 zone variants. The matching repeater panel has an
inbuilt 240Vac power supply.
The Minerva MZX-c range of conventional fire detection
control panels are designed to be both installer and user
friendly. A high degree of flexibility and programmability
allows the systems to be customised without the need for
any configuration software.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 1
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 2
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Technical Specifications
Panels
2 Zone
Electrical
Mains Supply
Power Consumption (max)
PSU/Charger Output
Sounder Circuits 24VDC Nominal
Aux DC Output 24VDC Nominal
Maximum Battery Space
Environmental
Operating Temperature
Operating Humidity
Mechanical
Dimensions (W x H x D mm)
Weight Excl Batteries Kg
Enclosure Colour
2 x 0.5A
4 Zone
8 Zone
230VAC +10% - 15%
138W
1.5A
4 x 0.5A
4 x 0.5A
0.25A
2 x 3.4 A/H (PS-1230)
Repeater
8 Zone
N/A
N/A
-5°C to +40°C
95% Non Condensing
365 x 273 x 110
2.2
Light Grey RAL7035
Product Codes
508.031.004.EG
508.031.005.EG
508.031.006.EG
508.031.016.EG
Chapter 3 Page 2
Fire Catalogue
MZX-c
MZX-c
MZX-c
MZX-c
2
4
8
8
ZONE
ZONE
ZONE
ZONE
PANEL TYCO 2 WIRE
PANEL TYCO 2 WIRE
PANEL TYCO 2 WIRE
REPEATER PANEL
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 3
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Features
• 4, 8, 16 and 32 zone versions available
• Semi-Flush mounting using optional bezel
• Supports the complete range of EN54 Approved Series
600 Detectors including photo multi-sensor and CO
multi-sensor
• Compatible with System 620 ATEX and IECEx approved
intrinsically safe system
• Extensive custom options programmable via switches
and front panel controls
• Two stage alarms and investigate delay options
• Day/Night modes and alarm counter (with optional timer
module)
• Full EN54 zone operation with options for non-latching,
short circuit alarm or indication only circuits
Minerva® MZX-c+
The MZX-c+ range of Conventional Control Panels are
designed to be both installer and user friendly.
They are designed and manufactured to a high standard
and are approved by LPCB to EN54 parts 2 & 4.
These Panels are available in 4,8,16 & 32 zone versions
along with suitable Repeaters for all models.
The 8 to 32 Zone Panels are capable of driving any
combination of 8 channel output expansion boards (relays,
alarm circuits & open collector 0v outputs) up to a
maximum of 12 boards which can be set to zonal activated
or common output modes.
Each Panel has extensive configuration options but remains
easy to install, program and operate and are supported by
detailed documentation on commissioning, operation and
maintenance.
The Panels are designed to work with a wide range of
manufacturers detectors (in addition to Tyco detectors) and
are suitable for use in many types of installation including
upgrades and new installations
Ancillaries and Expansion
C1631 Repeater Interface Board provides a port for
driving up to 5 repeater panels. One C1631 Repeater
interface board is required for the panel and one for each
repeater. Repeaters are supplied with a C1631 fitted.
C1630 Output Expansion Interface Board provides a port
for driving up to 12 output expansion boards.
EXP 4 and EXP 4 PSU Expansion Housings are designed
to house any combination of up to four output expansion
boards. The PSU version is equipped with a 5A 24Vdc
power supply with space for 2 x 12V 12Ah batteries.
Housing dimensions 325W x 370H x 126D mm
EXP 5 and EXP 5 PSU Expansion Housings are similar
to the EXP 4 and EXP 4 PSU but accommodate five
output expansion boards. Housing dimensions 400W x
441H x 131D mm
09/10
C1633 LED Driver Board provides eight open collector
outputs rated @ 60mA. Outputs can be zonal alarm or
common alarm.
C1634 Relay Output Module provides eight volt free
changeover contacts rated at 1A 30Vdc. Outputs can be
zonal alarm or common alarm.
C1635 Monitored Output Board provides eight fault
monitored 24Vdc outputs. Power can be derived from the
control panel or an external source. Outputs can be zonal
alarm or
common alarm..
C1651 MZX-c+ Timer Module is an optional plug-in board
with an alphanumeric LCD to provides a real-time clock
display. The clock can be programmed to provide
investigate delays, sequential alarms and day night
settings. The unit is also used to store and display a total
count of the number of times the panel enters the alarm
condition. Can be fitted to 8, 16 and 32 zone panels.
Additional Benefilts
• Inputs for remote Silence, Evacuate, Reset and Class
change
• Configurable monitored or volt free outputs for Fire, Fault
and Protection
• Outputs for zones 1 to 4 (open collector) with 8, 16 or 32
zonal outputs provided by optional expansion boards
• Outputs for Disablement active, Evacuate active and
buzzer active (open collector)
• Volt free reset relay. Active for 10 seconds following a
panel reset
• 8 to 32 zone systems can drive up to 12 expansion input
/ output modules per panel
• Drive up to 5 repeater panels
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 3
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 4
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Technical Specifications
Panels
Repeaters
Electrical
Mains Supply
Power Consumption
PSU / Charger Output
Sounder Circuits 24Vdc nominal
Aux. DC Output 24Vdc nominal
Maximum Battery Space
Environmental
Operating Temperature
Operating Humidity
Mechanical
Dimensions (W x H x D mm)
Space for 8 way expansion
Weight Excl. Batteries Kg
Enclosure Colour
4 Zone
8 Zone
85W
1.5A
4 @ 500mA
500mA
2 x 12Ah
165W
3.0A
4 @ 1A
1A
2 x 12Ah
16 Zone
32 Zone
230Vac +10% - 15%
165W
240W
3.0A
5.0A
4 @ 1A
4 @ 1A
1A
1A
2 x 12Ah 2 x 17Ah
8 Zone
16 Zone
32 Zone
85W
1.5A
N/A
N/A
2 x 12Ah
85W
1.5A
N/A
N/A
2 x 12Ah
85W
1.5A
N/A
N/A
2 x 17Ah
-5 to +40 oC
5% to 95% non-condensing
N/A
6.2
325x370x126
400x441x131
2 Boards
2 Boards
Use Exp Hsg
7.1
7.1
10.25
RAL7035 Light Grey
325x370x126
N/A
6.2
6.2
400x441x131
7.6
Product Codes
508.032.002.EA
508.032.003.EA
508.032.004.EA
508.032.005.EA
508.032.006.EA
MZXC+ 4 Zone Panel English/Arabic
MZXC+ 8 Zone Panel English/Arabic
MZXC+ 16 Zone Panel English/Arabic
MZXC+ 32 Zone Panel English/Arabic
MZXC+ 8 Zone Repeater 240Vac
English/Arabic
508.032.007.EA MZXC+16 Zone Repeater 240Vac
English/Arabic
508.032.008.EA MZXC+ 32 Zone Repeater 240Vac
English/Arabic
508.032.012
MZXC+ 4 Way Expansion Housing
508.032.013
MZXC+ 4 Way Expansion Housing with
PSU
508.032.014
MZXC+ 5 Way Expansion Housing
508.032.015
MZXC+ 5 Way Expansion Housing with
PSU
557.201.502
Flush Mount Bezel for MZXC+ 4/8/16
Zone Panel and Repeater
2605060
C1630 O/P Expansion Interface Board
2605061
C1631 Repeater Interface Board
2605062
C1632 16 Zone Interface Board
2605063
C1633 LED Driver Board
2605064
C1634 Relay Output Board
2605065
C1635 Monitored Output Board
2605070
C1651 MZX-c+ Timer Board
Chapter 3 Page 4
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 5
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Features
• Developed for use in vessels which require between 4
and 32 zones of fire detection.
• Compact 4 zone option for Console Mounting.
• Range includes a separate Water Mist Panel.
• Integrated Voyage Data Recorder output on 16 and 32
Zone Panel.
• No external secondary power source required.
• Discrimination between Automatic Fire Detectors and
Manual Alarm Call points to provide the appropriate
response.
• Optional Marine Approved Muster Alarm.
• Text label Inserts for Controls and Indicators in customer
supplied language.
T1200 Conventional Marine Controller
Developed and Manufactured in the United Kingdom the
T1200 range of Conventional Panels are a powerful yet user
friendly series of Control Panels. The range is fully approved
by all major Marine Authorities and takes advantage of the
very latest technological advancements both in terms of
design and manufacturing to the latest European, Marine
and Asian standards.
Benefits
Allows very early detection of accommodation fires with
significantly reduced false alarms when used with Tyco’s
unique heat enhanced Compensated Carbon Monoxide
(CCO) Detector.
Configurable Detection Zones allowing zones to be
configured for any or all of the following :- Latching or
Non Latching Fire Indication Normal or Intrinsically Safe
Zone Monitoring of Machinery space zones.
Fault Finding Features
• The following fault finding indications are available :• General Fault - Any Fault Condition.
• Power Supply Fault - Mains or standby power supply/
charger fault.
• System Fault - Micro Controller or memory fault.
• Earth Fault - Positive or Negative Power Supply Earth
Fault.
• Fuse Fault - Auxiliary Supply Fuse Failure.
• Repeater Fault - Repeater Fault or Repeater
communications failure.
• Sounder Fault - Any Sounder Fault.
• Fire Protection Fault - Fault on the Fire Protection Output.
• Fire Output Fault - Fault on the Fire Output.
• Fault Output Fault - Fault on the Fault Output.
Crew Alert Mode :- Manages Alarm Annunciation.
Pre-configured for Immediate use.
Detection Options
Optical Detector - An excellent all round detector suited to
all applications.
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
High Performance Optical (HPO) Detector - A direct
replacement for the Ion Chamber Smoke Detector.
Flame Detector- Used where there is a risk of large flaming
fires e.g. Machinery Spaces.
Enhanced Compensated Carbon Monoxide (CCO) Detector
– The best detector for early warning without false alarms,
used in life threatening applications e.g. Cabins, Public
Spaces etc.
Environmental
IP Rating:
Operating Temp:
Humidity:
T1204 & T1216RDC – 335w x 270h
x 148d mm
T1216 & T1216R – 420w x 445h x
148d mm
T1232/T1216W/T1232RAC/T1232R
DC/T1200EA/T1200EDC– 500w x
535h x 174d mm
T1200B – 335w x 170h x 102d mm
Designed to IP56
-10°C to +55°C
95% RH (non condensing)
Heat Detector - Used where smoke detectors cannot be
used e.g. Galleys, Laundries, Drying Rooms etc.
Extensive configuration options using simple on board
DIL switches and links.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 5
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 6
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Product Codes
508.023.001
508.023.002
508.023.003
508.023.004
508.023.005
508.023.006
508.023.011
508.023.012
508.023.013
508.023.014
508.023.015
508.023.016
508.023.021
508.023.022
508.023.023
508.023.025
2605061
2605063
2605064
2605065
508.023.035
508.023.036
508.023.051
508.023.052
508.023.053
508.023.054
T1204DC 4 ZONE PANEL C/W 1.5A
24VDC PSU (requires T1200B battery box)
T1204A1 4 ZONE PANEL C/W 1.5A
110VAC PSU (requires T1200B battery
box)
T1204A2 4 ZONE PANEL C/W 1.5A
230VAC PSU (requires T1200B battery
box)
T1216 16 ZONE PANEL C/W VOYAGE
DATA O/P MODULE & 5.0A 110/230VAC
PSU
T1216W 16 ZONE WATER MIST FIRE
DETECTION PANEL C/W 2 X 8 WAY
ZONAL RELAY OUTPUT MODULES
(C1634) AND 5.0AMP 110/230VAC PSU
T1232 32 ZONE PANEL C/W VOYAGE
DATA O/P MODULE & 5.0A 110/230VAC
PSU
T1216RDC 16 ZONE REPEATER
WITHOUT PSU
T1216RA1 16 ZONE REPEATER C/W 1.5A
110VAC PSU
T1216RA2 16 ZONE REPEATER C/W 1.5A
230VAC PSU
T1232RDC 32 ZONE REPEATER
WITHOUT PSU
T1232RA1 32 ZONE REPEATER C/W 1.5A
110VAC PSU
T1232RA2 32 ZONE REPEATER C/W 1.5A
230VAC PSU
T1200EA EXPANSION BOX C/W 5.0A
110/230VAC PSU
T1200EDC EXPANSION BOX (NO PSU)
T1200B BATTERY BOX FOR T1204 4
ZONE PANEL
T1200 RMRS DOOR STAY KIT
C1631 REPEATER INTERFACE BOARD
C1633 LED DRIVER BOARD
C1634 RELAY OUTPUT BOARD
C1635 MONITORED OUTPUT BOARD
C1665 MUSTER INTERFACE BOARD
A1466 RELAY OUTPUT BOARD
T1216 ENGLISH/CHINESE/JAPANESE
INSERT SET
T1232 ENGLISH/CHINESE/JAPANESE
INSERT SET
T1216R ENGLISH/CHINESE/JAPANESE
INSERT SET
T1232R ENGLISH/CHINESE/JAPANESE
INSERT SET
Chapter 3 Page 6
Spares
509.023.001
509.023.002
509.023.003
509.023.004
509.023.011
509.023.012
509.023.021
509.023.022
509.023.023
509.023.031
509.023.032
2605060
509.023.042
509.023.051
509.023.052
509.023.061
Fire Catalogue
C1626 4 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD
C/W AC PSU
C1626 4 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD
WITHOUT AC PSU
C1627 16 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD
WITHOUT AC PSU
C1627 16 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD
WITHOUT AC PSU FOR T1232
C1626 REPEATER MOTHERBOARD C/W
AC PSU
C1626 REPEATER MOTHERBOARD
WITHOUT AC PSU
C1628 4 ZONE PANEL DISPLAY
C1628 16 ZONE PANEL DISPLAY
C1629 32 ZONE PANEL DISPLAY
C1628 16 ZONE REPEATER DISPLAY
C1629 32 ZONE REPEATER DISPLAY
C1630 OUTPUT EXPANSION INTERFACE
BOARD
C1632 16 ZONE PANEL EXPANSION
BOARD
PS136 5.0A 110/230VAC PSU
PS40 1.5A 24VDC PSU
T1200 SPARE KEY SET
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 7
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Extinguishing Panels, Repeaters & Accessories
Features
•
•
•
•
Approval to BS EN 12094-1:2003 additional options
Approval to BS EN 54-2 and 4
Designed to BS7273-1:2000
Comprehensive facilities for gaseous extinguishing
systems
• Monitored inputs for gas discharged, gas low, isolation
valve closed/abnormal, gas trapped in manifold
• Control inputs for auto/manual, gas hold, gas abort
• 1 minute actuator cut off option
• Monitored actuator/solenoid release
• Extensive disablement options
• Common fire, fault, relay / monitored output facilities
• 1st, 2nd, 3rd stage and gas discharged relay / monitored
output facilities
• Reset relay facilities
MZX-e Extinguishing Control Panel
The MZX-e gaseous extinguishant control panel is powerful
yet user-friendly and is designed and manufactured to a
high standard. The panel features approval to BS EN
12094- 1:2003, BS EN 54-2 and 4 and is designed to BS
7273 part 1. The panel has extensive configuration options
but is easy to install, programme and operate. The
removable chassis enables the engineer to “first fix” an
empty cabinet and then fit the chassis at the commissioning
stage.
Normally-open inputs provide for remote evacuate, silence
alarms, system reset, lock-off input, low pressure and gas
discharged pressure switch input.
This is supported by comprehensive documentation on
commissioning, operating, maintenance and fault finding. In
addition there is a comprehensive range of compatible
accessories available to meet most customer requirements.
Configuration
The use of DIL switches on the internal motherboard
enables the engineer to easily configure the extensive
options available and view the panel’s configuration upon
any return visit.
Operation
Three fully-monitored detection zones are provided. Zones
1 and 2 normally provide first stage and second stage fire
conditions to allow extinguishant discharge (coincidence
detection zones). Zone 3 is an auxiliary zone for detection
only purposes. Zone 4 is used as a manual release zone.
Facilities
Three fully-monitored alarm circuits are provided, each
rated at 0.5A with various configuration options via the
engineers DIL switch settings. Two circuits are designed to
provide audible warning of any fire condition and one circuit
to provide an individually distinct audible warning of the
pre-discharge, discharged and emergency hold condition.
Two fully-monitored actuator/solenoid circuits, each rated at
1A, operate simultaneously upon “extinguishant release”.
An RS485 multi-drop circuit link supports up to 7 Status
Controller/Indicators of any type mixed on the
communication path. Additional terminals and
configuration options allows the engineer to configure the
manual release, abort and hold switches to either data
comms or hard wired inputs as required.
09/10
Outputs are provided for first stage signalling, second stage
signalling, system discharged, common fire and common
fault . These outputs may be configured as either Volt-Free
C/O contacts or monitored 24V (50mA) outputs. A system
reset Volt-Free relay is also provided.
Additional Benefits
• Intrinsically safe barrier settings
• Metron or solenoid compatible
• Single or double knock operation
• Pre-discharge delay adjustable from 0 to 60 seconds
• Discharged indication with or without pressure switch
• Inhibit silence alarms until gas discharged
• Latching or non latching fault indication option
• Option for rapid buzzer pulse when gas discharge is
imminent
• One man zone and sounder test
• Easily removable chassis
Product Codes
508.033.050.EA MZX-e Extinguishing Control Panel
English / Arabic
508.033.002.EA MZX-e SLU1 Status Lamp Unit, Indication
only English / Arabic
508.033.003.EA MZX-e SLU2 Status Lamp Unit, Indication,
Auto/Manual Select and Manual Release
English / Arabic
508.033.004.EA MZX-e SLU3 Full Function Status Lamp
Unit, Indication, Auto/Manual Select,
Manual Release, Hold, Abort & Time
Counter English / Arabic
508.033.005.EA MZX-e SLU4 Weatherproof Status Lamp
Unit, Indication and Auto/Manual Select
English / Arabic
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 7
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 8
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Extinguishing Door Interlock Ancillaries & T500 Series Spares
A microswitch lock keep can be used
with a deadlock to provide a signal to
the panel to ensure that the
extinguishing system is only put into
Automatic mode when the door is
locked shut.
Product Codes
527.001.028
Micro-switch Lock Keep & Back-plate
For Deadlock
599.001.012
Lamp 28V 60mA Used On T525
T561 Electrical Manual Release Unit
A stand alone manual extinguishant
release unit with selectable activation
and end of line resistors making the
T561 compatible with MXCE,
Prescient, System 1700 and NTR
Extinguishing Panels.
Product Code
509.030.117
T561 Extinguishing Release Manual
Callpoint.
Weatherproof Extinguishing Indicator Units
E1 Single Red lamp unit
Single 24V d.c. red lamp labelled
'Extinguishing System Operated'
Technical Specification Dimensions:
H(mm)
W(mm)
D(mm)
E1
100
100
115
E3
300
100
115
E3 Red/Amber/Green lamp unit
Heavy Duty IP67 Cast Aluminium
Surface Mount Lamp Unit Three
24Vdc lamps:
Red labelled 'Extinguishing System
Operated'
Chapter 3 Page 8
Amber labelled 'Extinguishing
System Automatic Control'
Green labelled 'Extinguishing
System Manual Control'
Fire Catalogue
Product Codes
540.007.001
E1 Single Red lamp unit
Heavy Duty IP67 Cast Aluminium
Surface Mount Lamp Unit
599.001.029
Spare bulb for E1/E3 24V-5W
Product Codes
540.007.002
E3 Red/Amber/Green lamp unit
599.001.029
Spare Bulb for E1/E3 24V-5W
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 9
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
DDA Compliant Pager
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
UHF radio link for maximum licensable protection
Unique coding avoids neighbouring system clashes
Self monitoring of system health
Rugged steel enclosure to IP65
Backlit 2 line text display continuously reports system
status
Additional audible & visible status indicators
Prioritised Fire Alarm Inputs
Automated test calls alert pagers to loss of radio signal
Fault Notification to the lost fire panel via a monitored link
Key operated "System Test" facility for routine confidence
checking
Over 90 hour's backup operation with internal battery
Achieves Disability Discrimination Act (DDA) compliance
Fire Tek Pro Paging System
The FireTek Pro paging system is designed for use with
professional Fire Systems installed in commercial, industrial
and educational premises. The system is primarily
designed to alert the "hearing impaired" in the event of a fire
or other emergency where an audible sounder is the
normal means of indication.
The FireTek Pro has been designed to comply with the
recommendations detailed in BS5839-1: 2002 for alerting
the "hearing impaired" to the activation of a fire alarm
system.
High Integrity Pagers
To complete the system the alphanumeric pagers have
added features specifically incorporated for the "hard of
hearing" when used with the FireTek Pro. These features
include distinct vibrate alerts for emergency messages, a
vibrating out of range indicator which displays "No Service"
on the pager when the radio link is lost, and a vibrating low
battery indicator.
Antenna Options
Mini Dipole Antenna - remote internally mounted antenna
for large sites or areas of difficult signal propagation.
The system can also be used in conjunction with a security
panel to alert guards who might be located remotely from
the main premises.
Folded Dipole Antenna - remote externally mounted
antenna for maximum signal coverage e.g. campuses and
multi-building sites.
The interface to the fire panel comprises of three Prioritised
Fire Inputs and two Fault Inputs. For ease of installation, a
monitored cable assembly is provided with each system
which includes a "common fault" relay output back to the
host fire panel. This output will activate if the FireTek Pro
suffers a mains failure, transmitter fault, antenna mismatch,
interface link failure, or low battery state.
Upon activation of any one of the Fire Inputs, the FireTek
Pro will enter the fire alert condition, prioritisng and
transmitting the Fire message to all enrolled pagers. The
transmissions will be repeated until the fire condition is
reset. The FireTek Pro Pagers ensure that users are alerted
by distinct vibration patterns and clear text messages.
UHF Radio Operation
Any alerting system is only as good as its weakest link. The
FireTek Pro utilises UHF radio frequencies, the main
benefits being superior in-building radio signal propagation
and the option of a manual frequency co-ordinate license
issued by OFCOM. Licensing the FireTek Pro provides a
higher degree of protection from interference. This fact is
acknowledged in Section 18.1 of BS 5839-1:2002.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 9
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 10
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Technical Specifications
Product Codes
Supply Voltage:
557.200.071
557.200.074
557.200.076
557.200.077
557.200.078
557.200.079
557.200.080
Operational Current:
Inputs:
Outputs:
Fault Notification:
Visual Display:
Enclosure:
Dimensions:
Chapter 3 Page 10
230V AC 50-60 Hz
12v 7Ah standby battery
250mA
3 Prioritised Volt Free (Fire)
Input 1 - Fire Alarm - Evacuate
Building
Input 2 - There is an Incident Leave Building
Input 3 - Prepare to Evacuate Await Instructions
2 Volt Free (Fault)
1 off volt free relay output
Mains Failure
Transmitter Fault
Antenna Mismatch
Panel Link Failure
Low/Missing Battery
2 Line Backlit LCD
Steel Enclosure rated to IP65
380 x 320 x 110 mm (H x W x D)
(No antenna fitted)
Fire Catalogue
Paging Transmitter
40 Character Alpha Numeric Pager
1/2 wave dipole antenna
Wall mounting folded dipole antenna
Pole mounting folded dipole antenna
5 metre antenna feeder cable
10 metre antenna feeder cable
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 11
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Point Detectors
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Through innovative design the Series 600 detectors have
reduced the installation and servicing time to a minimum,
needing only one visit to complete the installation and
having a park position for the detector to ease the servicing.
Unique early detection enhanced CO fire detector
Intelligent Universal HPO Smoke Detector
Low profile, discreet and unobtrusive
Superior performance and reliability
Designed for fast, easy installation
Integral and remote alarm LED
Series of Product Approvals
The HPO can be seen as a truly universal smoke detector,
suitable for most applications.
Approvals:-
The Series 600 includes the unique enhanced Carbon
Monoxide CO fire detector, which provides a general
purpose fire detector with unprecedented early detection
capability and excellent false alarm immunity. The CO fire
detectors are the first choice for sleeping risks.
Also included within the range is the intelligent high
performance optical smoke (HPO) detector. The use of the
patented optical sensing chamber, together with refined
signal processing, has enabled the introduction of a smoke
detector suitable for fast, reliable smoke detection of both
slow and fast developing fires.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 11
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 12
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
High Performance Optical Smoke
These detectors react to the whole
range of fire products from slow
smouldering fires, producing visible
particles to open flaming fires
producing large numbers of very hot
smaller sized aerosols. It combines
optical and heat detector technology
to detect clear burning fire products
which hitherto could only be easily
detected by ion-chamber detectors.
For normal ambient conditions, the
high performance optical detector
behaves as a normal optical detector.
Only when a rapid rise in temperature
is detected does the sensitivity of the
detector increase and the presence
of smoke will confirm a fire condition.
The HPO will not operate on a rate of
rise of temperature alone.
Datasheet - Product Code PSF123
Manual - Vol01C-02-D2 “Detectors
Fire Manual”
Product Codes
516.600.002.A
Approval
Branded
LPCB
ADT
516.600.002.T
Approval
Branded
LPCB
Thorn
516.600.002.Y
Approval
Branded
LPCB
Tyco
516.600.202
Approval
Branded
Marine
Tyco
Model
601PH
Model
601PH
Model
601PH
Model
601PH-M
Enhanced Carbon Monoxide Fire
The CO fire detector is a unique
general purpose fire detector which
provides very early warning of slow
smouldering fires. Ideal for sleeping
risks the CO fire detector is also well
suited to many applications where
heat detection is insufficient but
smoke detection causes false alarms.
As CO travels more freely than smoke
the position of CO fire detectors is
more flexible.
This feature is particularly useful in
large complex structures such as atria
and warehouses, where position of
smoke detectors is difficult.
Datasheet - Product Code PSF123
Manual - Vol01C-02-D3 “Detectors
Fire Manual”
Product Codes
516.600.004.A
Approval
Branded
LPCB
ADT
516.600.004.T
Approval
Branded
LPCB
Thorn
516.600.004.Y
Approval
Branded
LPCB
Tyco
516.600.204
Approval
Branded
Marine
Tyco
Model
601CH
Model
601CH
Model
601CH
Model
601CH-M
Optical Smoke
These detectors are capable of
detecting the visible smoke produced
by materials which smoulder or burn
slowly, i.e. soft furnishings, plastic
foam etc;. or 'smoke' produced by
overheated but unburnt PVC. These
detectors are particularly suitable for
general applications and areas where
cable overheating may occur e.g.
electrical services areas. The novel
design of the asymmetrical sampling
chamber and signal processing
techniques stop unwanted alarms
caused by very small insects. i.e.
thrips. Smoke entering the sampling
chamber scatters the infra-red light
pulses onto a photo-diode. These
pulses are converted to an electrical
signal which is compared against a
preset alarm level.
Product Codes
516.600.001.A
Approval
Branded
LPCB
ADT
516.600.001.T
Approval
Branded
Datasheet - Product Code PSF123
Manual - Vol01C-02-D6 “Detectors
Fire Manual”
LPCB
These detectors use two networked
thermistors in a bridge configuration
to provide a fast response, that
depends both on absolute
temperature and notes the change of
temperature. The rate of rise/fixed
temperature heat detectors can be
used in areas where smoke sensors
are unsuitable due to environmental
conditions (smoke, dust etc,). Such
areas include kitchens, locker rooms,
canteens, garages, loading bays etc.
Rate of Rise
Product Codes
516.600.003.A
Approval
Branded
Model
LPCB
ADT
601H-R
516.600.003.T
Approval
Branded
Model
LPCB
Thorn
601H-R
516.600.003.Y
Approval
Branded
Model
LPCB
Tyco
601H-R
516.600.203
Approval
Branded
Model
Marine
Tyco
601H-R-M
Model
601P
Model
Thorn
601P
Branded
Tyco
Model
601P
Branded
Tyco
Model
601P-M
Fixed Temperature 60°C
Product Code
516.600.214
Approval
LPCB /Marine
Model
611H-F
Fixed Temperature 90°C
Product Code
516.600.033
Approval
LPCB/Marine
Model
631H-F
516.600.001.Y
Approval
LPCB
516.600.201
Approval
Marine
Heat
Datasheet - Product Code PSF123
Manual - Vol01C-02-D5 “Detectors
Fire Manual”
Chapter 3 Page 12
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 13
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Ion Chamber Smoke
These detectors react to the visible
and invisible fire aerosols (products
of combustion) and are therefore
capable of detecting the early
presence of hot smouldering and
flaming fires, such as wood, paper
etc.
They are particularly suitable for
general applications in all areas and
use a dual ionisation chamber in
which the air is ionised by a single
radioactive source (33k Bq
Americium 241). The presence of
smoke in the sampling chamber
causes a change in the balance
voltage, between the two chambers.
This is then compared against an
alarm level.
Datasheet - Product Code PSF123
Manual - Vol01C-02-D4 “Detectors
Fire Manual”
Product Codes
516.600.005.A
Approval
Branded
LPCB
ADT
516.600.005.T
Approval
Branded
LPCB
Thorn
516.600.005.Y
Approval
Branded
LPCB
Tyco
Model
601I
Model
601I
Model
601I
Solar Blind Infra Red Flame Detector
Flame detectors, unlike smoke and
heat detectors, do not rely on
convection to transport the fire
product to the detector, nor do they
rely on a ceiling to trap the products.
They can therefore, be used to
protect large open areas without
sacrificing speed of response to
flaming fires. In order to ensure full
coverage, however, flame detectors
do require direct line of sight to all
parts of the protected area.
Infra-red flame detectors such as the
601F are designed to respond
09/10
rapidly to fires which involve cleanburning fuels such as alcohol or
methane, ie fires which would not be
detected by smoke detectors. The
601F Flame detector, by virtue of it’s
operating wavelength and flicker
discrimination, is insensitive to
normal environmental influences. For
outdoor use, a solar-blind detector
(e.g. the S200Plus) should be used.
The 601F flame detector should,
normally, only be used inside
buildings to supplement heat and
smoke detectors.
Fire Catalogue
Product Codes
516.600.006
601F
516.600.007
601F-M Marine
Datasheet - Product Code PSF132
Manual - Vol01C-02-D9 “Detectors
Fire Manual”
Chapter 3 Page 13
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 14
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Series 600 Detector Specifications
Dimensions of Smoke/Heat/Co Detector
43
109
Dimensions of Flame Detector
21.2
108
Technical Specification - Series 600
601
601PH/P/601PH-M/601P-M
Weight
100g
93g
Material
Operating Temp.
-20 to +70°C
-20 to +70°C
Storage Temp.
-40 to +80°C
-25 to +80°C
Relative Humidity
Quiescent Current(typ)
62μA
65μA
Alarm Current(typ)
54mA
45mA
Operating Voltage
10.5 - 33 Vdc
10.5 - 33 Vdc
*Short Term (<3min) -40 to +120°C
601H-R/611H-F/601H-R-M/631H-F
80g
FR 110 Bayblend
-20 to +70°C*
-25 to +80°C
95/98% Non-Condensing
61/65μA
53mA
10.5 - 33 Vdc
Chapter 3 Page 14
Fire Catalogue
601CH/601CH-M
90g
601F/601F-M
74g
-10 to +55°C
-20 to +55°C
-20 to +70°C
-40 to + 80°C
87μA
53mA
10.5 - 33 Vdc
300μA
42mA
18-28Vdc
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 15
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Features
• Sealed Stainless Steel Construction
• Suitable for use in hazardous areas
T54B - Point Type Heat Detector
Constructed from stainless steel, the T54B is an extremely
rugged heat detector that can be used to detect fires in the
harshest of environments. The T54B can be used in
environments with ambient temperatures up to 200°C and,
being hermetically sealed is impervious to most
contaminants.
For reliable operation, it is recommended that T54B
detectors have set points 20°C or 20% (whichever is higher)
above the maximum temperature they will be exposed to in
normal operation.
Preferred factory preset temperatures are:
60, 90, 100, 145°C; normally with open contacts.
Classified as a simple device, the T54B can be used in
Zone 0 areas when connected to a suitable intrinsically safe
barrier.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Operating voltage
@ 0.5A:
Switching Current:
Contact Resistance:
Actuating Temp:
(factory set)
Fixed Temp. only:
Accuracy:
Ambient Temp.:
Relative Humidity:
Protection Category:
Thread Size:
516.033.011
09/10
240Va.c. to 24Vdc
5 to 500mA
<1 ohm
516.033.012
516.033.013
60 to 240°C
Type E
+ or - 5%
-40 to +270°C
100% RH
IP67
M20 x 1.5mm
516.033.014
T4E60X T54B Point Type heat
detector - 60°C
T4E90X T54B Point Type heat
detector - 90°C
T4E100X T54B Point Type heat
detector - 100°C
T4E145X T54B Point Type heat
detector - 145°C
Other temperatures and normally closed contacts are
available by request.
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 15
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 16
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Beam Detectors
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Motorised Auto-Aligning
Up to 4 Detectors per System Controller
Each Detector configurable from 8m to 100m
Integral LASER
Auto-Align Fast Automatic BeamAlignment
Auto-Optimise Building Movement and Contamination
Compensation
Low Level System Controller
20mm Cable Gland Knockouts on System Controller
2-wire interface from System Controller to Detector
Worldwide Approvals including EN54:12 and UL268
Up to 4 Detectors per System Controller
FIRERAY 5000 Multi Head Auto Aligning Infrared Optical Beam Smoke Detector
The FIRERAY® 5000 motorised, auto aligning infrared optical
beam smoke detector can now be installed with up to four
detector heads per system, thus saving on installation time
and costs. This innovative system has been designed from
the ground up to include pioneering technology that fully
addresses the needs of the installer and user, both now and
in the future.
With its industry leading optics, the FIRERAY 5000 is ideally
suited for the protection of large areas where the use of
traditional detection technologies would prove to be too
difficult and/or costly to install. The FIRERAY 5000 combines
an infrared transmitter and receiver in the same discrete unit
and operates by projecting a well-defined beam to a
reflective prism, which returns the beam to the receiver for
analysis. Smoke in the beam path causes a drop in power,
which, if below a pre-determined level, results in an alarm
signal.
Getting the system operational is simplified by a number of
groundbreaking features that combine to make the FIRERAY
5000 the quickest and easiest detector of its type to install.
Once the detector heads are connected, using the Easifit
First Fix system, an integral LASER, which is aligned along
the optical path of the beam, can be activated. This allows
the reflective prism to be sighted quickly and with
confidence. Once the LASER has been used to coarsely
align the beam, the AutOptimise beam alignment system
takes over and automatically steers the beam into the
optimum position.
The system can be fully customised, according to local
conditions; both alarm thresholds (sensitivity) and time to
Alarm/Fault can be set from the ground level System
Controller.
Each detector head is independently configurable from 8m
through to 100m and has its own individual fire threshold.
The System Controller retains one set of Fire and Fault
relays that is common to all detectors that are installed.
The FR5000 MultiHead is supplied with one detector head
and reflector for single beam operation from 8 to 50 meters.
Up to 3 additional detector heads can be added to the
controller to enable larger or more complex areas to be
protected (Subject to local codes and standards)
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Controller:
202w x 230h x 81d mm 0.9 Kg
Detector:
134w x 135h x 134d mm - 0.5 Kg
Additional detector head 2mA @ 24VDC
Operating Current
(low power mode):
10mA @ 24VDC
Operating Voltage:
14 to 28VDC
IP Rating:
IP54
Operating Temperature: -20 to +55oC
Humidity:
93% RH (non condensing) max
516.015.020
516.015.021
516.015.007
Chapter 3 Page 16
Fire Catalogue
FireRay 5000 System (50m)
FR 5000 Detector Head (50m)
FireRay Reflector 100 X 100mm
4 reflectors are required for distances from
50 to 100m
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 17
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Range 5 metres up to 100 metres
Area coverage up to 1400m2
Selectable sensitivity
Self-check and automatic compensation
Manual or automatic reset
Suitable for both conventional and addressable fire
systems
Low current consumption
Flexible system design options
Robust metal construction
Designed to conform to BS5839 Part 5
Optical Beam Smoke Detectors
The FIRE-RAY 2000 is an active infra-red smoke detector.
The system comprises of three base elements i.e. a
transmitter, receiver and Control Unit.
Analysis of the modulated infra-red beam by the Control
Unit determines whether smoke is present, and if so
generates an alarm signal.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
516.015.006.A
Technical Specification
Dimensions(mm)
Height Width Depth
95
75
115
260
210
80
Transmitter/Receiver
Control Unit
Voltage RangeFireray 2000
Fireray 2000 Quiescent Current
Fireray 2000 Alarm Current
Operating Temp. Range -
Fireray
Weight
(Kg)
0.4
2.25
516.015.006.T
920450
516.015.007
516.015.008
+11.5 to +28Vdc
<13mA
<20mA
FireRay2000 optical beam smoke
detector VdS approved, ADT Branded
FireRay2000 optical beam smoke
detector VdS approved, Thorn Branded
FireRay2000 -UL Optical beam smoke
detector - UL approved
FireRay2000 Retro-Reflector 100 x100mm
FireRay2000 Alignment tool
-10oC to +55oC
Humidity
up to 95% RH
(Non-condensing)
Fireray 2000 Enclosure
IP54
FireRay Optical Beam Smoke Detector Mounting Accessories
There are a range of mounting accessories available for use with FireRay® Optical Beam Smoke Detectors. These
accessories will help reduce installation times and provide a professional mounting solution when faced with challenging
building internals.
The large prism plate will securely
The Universal Mounting bracket can be used
mount 4 prisms and is designed
with the Fireray 5000 detector head and the 1
to be used in conjunction with the
or 4 way prism plates to enable the detector
Universal Mounting Bracket (not
head or prism plates to be easily mounted
included)
and adjusted when fixing to angled walls or
cladding
The small prism plate will securely
mount a single prism and is
designed to be used in
conjunction with the Universal
Mounting Bracket (not included)
The Flat Mounting plate is a metal plate
which will support a single prism or 4 prisms,
the side mounting holes are compatible with
Unistrut® racking systems.
Product Codes
5000-005
5000-006
5000-007
5000-008
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Universal Mounting Bracket
Flat Mounting Plate for 1 to 4 Prisms
Prism Mounting Plate for 4 Prisms
Prism Mounting Plate for 1 Prism
Chapter 3 Page 17
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 18
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Linear Heat Detectors
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
Easy and cost effective installation
Good sensitivity with adjustable alarm threshold
Open and short circuit monitoring
Suited for outdoor and indoor applications
Can be used in hazardous areas
Mechanical protection is provided for cables in areas
where damage may occur
• Chemical resistance sheathing is available for areas
where petro-chemical corrosion may occur.
Linear Heat Detection
The LD40 linear heat detection system is used to monitor
fire (or overheat) conditions in confined or polluted areas or
where there are adverse or unusually variable
environmental conditions.
The sensor cable is unaffected by dust, moisture or
vibration and requires little maintenance.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Dimensions:
Weight:
Operating Temp:
Relative humidity:
Rating:
Operating Voltage:
Quiescent Current:
516.016.005
Ceiling Clip
Pipe Clip
178H x 130W x 75D mm
0.55Kg
-25°C to +70°C
Up to 98% RH non-condensing
IP55
+8 to +30Vdc
60-80μA
Edge Clip
516.016.006
516.016.010
516.016.011
516.016.012
516.016.201
516.016.202
516.016.203
516.016.204
516.016.205
516.016.206
516.016.207
516.016.208
516.016.209
516.016.210
LD40 High resistance sensor cable blue 200M reel
LD40 High resistance sensor cable black
- 200M reel (Nylon sheath suitable for
petrochemical exposure)
LD40 EOL Termination kit (PK10)
LD40 In-line Jointing kit
LD40 Analyser module with conventional
detection zone interface.
B6782-003 EDGE CLIP 2-3mm WEB
B6782-024 EDGE CLIP 3-8mm WEB
B6782-025 EDGE CLIP 8-13mm WEB
B6782-026 EDGE CLIP 14-20mm WEB
B6782-004 'T' CLIP
B6782-005 PIPE CLIP
B6782-023 'V' CLIP
B6782-008 NEOPRENE SLEEVE
B6782-151 THERMAL SPACER
B6782-152 THERMAL SPACER
Thermal Spacer
V Clip
Chapter 3 Page 18
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 19
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Detector Bases and Accessories
Features
•
•
•
•
Optional relay bases
Remote indication LEDs
Optional conduit entry backboxes
Protective wire cages
Detector Bases and Ancillaries
The 600 Series range of low profile detectors provide a
comprehensive range of highly effective and aesthetically
pleasing smoke and heat detectors with worldwide
approvals.
The unique design and leading edge technology of the
detectors go beyond the detection technology itself.
The range of detector bases is designed to make low
profile detector installations cost effective, aesthetically
pleasing and easy to install and maintain – thus minimising
disruption.
09/10
The detector bases include standard universal bases,
which have no integral electronics, thus making them low
cost and low maintenance. Alternatively, a range of
functional bases incorporate sounders and relays to
provide a cost effective method of adding functions and
flexibility to the fire detection installation.
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 19
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 20
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
The standard universal detector bases are compatible with the Series 600 low profile detectors. The standard bases have
no electronics and even when the detectors are connected to the bases, they can be electrically disconnected and left in
a ‘park’ position. This enables wiring integrity tests to take place without any damage to electronics. An optional, tool
removable locking pin allows the detector to be fixed in place to prevent tampering.
5B-5 Inch Universal Detector Base
This is the most commonly used
base. It is fully EN54 approved for
use with the Series 600 conventional
range of detectors.
Product Code
517.050.017
5B 5” Universal Base LPCB
If used it will require a separately
supplied tool to remove a detector
from the base.
Features
• Drives a remote indicator
• Detector locking pin with every
base
• Temporary Park position
• Fits directly to a British or
European conduit box or directly
onto the ceiling.
• Break-outs for surface installation
5BD-5 Inch Conventional Diode Continuity Base
The 5BD Continuity Base is a
standard 5 inch base fitted with a
continuity diode, for use with all
Series 600 detectors. The base is
designed to ensure that conventional
systems meet the requirements of
BS5839 Pt:1 for callpoints placed
after detectors.
Chapter 3 Page 20
Features
• Compatible with Series 600 Low
Profile Detector Range
• Designed for two wire operation
• Facility to drive a remote indicator
• A breakout locking key is
provided as an integral part of
each base, which can be fitted to
lock the detector into position.
• A temporary park position is
provided so that the field wiring
can be tested with the detector in
situ.
• Maybe fitted directly to a British
or European conduit box or
directly onto the ceiling
Fire Catalogue
Product Code
517.050.600
5 BD 5” Conventional Diode
Continuity Base LPCB
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 21
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Functional Detector Bases
Functional detector bases use a common moulding which
incorporates a double sided circuit board which enables
electrical connections to be made on the top and bottom of
the functional base. This allows the functional bases to be
retrofitted into new and existing universal bases or
alternatively the depth and cost of the installed detector can
be reduced by using the functional base instead of the
universal base.
This feature enables additional sounders to be easily added
during commissioning. In addition, changes to the building
during it’s life can be easily adapted to, by retrofitting
sounders and relay outputs to existing detection points.
When functional bases are fitted to universal bases, they
automatically lock into position. Removal is then achieved
using the detector removal tool. This feature ensures that
the detector and functional bases are removed separately.
Manual - Vol/01B-09-D1/01B-07-D1 “Detectors Fire Manual”
Tyco MKII Sounder Base
A new low current range of sounder
bases for use with Conventional Fire
Alarm Control Panels.
Features
• Manufactured to EN54 part 3
• Integral sounder and detector
base
• Volume and tone adjustable after
installation
• Low Power Synchronisation
• Do not require use of a standard
base (maybe installed directly
onto a standard besa box)
Product Codes
577.001.035
601SB Conventional Sounder Base
577.001.037
601SBD Conventional Diode Sounder
Base
577.001.036
602SB 2 Wire Line Powered Sounder
Base
577.001.038
602SBD 2 Wire Line Powered Diode
Sounder Base
517.050.022
Volume Pot Spare Cover (1 sheet of
144)
517.050.005
4” Detector Base Locking Pin Kit
(PK100)
Tyco MKII Sounder Cap
A plastic cap which fits onto the
601SB/601SBD/602SB/602SBD
Sounder Base to enable these
bases to operate as a sounder
without fitting a detector.
Product Codes
557.001.040.A
Mark II Sounder Cap (ADT Branded)
557.001.040.Y
Mark II Sounder Cap (Tyco Branded)
MC600 Functional Relay Base
The 600 Series relay base provides
dual relay contacts for signalling
external devices on conventional
detection systems. Very low
operating current even when the
relay is energised, enable the relay
base to be used without additional
power. The relay contacts operate
when the detector enters the alarm
condition.
Features
• Dual pole 24Vdc relay contact
(60VA)
• Status indicator LED
• Low power consumption (<20μA
except start up)
• Latching operation
• Can be used instead of a standard base
• Requires diode fitting if used in
place of a diode base.
Vibration:
Exceeds
requirements of
EN54-3, Marine
& UL268
Product Code
568.001.018
MC600 Relay base (BS5839)
Technical Specification
Operating Temp.:
-25°C to +70°C
Humidity:
Up to 95% RH
(noncondensing)
Volume Adjustment Tool
A simple Volume Adjustment Tool,
specific to the task of sounder
volume selection on the “variablevolume” range of Tyco MKII Sounder
Bases.
Sounder volume can be easily varied
between the maximum 90dBA and
minimum 68dBA volume settings,
using this simple, functional tool.
Product Code
517.050.015
Volume Adjustment Tool
Note: Sounder Bases are supplied
with the volume pre-set to maximum
volume.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 21
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 22
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Remote Indication LED
All detector bases have the ability to
drive a remote LED in the event that
the installed position of the detector
is not easily visible.
Features
• UK Single gang mounting
• High intensity red LED
Product Code
540.003.006
Remote LED
Features
• 2 x 18mm conduit entries
• 2 x 21mm conduit entries
• Fits all 5” Bases
• Fitted with terminal, if more are
required use optional accessory
kit
Product Codes
517.050.604
EM5B mounting base
517.050.612
Base accessory terminal kit
(pack of 10)
with 1 terminal. If more are required,
use the optional base accessory kit.
Product Codes
517.050.603
Deckhead mounting
517.050.612
Base accessory terminal kit
(pack of 10)
EM-5B Euro Mounting
The euro-mounting base provides a
matching back box, which allows the
standard MUB to be ceiling mounted
with conduit entries for standard 18
and 21mm conduit.
DHM-5B - Deck Head Mounting
Where the detectors are mounted in
humid and environmentally
challenging situations such as
marine or offshore installations, the
DHM 5B deck head mount provides
a sealed waterproof mounting which
protects the electrical connections in
the base. Can be screwed, bolted or
welded to the deckhead. Supplied
Features
• 4 x 20mm gland entries
• Fits ALL 5” bases
• IP55 with supplied gasket
Protective Detector Cage
Robust steel protective cage for
Series 600 detectors using the 5”
base. Ideal for schools and sporthalls
or whenever detectors need
protection.
Strong coated steel construction with
4 point fitting.
Product Code
517.050.614
CW-5B Detector Cage
Protective Detector/Sounder Base Cage
White powder coated steel protective
cage for Series 600 Detectors fitted
with a sounder base. Internal
dimensions: 120mm dia x 80mm
deep.
Chapter 3 Page 22
Product Code
517.050.011
Steel Protective Detector Cage
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 23
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Duct Probes
SMP Duct Probe Units
Where smoke within duct work needs to be detected these
duct probe units provide an economical solution, for use
with series 600 detectors. .
The SMP Duct Probe Units are designed to be installed in
air conditioning supply and exhaust ducts for the purpose
of monitoring the airflow for smoke and combustion
products.
The SMP69 probe units are designed to accept and operate
with series 600 detectors. For general applications it is
recommended that photoelectric smoke detectors rather
than ionisation smoke detectors are used.
The SMP stainless steel probe unit is designed to withstand
the more demanding environments of the offshore oil and
gas industries.
Warning
Duct probe units sited in the common duct work to several extract grills
may fail to respond to smoke from any one extract due to the effect of
dilution. The SMP units will not respond to airflow of less than
1.5m/sec.
Technical Specification
Operating temperature:
-20°C to +70°C
Storage temperature:
-25°C to +80°C
Relative Humidity:
0 to 95%
SMP69
Stainless steel 316 housing
with transparent
polycarbonate cover
The units are designed to operate in airspeeds of 1.5 to 25
metres per second. A range of sampling tubes from 525mm
to 1575mm are available.
Height
Width
Length
Weight
SMP69
90mm
150mm
225mm
1.2Kg
SMP69 Duct Probe Air Sampling - Stainless Steel
Product Codes
517.025.035
SMP69 Stainless Steel Duct Probe
unit and universal detector base for
Series 600/800 Detectors.
517.025.028
DPS450 Probe tube stainless steel
450mm and exhaust
517.025.029
DPS600 Probe tube stainless steel
600mm and exhaust
517.025.030
DPS750 Probe tube stainless steel
750mm and exhaust
09/10
517.025.031
DPS900 Probe tube stainless steel
900mm and exhaust
517.025.032
DPS 1200 Probe tube stainless steel
1200mm and exhaust
517.025.033
DPS1500 Probe tube stainless steel
1500mm and exhaust
Datasheet - Product Code PSF092
“SMP69 Duct Probe Unit”
Manual - Vol01B-06-D1 “Detectors
Fire Manual
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 23
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 24
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Features
• Built-in MZX Detector base
DPK4 - with built-in MZX detector base 5" - 5B
• DPK4 is suitable for conventional systems
• Suitable for air velocities from 1 m/s to 20 m/s
• Can be used in combination with a wide range of optical
smoke detectors e.g. 601P or 601PH
• One-pipe air sampling system simplifies installation
• Range of aluminium probe tubes are available for ducts
up to 2700 mm
• Transparent lid allows detector to be seen
• Test hole on cover
• Sensitive flow indicator
• Simple service and maintenance
• Installer friendly connection of cables
• Easy installation of duct probe tubes
DPK4 Duct Probe
The DPK4 duct probe unit have been
developed to detect smoke in ventilation ducts. They offer
significant benefits in terms of performance and installation.
The system comprises a single duct probe tube and
housing specially designed for optimum airflow through the
smoke detector and suitable for use in incoming, outgoing
and circulation air ducts of ventilation and conditioning
systems.
The duct probes can operate across a wide range of airflow
speeds and are especially recommended for installations in
ducts with air flow velocities between 1 m/s and 20 m/s.
Unlike more traditional duct probe units that employ an inlet
and exhaust tube with sampling holes, the DPK4 unit uses
a highly efficient single sampling tube that is slotted along
its length. This allows the sampling tubes to be cut to the
desired length whilst maintaining maximum efficiency.
The transparent cover gives clear visibility of the detector,
its LED indication and airflow indicator. A red plastic flag is
fixed inside the housing providing a simple but effective
confirmation that there is no leakage and that the air flow
from the air duct is in fact passing through the housing.
In order to reduce the time required to test the duct probe
detector during routine maintenance, an aperture is
provided that allows aerosol test gas to be directed at the
detector without having to dismantle the unit.
Accessories
Tyco Safety Products offer 3 lengths of the duct probe
tubes. The tube is made of aluminium and can easily be
shortened to suit the span of the air duct. Where the unit is
mounted on insulated or circular air ducts, the DPKM
mounting bracket is required.
Product Codes
517.025.049
517.025.051
517.025.052
517.025.053
517.025.054
517.025.055
DPK4 - Duct Probe with MZX
detector base 5" - 5B
DPK600 - Duct Probe Tube 600 mm
DPK1500 - Duct Probe Tube 1500 mm
DPK2800 - Duct Probe Tube 2800 mm
DPKM - Duct Probe Mounting Bracket
Spare Filters for DPK4/DPK4I (Pk 10)
Detector supplied separately
Chapter 3 Page 24
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 25
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Callpoints
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
Integral LED indicator for easy identification of operation
Surface or flush mounting
Extensive range of conventional callpoints
Test key facility, speeds maintenance visits
Optional transparent hinged cover
Hazardous areas models available (See Special Hazards
Section)
• IP67 Waterproof models for external applications
MCP Series Callpoints
A comprehensive range of callpoints for use with
conventional systems. All the callpoints are designed to
enable an alarm signal to be given by breaking a glass
element.
This operates a switch and is indicated by an LED indicator.
If required, an optional transparent hinged cover may be
installed to guard against accidental operation.
Technical Specification
(Indoor & Outdoor)
Housing:
Operating Temp.:
Outdoor
Indoor
Relative Humidity:
PC/ABS
-30oC TO +70oC
-10oC TO +55oC
up to 95% RH (non-condensing)
Commonly Used Callpoints
Model
MCP200
MCP210
MCP230
MCP270
Keyswitch
Colour
Red
Red
Red
Yellow
White
Type
Conventional
Conventional
Conventional
Conventional
Conventional
IP Rating
24D
24D
67
24D
24D
Alert
Evacuate
Alert
Evacuate
R4/R1 Ohms
120/470
47/39
120/470
47/39
Not Applicable
Indoor & Outdoor MCP Callpoint
Indoor Callpoint
Weight: 110g
09/10
Outdoor Callpoint
Weight: 240g
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 25
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 26
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Conventional MCP200 Callpoint
The MCP200 is a red indoor callpoint
with ‘alert’ resistors and LED
indicator. The MCP200 is LPCB
approved.
Product Codes
514.001.142.A
MCP200 without backbox-ADT
branded
514.001.142.T
MCP200 without backbox - Thorn
branded
514.001.142.Y
MCP200 without backbox - Tyco
branded
Conventional MCP210/MCP211 Callpoint
The MCP210 is a red indoor callpoint
with LED indicator and evacuate
resistors. The MCP210 is LPCB
approved and is supplied without a
backbox.
Product Codes
514.001.143.A
MCP210 ADT branded
514.001.143.T
MCP210 Thorn branded
514.001.143.Y
MCP210 Tyco branded
The MCP211 is a red indoor callpoint
with evacuate resistors and LED
indicator. (For use with the
MZX-c Panels only).
514.001.160.Y
MCP211 Without backbox - Tyco
branded
514.001.160.A
MCP211 Without backbox - ADT
branded
514.001.160.T
MCP211 Without backbox - Thorn
branded
Conventional MCP230 Callpoint
The MCP230 is an IP67 red
weatherproof callpoint with LED
indicator and LPCB approved.
Product Codes
514.001.110.A
MCP230 ADT branded
514.001.110.T
MCP230 Thorn branded
514.001.110.Y
MCP230 Tyco branded
Conventional MCP270 Callpoint
Product Code
514.001.114
MCP270 Yellow callpoint ‘Evacuate’
complete with LED indicator and
backbox - LPCB approved
Other Conventional Callpoints & Keyswitches
Product Code
514.002.002.A
White keyswitch in callpoint housing.
English ‘Bomb Alert’ marking with
ADT branded
Special Marine Callpoints
Product Codes
514.001.112
MCP260M Marine callpoint complete
with LED indicator - IP67
Chapter 3 Page 26
514.001.113
MCP250M Marine callpoint complete
with LED indicator surface mount
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 27
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Callpoint Ancillaries
Product Codes
90-107
Red M141 spacer for red MCP KAC
callpoints
515.001.045
Test keys for all MCP and CP style callpoints
515.001.128
Callpoint hinged cover for use on
MCP & CP style callpoint models
(Colour -Clear)
515.001.026
Black callpoint bezel for MCP KAC
callpoints
Ancillaries - Back Boxes
Product Codes
515.001.021
Standard Red surface mounting back
box for MCP & CP indoor callpoints
Unless stated the indoor callpoints are supplied
as flush mount units. The range is approved for
use with the standard backbox. However, the
SR2-T backbox is also available.
10-115
SR2-T Optional Back Box (2
terminals) for MCP & CP indoor
callpoints
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 27
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 28
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Callpoint Spare Glasses - Current
Product Codes
515.001.119
EN54 Part 11 Spare Glass for MCP
and CP series Callpoints (Pack of 5)
515.001.025
CP200 Glasses, clear English text
on white background. No logo
(Pack of 5).
515.001.127
Deformable operating unit “glass”
for use in place of glasses, for
kitchens or other areas where glass
is not acceptable. For MCP
callpoints only.
515.001.024
CP200 spare glasses, white
Arabic/English text with Thorn
Security logo on white background
(Pack of 5)
515.001.014
CP200 Spare glasses, black Arabic
text on a white background
(Pack of 5)
515.001.023
CP200 Spare glasses for CP200
white dutch text on clear
background (Pack of 5)
Callpoint Spare Glasses - Old
Product Codes
515.001.010
Walsall callpoint glasses (Pack of 10)
for service spares. The Walsall
callpoint is an old square callpoint
with round glass
515.001.003
ZF121 Callpoint glass (Pack 10) for
service spares. The ZF121 is a
square metal fronted AFA MINERVA
callpoint typically used on Firefinder,
System 1100, ZF/System 1200, CP
and CT systems
515.001.009
CP100A glass unscored (Pack 10)
for service spares. The CP100A has
a large square glass to the edge of
the callpoint. Used on the same AFA
systems as the ZF121.
Chapter 3 Page 28
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 29
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Features
• Prevents accidental operation of callpoints
• Strong polycarbonate construction
• Optional break seal kit
STOPPER
The callpoint STOPPER provides protection from malicious or
accidental activation of manual callpoints. Available for flush or
surface mounted callpoints the ‘STOPPER’ is also available
with optional high pitch sounder which is activated when the lid
is lifted. An optional ‘Break-Seal’ fitting kit allows ‘Break-Seals’
to be used to provide extra protection.
Product Code
515.001.029
515.001.030
515.001.036
515.001.034
515.001.035
515.001.031
515.001.032
Ref
STI6530
STI6531
STI6535
STI1230
STI3150
STI6532
STI6533
STOPPER
Flush
Surface
4
4
4
4
WARNING:- Break seals only to be fitted by agreement with
relevant fire authorities.
The STOPPER is suitable for all callpoints up to 100mm
square, including the MCP200 and other indoor KAC style
callpoints.
STOPPER II
4
4
4
With Sounder
Weatherproof
4
4
4
4
Product Code
STOPPER Dimensions
515.001.033
IPO36 Break Seal Kit (pack of 1)
Flush Fit
Surface Fit
(+30mm)
Millimetres
A 137
B 140
C 104
D
45
E 12.5
F 12.5
G 185
H 12.5
Stopper
STI6530
Stopper with Sounder STI6532
STI6531
STI6533
STOPPER
STOPPER II
Max. Callpoint Size 100 x 100mm 160 x 160 mm
Max. Callpoint Depth
57.5
120
(+30mm Surface)
STOPPER II Dimensions
Millimetres
A
70
B
16
C 197
D
50
E 178
F 146
G 228
H 254
09/10
Stopper II Surface Fit - STI1230
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 29
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 30
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Features
• Strong polycarbonate construction
• Will accommodate MCP230 callpoints
• Tamper resistant
STOPPER II
STOPPER II is constructed as the STOPPER from tough
injection moulded polycarbonate. Physically larger than the
STOPPER the STOPPER II extends the number of
products to which these tough multi-purpose covers can
protect.
It consists of a strong tamper-proof clear polycarbonate
cover and frame that fits easily over such products as break
glass callpoints.
STOPPER II can also be fitted with an integral battery
powered sounder which activates if the cover is lifted.
The STOPPER II is suitable for callpoints up to 160mm
square.
Product Code
515.001.034
STI1230 Surface Fit STOPPER II
Features
• Strong polycarbonate construction
• Provides environmental protection
• Ideal for offshore environments
Weather STOPPER & Weather STOPPER II
The Weather STOPPER and Weather STOPPER II extends
the life of weather exposed devices, such as break glass
callpoints, by offering protection against harsh conditions
and environments. Experience has shown that this
protective cover can extend the life of products installed in
saline atmospheres, such as oil rigs and ship decks.
While offering environmental protection the Weather
STOPPER and Weather STOPPER II are constructed from
tough durable polycarbonate which will also guard against
tampering, vandalism or accidental operation of devices
such as emergency switches.
Product Codes
515.001.036
515.001.035
Chapter 3 Page 30
Fire Catalogue
STI6535 Surface fit Weather
STOPPER
STI3150 Surface fit Weather
STOPPER II
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 31
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Smoke Beam/CCTV Guard
The Smoke Beam/CCTV Guard is
manufactured from tough coated
steel rod and is designed to protect
projected beam detectors or CCTV
cameras from vandalism or
accidental damage.
Suitable for use with System Sensor,
Hochiki and Fireray 2000 detectors.
Product Code
516.015.009
STI9625 Smoke beam/CCTV guard
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
260H x 200W x
321D mm
Keybox
This tough polycarbonate breakglass
keybox is available to protect
emergency keys.
09/10
Product Code
515.001.043
STI6720 Keybox with printed glass
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 31
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 32
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Sounders and Beacons
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wide range of both bells and electronic sounders
High sound output characteristics
Low current consumption
Clean lines, modern styling
Easy to install, low installation costs
Weatherproof units for outdoor use
Distinct sounds are available
Motorised and Solenoid bells available
Wide range of voltages available
Sounders
A range of sounders to meet a wide variety of alarm
applications where loud, penetrating and distinctive
warnings must be given to alert people of fire situations.
In addition, multitone electronic sounders can give a variety
of sounds to signal other conditions e.g.“extinguishing gas
release imminent,” etc.
Note: For I.S. & Flameproof sounders, please see the special hazards section.
Chapter 3 Page 32
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 33
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Features
• Solenoid Operated
• Designed for Long Life
• Stove Enamelled Dome
6” Red Solenoid Operated Friedland Bell
The bells are the underdome type, with a high resonance
pressed alloy-steel gong to ensure a loud clear ring tone.
The operating mechanism is fully enclosed and the gong is
red stove enamelled for long life. The bells are designed
for internal use, but gasket sealed conduit boxes can be
provided for external use.
Product Codes
576.500.014
576.500.015
577.001.002
240V Red bell 6” 240Vac solenoid
operated. ‘Fire’ text
24V Red bell 6” 24Vdc solenoid
operated. ‘Fire’ text
Weatherproof gasket box for use with
Solenoid operated bells
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
CE marked
Low current 6” bell (ONLY 11mA)
Low cost
Extra high 95dBA/m
Slim profile (53mm)
Fully suppressed and polarised
Quick and easy to install
LPCB approved to EN54 Pt 3
6” & 8” Motorised Bells
Product Codes
Model
MBF-6EV
MBF-8EV
MBA 8EV
Rated Voltage 24V d.c.
24V d.c.
24V d.c.
Rated Current
11mA
17mA
18mA
Sound output 90-95dBA
90-97dBA
91-97dBA
Operating Temp
-12 to +50°C
-10 to +50°C
Colour
Red
Weight
410g
640g
1100g with back box
576.501.039.A
576.501.039.T
576.501.040.A
576.501.044.A
576.501.044.T
576.501.045
09/10
Fire Catalogue
MBF-6EV ADT Branded
MBF-6EV Thorn Branded
MBF-8EV ADT Branded
MBA-8EV ADT Branded
MBA-8EV Thorn Branded
BBX4 (2) W/P Backbox for MBA-8 Bell
Chapter 3 Page 33
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 34
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Features
• Weatherproof Option
• Flexible Mounting Option
• Attractive Design
Electronic Solenoid Bell
Unique patented alarm bell with miniature solenoid and
integrated electronic control. No backbox required for
surface wiring.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Dimensions:
Voltage:
Typical Current:
Typ. Sound Output:
20-100 6” 24Vdc Electronic bell, weatherproof
20-101 6” 24Vdc Electronic bell - red
20-111 6” 24Vdc Electronic bell - white
Chapter 3 Page 34
6” diameter
18-30Vdc
24Vdc@30mA
94dB (A)@1m
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 35
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Features
•
•
•
•
•
New Aesthetic Design
32 Selectable Tones
3 Volume Settings
Push and Twist Mount
Low Current Consumption
Banshee Multi-Tone Sounder
The Banshee Multi-Tone Sounder replaces the well
established range of Banshee and Bedlam sounders.
The new range provides a compact unit capable of 32
tones and also incorporating a volume control.
The Banshee is easily installed and is fitted with robust
loop through terminations. The design incorporates a
bayonet push and fit feature for easy installations.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
LPCB and Vds approved to EN54 pt 3
Low Current consumption
32 Tones
3 Volume settings
Rated at IP66 or IP45
Operating temperature:
-40°C to +70°C
Operating Voltage:
9 to 30 Vdc
576.501.005.A
576.501.005.T
576.501.016.A
576.501.016.T
576.501.025.A
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Banshee Multi-Tone Sounder Red, Low
profile base (ADT) (Replaces
576.501.004.A & 576.001.008.A)
Banshee Multi-Tone Sounder Red, Low
profile base (Thorn) (Replaces
576.501.004.T, 576.501.008.T &
576.501.019)
Banshee Multi-Tone Sounder Red,
Weather Proof base (ADT)
(Replaces 576.501.015.A &
576.501.024.A)
Banshee Multi-Tone Sounder Red,
Weather Proof base (Thorn) (Replaces
576.501.015.T & 576.501.024.T)
Banshee Multi-Tone Sounder White, Low
Profile base (ADT) (Replaces
576.501.033.A)
Chapter 3 Page 35
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 36
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Accessories
The combined mounting bracket for
the Besson Multi-tone Banshee and
Xenon Beacon allows quick and
neat installation of combined
sounders and beacons. The
bracket allows the following
electronic sounders to be mounted
with the range of 1W Xenon
Beacons:
• Besson Banshee
• MINERVA FIRECRYER voice
enhanced sounder
The bracket can be used with any of
the 24Vd.c 1W Xenon beacons in
red, clear, amber or blue (Part no.'s
540.001.030/031/032 & 033)
Product Code
576.501.047
Banshee/Xenon bracket
Technical Specification
Current:
4mA to 15mA
Temperature Range: -40°C to + 70°C
Dimensions:
Dia 103mm,
Height 22mm
(excluding
coverplate)
Product Code
576.501.038
Besson wafer sounder and blank
cover in white
Meeting the requirements for
BS5839 part 1, the Bedroom
Sounder range is well suited to
hotels and residential environments
where aesthetics is a prime
concern. Matching the sound
output of the Banshee range of
sounders so therefore they can be
mixed on the same site.
Features
• Low current consumption 7mA
• Dual sound options selected via
a jumper switch: ‘Continuous’
and ‘Fast Sweep’ 90dB
• Can be both Flush and Surface
mounted
• Robust terminal connectors to
accommodate up to 2.5mm2
conductors
Product Codes
576.501.032.A
Flush Mount Sounder ADT Branded
576.501.032.T
Flush Mount Sounder Thorn
Branded
This versatile range of sounders are
ideally suited for fire, safety and
security hazard warning.
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
YO3:
89H x 89W x 85D mm
YO5:
134H x 134W x 128D mm
YO8:
216H x 216W x 153D mm
Product Codes
576.501.001
YO3 Yodalarm 3” 24Vdc 100dB @
1Mtr
576.501.002
YO5 Yodalarm 5” 24Vdc 106dB @
1Mtr
576.501.003
YO8 Yodalarm 8” 24Vdc 112dB @
1Mtr
Besson Wafer Sounder
The standard Besson Wafer
sounder is supplied in white with a
blank cover included. The
specification is as follows:
Input voltage: 24V d.c. (+/-25%)
Sound Output: 60dBA/90dBA at 1m
typical (pot. Adjustable) offering the
same sound formats as the
Banshee sounder range. It can
therefore be used in conjunction
with the Banshee sounders on the
same site.
Flush Mount Bedroom Sounder
Yodalarms
Chapter 3 Page 36
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 37
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
MZX-c 2 Wire Symphoni Sounder
A Symphoni electronic sounder
designed specifically for installation
on the detection zone of the MZX-c
panel
Technical Specification
Sound Output @ 1M: 100dB(A)
+/-2dB(A) @ 24Vdc
Tones:
Continuous - 970Hz
Alternating - 970/800
Hz at 2 Hz
Pulsed - 970 Hz at 1Hz
Operating Temp:
-25 to+70 C
Construction: Red/White ABS
Ingress Protection: IP42
Termination: 2.5mm2 Screw Terminals
Product Codes
576.501.204
Symphoni 2 Wire Sounder (Red)
576.501.205
Symphoni 2 Wire Sounder (White)
24Vdc Symphoni Sounder
The 24Vdc Symphoni Sounder is a
general purpose internal sounder,
available either as a very high output
sounder for noisy areas, or a high
output low current sounder for
applications where power is limited.
Both versions share the same horn
and backbox which has double
cable entries for ease of installation.
The low power version has 3
selectable tones which may be
employed for one, two or three stage
alarm applications. The high output
version has 32 selectable tones and
retains full tone compatibility with the
Roshni, Squashni and Askari product
ranges.
Product Codes
576.501.200
SY/R Low Power Red Symphoni
Sounder (3 tone)
576.501.201
SY/W Low Power White Symphoni
Sounder (3 tone)
576.501.202
SYHO/R High Output Red Symphoni
Sounder (32 tone)
576.501.203
SYHO/W High Output White
Symphoni Sounder (32 tone)
Technical Specification
Model
Operation
Operating Voltage Range
Sound Output @ 1m
Volume Control
Current Consumption
Tones
Symphoni High Output
2 Hours Continuous
9-28Vdc
Up to 120dB(A)
Synchronisation
Frequency Stability
Operating Temperature
Line Monitoring Method
Construction
Ingress Protection
Weight
Synchronised Start
+/- 0.15%
-25 °C to +55°C
Polarised Input
ABS Plastic Case
IP42
0.58Kg
240mA +/- 20mA on Tone 3
1 to 32
Symphoni (Low Power)
Continuous
12-30Vdc
100dB(A) +/- 2dB(A) @24Vd. c.
Down to 80dB approx.
5mA +/- 1mA at all volumes
Alternating 990Hz/650Hz@2Hz
Continuous 990Hz
Intermittent 990Hz, On/Off@1Hz
Synchronised Start
+/- 0.5%
-25°C to +70°C
Polarised Input
ABS Plastic Case
IP42
0.212Kg
Roshni
A flexible alarm sounder for Fire and
Security applications complete with
volume control and dil switch to
provide 32 tones.
Low profile Roshni with Deep base
offers IP65 protection. All Roshni
sounders have synchronised start for
self synchronisation without third
wire.
09/10
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
93 Dia x
105D mm
(Deep base)
Colour:
Red or white
Output Voltage:
9-28Vdc
Typical Current:
24Vdc@16mA
Typ. Sound Output: @1m 102dB
Product Codes
ROSHRDSR
ROSHNI Sounder c/w deep base red
Fire Catalogue
576.501.220
ROSHNI Sounder c/w shallow base red
576.501.221
ROSHNI Sounder c/w shallow base white
576.501.222
ROSHNI/Flashni Deep Base - Red
576.501.223
ROSHNI/Flashni Deep Base - White
Chapter 3 Page 37
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 38
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Squashni
The Squashni electronic sounder is
the original ceiling sounder for use
as a universal fire detector platform
or as a stand alone sounder
complete with blank cover. It comes
preset to tone 3 with a volume
control and is fully compatible with
Roshni tones, and has a
synchronised start.
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
112 Dia x 27D mm
Colour:
Matched to
leading fire
detector
manufacturers
Approvals:
None
Output Voltage: 9-28Vdc
Typical Current: 24Vdc@16mA
Typ. Sound Output: @1m 93dB (A)
Product Codes
576.501.030
Squashni white 24Vdc
576.501.031
Blank cover plate white for Squashni
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
87.5H x 87.5W
x 36D mm
Colour:
Red or white
Product Codes
576.501.242
Multi Tone Askari Compact
Sounder - white
576.501.243
Multi Tone Askari Compact
Sounder - red
Multi-Tone Askari Compact
The Multi-Tone Askari Compact is a
compact bedroom sounder for
unobtrusive installation. It comes
with a volume control and is fully
compatible with Roshni tones and
has a synchronised start. A surface
mount backbox is available from the
supplier to special order.
Chapter 3 Page 38
Approvals:
Input Voltage:
Typ. Current:
Typ. Sound Output:
Fire Catalogue
BS 5839 pt 1
9-28Vdc
18mA @ 24Vdc
97dB (A) @1m
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 39
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Features
• 4 predefined voice messages
• Custom messages available
• Low current consumption
Firecryer
The FIRECRYER is an electronic sounder which provides as
default the same electronic sound as the MT Besson
Banshee and in addition, provides 4 predefined voice
messages, which can be synchronised across a zone of
sounders.
The FIRECRYER offers an excellent service upgrade
opportunity in the UK for systems installed to BS5839pt1
and may also provide opportunities elsewhere.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Dimensions:
576.501.042
Operating Voltage:
Current Consumption:
Sound output:
Voice message:
Polarity D.C.
Operating Temp:
Humidity:
Weatherproofing:
IP45 - 92dia 61.3 Hmm
IP66 - 92dia 85.5 Hmm
Nominally 24Vdc
Min. 18Vdc Max. 30Vdc
Average 19mA
Min. 10mA
Max. 23mA
(Subject to message)
Fast sweep - 100dBA
97dBA approx
reverse polarity protection
-25°C to +70°C
90% relative humidity
(non-condensing)
Standard base IP45
Special base IP66
Red Flame-retardant ABS
576.501.052
576.501.051
576.501.035.A
576.501.104.A
576.501.105
Banshee IP66 backbox for Firecryer
Sounders
Mini Fire Cryer Voice Enhanced Base
Sounder Cable Spacing Ring
Multi Message Synchronised Mini Fire
Cryer Voice Enhanced Base Sounder
MFC4SUA 4 message Red ADT Branded
Fire Cryer Sounder
MFC4SCA Custom Message Red ADT
Branded Fire Cryer Sounder
MFC-CM Fire Cryer Custom Message
Chip
Housing Material:
Standard Messages:
AK - “Fire Emergency, please remain calm and evacuate
the building immediately.”
AB - “This is a fire alert. This is a fire alert. Await further
instructions. Await further instructions.”
SP - “This is an ADT fire alarm test. No action required.”
AD - “Fire Alarm Test Now Complete.”
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 39
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 40
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
FIRECRYER cont’d
Additional Features
Four Message
With four messages fire tests can be easily differentiated
from alert and evacuate messages.
Two Wire Connection
The FIRECRYER uses a standard 2 wire 24V d.c. connection to carry power, message switching and message
synchronisation. This enables a quick and easy upgrade
to existing bells and sounders.
MINERVA MT Banshee Compatible
The electronic alarm sound and mechanics of the FIRECRYER are the same as other Banshee sounders in the
range. This allows them to be mixed with other sounders
in a zone. It also means that existing Banshees can be
very quickly upgraded to FIRECRYERs.
Multi Message Variants
Multi-message versions only require a multi-message
switching PCB added at the fire panel which then allows
all FIRECRYERS on two sounder circuits to be synchronised.
Low Power
The FIRECRYER takes marginally more power than an
equivalent electronic sounder. This enables voice
enhanced sounders to be offered without the high additional cost of large battery backups.
Standard Products
The FIRECRYER is available in ADT branding with predefined English messages and 100dBA fast sweep alert
sound to comply with BS5839Pt1. Other variants with
different branding, languages, messages and different
tones are available upon request.
Product Codes
Product
Message
Brand
Synchronised
Reference
1
2
3
4
576.501.035.A
MFC4SUA
AK
AB
AD
SP
ADT
Yes
576.501.104.A
*MFC4SCA
Customer Defined
ADT
Yes
576.501.051
F/C/4A
AK
AB
AD
SP
Yes
* For recording of special messages there is a charge. This can be ordered under product code
576.501.105 MFC-CM. This includes the supply of a different timer chip for the F/S/VMC
synchronisation board.
Chapter 3 Page 40
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 41
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Single Gang Lamp/Buzzer Units
Lamp Buzzer units may be used for
local alarms when high level audible
warnings may not be appropriate.
Available in flush and surface mount
versions to fit standard single gang
backboxes.
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
90H x 90W
x 40D mm
Current Rating:
15mA at 24Vdc
nominally
Features
• Low Current
• Flush or Surface Mount
• Hi-Brightness LED
Product Codes
540.011.012
Single gang flush mount LED
(red)/Buzzer Unit labelled ‘Fire
Alarm’
540.011.013
Single gang surface mount LED
(red)/Buzzer Unit labelled ‘Fire
Alarm’ c/w surface backbox.
Solista LED Beacon
Ultra low power requirement 3mA
or 6mA at 24Vdc. Long life low
profile design. Protected to IP54,
supplied complete with base.
Product Code
576.501.230
Solista LED Beacon (Red)
Easy AVTM Retrofit LED Beacon
This low power LED beacon is
designed to be retrofitted to existing
Banshee electronic sounders. Easy
and fast installation typically 3 min.
Low power 6mA max at 24Vdc.High
Output LEDs.
Product Code
576.501.012
Easy AV strobe for Banshee
Sounders
NOTE: For I.S. Flameproof Beacons, please see the special hazards section.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 3 Page 41
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 42
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Features
•
•
•
•
Available in 1, 2, 3 and 5 watts
Protected to IP65
Attractive low profile design
Optional bracket for mounting both Beacon and
Banshee Sounder
Xenon Beacons - 24V Including Surface Mount Adaptor
This high quality range of Xenon beacons are tested to IP
65 making them ideal for the most stringent applications.
Each beacon incorporates a low profile Fresnel lens
designed to give maximum light output.
Technical Specification
Voltage
V d.c.
24
24
24
24
Power Output Alarm Current
Watt(s)
mA
1
42
2
84
3
126
5
210
Flash Rate
60/min
60/min
60/min
60/min
Rating
IP65
IP65
IP65
IP65
Temp. Range
Height
-30 to +70°C
-30 to +70°C
-30 to +70°C
-30 to +70°C
Dimensions (mm)
Diameter
51
75
51
75
51
75
75
90
Product Codes
540.001.030
540.001.031
540.001.032
540.001.033
20-112
20-113
20-120
Low profile clear 24Vdc 1 watt
Low profile blue 24Vdc 1 watt
Low profile amber 24Vdc 1 watt
Low profile red 24Vdc 1 watt
Low profile red 24Vdc 2 watt
Low profile red 24Vdc 5 watt
Low profile red 24Vdc 3 watt
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
High Power – 10 Candela
Current Surge Suppression
High Efficiency – 88mA at 24VDC
1 Hz Flash Rate
Protected to IP54
Wide Operating Voltage – 10 to 60 VDC
Operating Temperature -25oC to + 70oC
Solex 10 cd Xenon Beacon
A Solex 10 Candela Xenon Beacon with a red lens and a
white shallow base which can be used wherever a high
power xenon beacon is required.
Due to the high power output and current consumption it is
recommended that this device is not used with the MZX-c,
MZX-c+ or similar small panels (an SB520 sounder booster
module and PSU may be required in some cases).
Product Code
576.501.232
Chapter 3 Page 42
Fire Catalogue
Solex 10 cd Beacon with red lens and
white base
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 43
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Features
• Combined strobe & sounder
• Matches Roshni sounders
• Weather Resistant to IP65
Flashni
A combined sounder and beacon which combines the
features of the Roshni electronic sounder with a fully
integrated Xenon beacon.
These sounders are fully compatible with all Roshni tones.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Dimensions:
20-118
Output Voltage:
Typical Current:
Typ. Sound Output:
09/10
93 Dia x 92D mm
(Shallow base)
93 Dia x 121D mm
(Deep base)
18-30Vdc
68mA@24Vdc
101dB (A)@1m
576.501.224
576.501.227
Fire Catalogue
Combined Roshni sounder/strobe
complete with deep base (IP65).
Combined Roshni Sounder/Strobe, Red
Body/Red Lens complete with shallow
base & tone switch.
Combined Roshni Sounder/Strobe, Red
Body/Red Lens, deep base, tone switch
& separate sounder/strobe operation.
Chapter 3 Page 43
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 44
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Combined Sounder and LED Beacon
Low Current -10mA @ 24VDC
6 selectable tones
Volume control (2 levels)
White housing, clear lens with red LED’s
DDA compliant audio visual solution for UK
Neat unobtrusive design
Ideal for hotels, care homes, schools & offices
Independent power cables allow a large number of AV
platform sounders to be driven from a single 24V circuit
• 90dB sound output
• >1Cd light output at 1 Hz
• Approved to EN54-3 (pending)
.
Squashni G3/AV Sounder Beacon
This low current combined sounder/beacon is ideal for
standalone usage utilising the optional blanking cap or can
be used in conjunction with a 4” base and detector. When
used with a detector it will provide a single point of
installation for the detector, sounder and beacon.
This is a conventional sounder / beacon and needs to be
powered from the panel sounder outputs.
Product Codes
576.501.250
576.501.255
517.050.401
517.050.005
Chapter 3 Page 44
Fire Catalogue
Squashni G3/AV Sounder Beacon
Squashni G3/AV Blanking Cap – Pack of 5
4” Universal Base
4” Detector Base Locking Pin Kit (PK100)
09/10
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 45
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
2 Wire for use with MZX-c Fire Controllers
Combined Sounder and LED Beacon
Low Current
4 selectable tones
Volume control (2 levels)
Beacon Only option (switchable)
White housing, clear lens with red LED’s
DDA compliant audio visual solution for UK
Neat unobtrusive design
Ideal for hotels, offices, care homes, schools & offices
90dB sound output
>1Cd Light output at 1 Hz
Maximum number per zone = 10
Squashni G3/AV 2 Wire Sounder Beacon - (Twin Wire)
This low current combined sounder beacon is designed
specifically for installation on the detection loop of the MZXc control panel. Ideal for standalone usage utilising the
optional blanking cap or can be used in conjunction with a
4” base and detector.
When used with a detector it will provide a single point of
installation for the detector, sounder and beacon.
This is a 2 wire sounder/beacon and can be used on all
zones of the MZX-c control panel.
Product Codes
576.501.251
576.501.255
517.050.401
517.050.005
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Squashni G3/AV 2 Wire Sounder Beacon
Squashni G3/AV Blanking Cap – Pack of 5
4” Universal Base
4” Detector Base Locking Pin Kit (PK100)
Chapter 3 Page 45
FIRE_Ch3_Conventional_Systems:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:09 Page 46
Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems
Service & Spares
T1200 CONVENTIONAL MARINE PANEL
MZX-e EXTINGUISHING PANEL
C1626 4 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD WITH AC PSU
(509.023.001)
C1626 4 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD WITHOUT AC PSU
(509.023.002)
C1627 16 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD WITHOUT AC
PSU (509.023.003)
C1627 16 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD WITHOUT AC
PSU FOR T1232 (509.023.004)
C1626 REPEATER MOTHERBOARD WITH AC PSU
(509.023.011)
C1626 REPEATER MOTHERBOARD WITHOUT AC PSU
(509.023.012)
C1628 4 ZONE PANEL DISPLAY PCB (509.023.021)
C1628 16 ZONE PANEL DISPLAY PCB (509.023.022)
C1629 32 ZONE PANEL DISPLAY PCB (509.023.023)
C1628 16 ZONE REPEATER DISPLAY PCB (509.023.031)
C1629 32 ZONE REPEATER DISPLAY PCB (509.023.032)
C1630 OUTPUT EXPANSION INTERFACE PCB (2605060)
C1632 16 ZONE PANEL EXPANSION PCB (509.023.042)
PS136 5.0 AMP 110/230VAC PSU (509.023.051)
PS40 1.5 AMP 24VDC PSU (509.023.052)
T1200 SPARE KEY SET (509.023.061)
MZX-c CONVENTIONAL PANEL
MZX-e SPARE KEY SET (557.201.508)
EXTINGUISHING ANCILLARIES
LAMP 28V 60mA (MCC) FOR T525 (599.001.012)
24V5WSBC SP BULB FOR E1/E3 (599.001.029)
MANUAL ALARM CALLPOINTS
ZF121 CALLPOINT GLASS (PK10) (515.001.003)
CP100A CALLPOINT GLASS UNSCORED (PK10)
(515.001.009)
WALSALL CALLPOINT GLASS (PK10) (515.001.010)
CP200 CALLPOINT GLASS-ARABIC (PK5) (515.001.014)
CP200N CALLPOINT GLASS (PK5) (515.001.023)
CP200 CALLPOINT ARABIC/ENGLISH GLASS (PK5)
(515.001.024)
CP200 CALLPOINT ENGLISH GLASS NO LOGO (PK5)
(515.001.025)
STOPPER BREAK SEAL KIT-RED (PK1) (515.001.033)
MCP/CP CALLPOINT TEST KEY (PK1) (515.001.045)
MCP/CP CALLPOINT EN54 PT11 SPARE GLASS (PK5)
(515.001.119)
DEFORMABLE MCP ELEMENT (PK1) (515.001.127)
2 ZONE 2 WIRE MZX-c MOTHERBOARD (2605508)
4 ZONE 2 WIRE MZX-c MOTHERBOARD (2605509)
8 ZONE 2 WIRE MZX-c MOTHERBOARD (2605510)
MZX-c MOTHERBOARD 8 ZONE REPEATER (2605505)
MZX-c POWER SUPPLY (BAQ35T-24)
MZX-c SPARE ENABLE KEY (2501061)
MZX-c+ CONVENTIONAL PANEL
MZX-c+
MZX-c+
MZX-c+
MZX-c+
MZX-c+
SPARE KEY SET (557.201.508)
5.0 AMP PSU - C1652 (2605071)
TRANSFORMER 1.5 AMP (2000636)
TRANSFORMER 3.0 AMP (2000637)
TRANSFORMER 5.0 AMP (2000638)
Chapter 3 Page 46
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch4_Networks_and_Graphics:Layout 1 01/09/2010 09:09 Page 1
Chapter 4 - Networks and Graphics
Tyco Expert Graphics (TXG)
Features
• Provides annunciation, status display, and control in
both normal and emergency situations
• Developed by Tyco specifically to provide monitoring
and control of fire protection life safety systems
• Supports a range of fire detection systems:Minerva® MX
Minerva®
Simplex 4100 range 4100, 4120,
4020,4100U with upgrade paths to 2120
Zettler Zetfas, Wormald PBS16, Tyco Fast 2000
• Multiple workstations can be configured for specific
functions or redundant operation
• Single monitor or two monitor (text and graphics)
support at each workstation
Emergency Management System & Fire Detection Graphical User Interface
Tyco Expert Graphics is a new client/server emergency
management system and fire detection graphical user
interface.
TXG is based on a Tyco graphical alarm monitoring system
that has been installed on hundreds of large fire detection
and alarm monitoring systems around the world and will
now be able to integrate the Minerva® MX product range
with improved functionality, particularly suited to the MX
Graph markets.
Tyco Expert Graphics provides annunciation, status display,
and control for various fire detection and alarm systems
including MX networks incorporating the latest MX
Technology™ fire detection systems. It also supports the
predecessor Minerva® fire detection systems thus ensuring
that future updates from Minerva® to MX technology™ can
be accommodated. Additional support is provided for
Simplex 4100 range, Zetfas and Fast2000\PBS (Token ring
format).
TXG is a Microsoft Windows® based graphical interface with
a high resolution colour display. Responsive touch-screen
(optional) buttons with realistic icons provide control
switches specific to the operation being performed.
Utilising a combination of symbols, floor plans, pictures,
text, voice messages and video input, TXG displays the
precise location and gives instructions on what emergency
action should be taken.
Additional Features
• Link up with I.P. CCTV camera systems, no additional
wiring, reduced installation cost for a fully integrated
fire\CCTV system
• Compatible with Flamevision® FV300 array based IR
flame detectors with built in CCTV
• MX Hotspot, chromatic analogue display. Programmable
tracking of analogue values. Changes display colour in
response to changes in analogue value from a selected
number of MX devices.
• Trending diagrams of analogue values helps reduce
maintenance time and cost
• Export analogue values to Excel for in depth analysis
• Audio descriptions of screens can be played when they
are displayed or played when an event occurs
09/10
The display can be configured to track detector inputs by
changing the colour of areas in response to changes in
analogue value. A detailed map of the area affected can be
printed automatically for use by personnel responding to an
emergency. Prompt response to a fire emergency, with the
correct action, provides the opportunity to reduce financial
loss and greatly improves safety.
Much of the work involved in configuring TXG has been
simplified through the automatic import of panel
configurations and the ability to use a wide range of input
data file types including GIF, JPG, bitmap, AutoCAD®, Vector
and WAV files.
System maintenance can be carried out via the high level
user interface with the ability to edit the position and
attributes of point icons as well as make changes to drawing
layouts. As well as simplifying maintenance, being a true
client server application means that any number of on-site or
off-site workstations can interrogate the database with
pre-defined security levels to facilitate any required
combination of access and control.
• High level user interface allows end user to make
changes to point attributes and layout further reducing
lifetime cost of ownership.
• Centralised security administration means that operator
accounts are administered through the TXG client’s
common database
• Mouse, keyboard or touch-screen control with full
multimedia compatibility
• Dual language switching
• The ability to display live video when specific predefined
alarm conditions occur
• Easy to configure and set-up. No special networking or
PC training required
• Facilities and maintenance management report and
analysis tools are available
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 4 Page 1
FIRE_Ch4_Networks_and_Graphics:Layout 1 01/09/2010 09:09 Page 2
Chapter 4 - Networks and Graphics
The IP Video feature allows real-time images of the area at
risk to be displayed in the event of an alarm or fault. Video
capture of the affected area appears on the screen
automatically, allowing the severity of the situation to be
assessed quickly and the appropriate executive action to be
taken.
AVAILABILITY AND ORDER PROCESS
For less serious incidents, expensive and unnecessary plant
shut downs can be avoided. In more critical situations,
accurate information can be quickly and efficiently
communicated to the response team.
Customers can fax or e-Mail an order form which details the
software options required, to customer service at
Letchworth. Original order forms can be obtained from
http://www.tycoemea.com/. This form will allow customer
service to prepare and allocate a license code that will
activate the required features. Customers will also be
required to place an order on JDE for each part number on
the form.
MX HOTSPOT Icons representing the devices being
monitored will change colour dependant on status, alarm,
normal, fault, isolate etc.
In addition to this, selected areas can be highlighted using
the chromatic analogue display feature, MX HOTSPOT. As
the analogue value of a monitored point changes the
chromatic analogue display will change the highlight colour
through a pre-defined range.
For example a heat detector assigned MX HOTSPOT could
transit the highlight from blue to red. The number of
chromatic steps is dependant on the resolution of the
graphics card used, 16, 24 or 32 bits.
TXG can be downloaded from the tycoemea.com website
and can be used with a time restriction for demonstration or
training purposes. TXG can also be ordered from our
Letchworth and Echt distribution centres.
A media pack containing CD with license number, dongle,
manual and original order form will be dispatched to the
customer.
On receipt, the software can be loaded and the license
number entered to make available the requested software
features.
Product Codes
508.040.100
NOTIFICATION BY EMAIL
Events, whether they are real or false alarms are handled
most efficiently when information can be quickly and
accurately communicated. TXG allows users to set up email
groups and notification texts linked to predetermined
events.
These are automatically transmitted ensuring that the
appropriate resource is deployed.
508.040.001
508.040.002
508.040.003
508.040.004
ADDITIONAL FUNCTIONS AND FEATURES
508.040.005
• Response buttons with configurable icons or text provide
control switches specific to any operation being
performed
• Uses a combination of symbols, floor plans, pictures, text
and video to communicate events
• Standard MX and Minerva® symbol libraries supplied
• Gives instructions on what emergency action should be
taken
• Prints maps and instructions to assist response teams
• History logging recallable or printable by event, dates,
device, or a host of other available filters
• The advanced filter allows the history report to be
specifically limited to a particular range or date period.
• Commands to control outputs from the Graphical User
Interface
• Events can be accepted individually or can be
“auto-accept”
• Supports all standard PC image file types (i.e. GIF, JPG,
BMP), AutoCAD® & Vector file types
Chapter 4 Page 2
508.040.011
508.040.021
508.040.025
508.040.027
508.040.033
508.020.023
508.020.019
Fire Catalogue
TXG USB Server Dongle/License/Software
English
TXG001-Single Client with 1 panel
(Requires TXG USB)
TXG004-Single Client with 2 to 4 panels
(Requires TXG USB and TXG001)
TXG010-Single Client with 5 to 10 panels
(Requires TXG USB, TXG001 and
TXG004)
TXG020-Single Client with 11 to 20 panels
(RequiresTXG USB, TXG001, TXG004 and
TXG010)
TXG999-Single Client with 21 or above
panels (Requires TXG USB, TXG001,
TXG004 TXG010 and TXG020)
TXG-C Additional Client license
TXG-MIN80 Minerva driver license
TXG-OPC - OPC Alarm / Event & Data
Access Server Licence
TXG-CPP - SIMPLEX CPP driver
TXG-PBS/FAST2000 DRIVER
Dell Optiplex 780 DT PC (no monitor) for
use with TXG
19” LCD Touchscreen
09/10
FIRE_Ch4_Networks_and_Graphics:Layout 1 01/09/2010 09:09 Page 3
Chapter 4 - Networks and Graphics
TXG IS TOTALLY SCALABLE
……FROM A SINGLE FIRE ALARM
PANEL
CONNECTED TO A TXG SERVER……
The modest additional cost of a single
TXG
client/server is easily justified when the
benefits that a
Graphical User Interface bring are
considered.
RS232
TXG with direct connection to a single Minerva® MX
……TO A COMPLEX
INSTALLATION WITH MULTIPLE
DIVERSE NETWORKS AND
DISTRIBUTED CLIENTS
Large multi-building facilities may have
a number of fire detection networks,
possibly installed over an extended
period of time. TXG can be used as a
hub to integrate these systems with a
number clients providing annunciation
and control where it is needed.
Zetfas
Simplex 4100 Range
Wormald PBS 16
Tyco Fast 2000
Minerva® network via TLK800 Interface
TXG Client
TLI800G
Interface
TXG Server
TXG Client
CCTV Surveillance System
Minerva® MX Network
TXG Client
TCP\IP
TXG with multiple fire detection networks and CCTV integration
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 4 Page 3
FIRE_Ch4_Networks_and_Graphics:Layout 1 01/09/2010 09:09 Page 4
Chapter 4 - Networks and Graphics
Features
• LPCB approved
• A peer to peer network that does not use a host or
master controller.
• 99 nodes, 99,000 points, 23,760 zone capacity.
• Bi-directional signaling.
• Open/short circuit isolation.
• Events originating at any node can be used as an input to
event/action processing of other panels to co-ordinate
and distribute systems control.
• System can be configured in the field using MX Consys
software.
• Failure of one node does not affect any other node or
communications between nodes. In the event of multiple
failures, nodes will automatically re-generate into
independent fully functional networks.
MXNet
MXNet provides a true peer to peer communications
interface for up to 99, MINERVA MX, or MINERVA T2000
fire controllers in any combination and the TXG, graphical
user interface. The units can be inter-connected into a large
network without the need for a host or master controller.
MXNet is based upon a combination of hardware and
software that allows MX fire controllers (Nodes) to be linked
together.
The MXNet supports up to 99,000 analogue/addressable
points and over 49,000 digital I/0 points. The network
co-ordinates and distributes alarm annunciation and
supervises system operation. When connected to the
network, each MX Fire controller maintains its full
stand-alone features, functions and capabilities.
Additional Features
• Automatic network re-configuration when a previously
failed node is restored to the network.
• Up to 3,000 metres between nodes with twisted/shielded
cable.
• System will operate on standard 2 core MICC.
• MX controllers may be grouped into sub-nets where each
panel is programmed to inter-act only with other selected
controllers.
• Plug-in module (TLI-800) easily connects an MX fire
controller to the network.
• Data is re-generated at each MX controller and is sent out
over the MXNet as new clean data. All degradation in
received data due to noise on a line, line attenuation, or
phase shifting is eliminated when the data is
re-generated.
• The MXNet uses a token-passing, non collision
communication protocol for data transmission.
• "Network zones" and "sectors" allow the network
controllers to be configured as a single "seamless"
system.
• TXG, a P.C. based graphical user interface, connects
directly on to the network.
• MXNet supports combinations of MICC, twisted/shielded
pair cabling, fibre optic cabling, and dedicated telephone
line.
• Multiple communication topologies bus or ring.
Chapter 4 Page 4
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch4_Networks_and_Graphics:Layout 1 01/09/2010 09:09 Page 5
Chapter 4 - Networks and Graphics
TLI-800
The key hardware component that makes the network possible is the LPCB approved network card
TLI-800. The TLI-800 provides the
electrical/mechanical means to connect the
components of the network to local and remote
network signalling circuits. Installation of the
TLI-800 is simplified with an edge connector that
plugs onto the main processor board of the MX
controller. The TLI-800 provides RS-485 comm
unications over a twisted shielded pair as a
standard configuration.
Product Codes
TLI-800 MXNet network node
557.202.026
interface module
557.200.038
TLI-800G ThornNet interface
for MXGraph PC c/w 240V
PSU and housing
557.180.219
MXGraph PC to TLK-530-G
& TLI-800G connection cable
The distance between controllers can reach 3,000
metres at a speed of 38.4 Kbs using 18AWG
twisted shielded cable. It fits within the MX panel
housing.
TLD-530
The Telephone Line Driver Module (TLD-530) is
used to interface two (2) dedicated telephone line
circuits to the TLI-800 module. The TLD-530 line
driver module converts the RS-485 signals
received from the TLI-800 network interface
module to signals capable of being transmitted
over the telephone line circuits. One TLI-800
supports two channels so only one module is
required per controller for both single path and
redundant path star connections. The interface
allows for field configured baud rates and
supports distances of up 3,000 metres. Up to two
units can be fitted into a TLO/TLD Housing.
Technical Specification
Dimensions
170H x 120W x
20D mm
Weight
140g
Product Codes
TLD 530 ThornNet/MXNet
557.180.699
direct line driver PCB
557.180.148.A TLO/TLD Housing - ADT
branded
CCU3
The CCU3/C-MXMB provides a MODBUS interface
to a number of MX panels on an MXNet. CCU/IO
boards may also be connected to provide general
I/O devices accessed through the MODBUS
interface.
The CCU3/C-MXMB connects to MX panels on the
MXNet via a TLI-800 (TPI) interface card using
RS232 (PL2 socket). It connects to MODBUS via
either an RS232, RS485 (default) or RS422
connection. Another port allows up to 8 CCU/IO
boards to be connected. Each CCU/IO has 8
relay outputs that can be used as inputs to the
MX. These contacts are controlled via WRITE
commands to the MODBUS map. Each CCU/IO
also has 8 supervised inputs whose status can be
read from the MODBUS map.
The CCU3/C-MX Bridge enables the direct
connection of an MX Technology® fire controller
and Minerva® 16E or 80 fire controllers via the
H-Bus Communications Driver Module (CDM). No
network cards are required in this configuration.
The CDM attaches on to the Minerva® H-Bus and
provides a serial port for the CCU3/C-MX bridge.
09/10
Technical Specification
Input Voltage
18-30Vdc
Current
150mA at
24Vdc
Dimensions
140 x 105 x
15mm
Product Code
MX CCU3/C-MXMB
557.202.046
MX to MOD Bus Interface
Product Codes
MX Bridge CCU3/C-MX Bridge
557.202.123
557.180.025
Minerva Comms Driver Module
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 4 Page 5
FIRE_Ch4_Networks_and_Graphics:Layout 1 01/09/2010 09:09 Page 6
Chapter 4 - Networks and Graphics
Features
• Facilitates Integration of MX & Minerva Systems
• Easy Upgrade Path for MINERVA systems
MX Minerva - Bridge
The MX Minerva bridge enables a mix of Minerva and MX
Panels anywhere on a shared network to operate as an
integrated system.
The bridge comprises of 2 network cards and a translating
host (CCU).
Housed in either a MXAPSU17 or MXAPSU38 housing, the
MX-Minerva bridge is a translating host converting packets
between the Minerva format and the MX format in both
directions. Flexibility is provided for packet conversion in
the bridge configuration programme.
The MX Minerva bridge can be added to one mixed
network using both Minerva and MX Nodes or it can be
connected to span between two physically separated
network rings, one with Minerva nodes and one with MX
nodes.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Size:
557.202.120
557.202.121
Input voltage:
Operating Temp:
EMC/RFI:
Chapter 4 Page 6
320x440x120mm (17A/H)
320x440x215mm (38A/H)
120-250VAC - 50/60Hz
8° to +55°C
EN50130-4
Fire Catalogue
MX-Minerva Bridge Kit (17AH)
MX Minerva Bridge Kit (38AH)
09/10
FIRE_Ch5_Detector_Test_Equipment:Layout 1 27/04/2010 11:33 Page 1
Chapter 5 - Detector Test Equipment
Detector Test Equipment for Point Detector Testing/
Commissioning
The solo range of test equipment provides a range of easy to use products for commissioning and servicing all
types of point detectors.
Telescope Poles
Product Codes
517.001.230
SOLO100 Telescopic pole 1.26M to
4.5M long
517.001.226
SOLO101 Extension tube 1.13M
long for use with Telescopic
extension pole (517.001.230)
517.001.264
SOLO 610 Protective Carry/Storage
Bag for Solo Detector Test Kit
SOLO724 charger. (Connects
directly to SOLO100/101 poles).
517.001.239
SOLO760 Spare battery baton for
use with SOLO 450/460 tester
517.001.243
SOLO725 Spare mains/car battery
charger for SOLO760 battery baton
The tool also enables detector dust
covers to be easily removed.
The 800RT is also compatible with
Series 600 Low Profile detectors.
Product Code
516.800.917
800RT Removal Tool
SOLO330 Test Gas Dispenser
Product Code
517.001.255
SOLO330 Aerosol dispenser for use
with all detector ranges. (Connects
directly to SOLO100/101 poles).
SOLO461 Heat Detector Tester
Product Codes
517.001.254
SOLO461 Cordless heat detector
tester kit including SOLO460 tester,
SOLO720 battery batons and
Smoke Detector Test Gas
Product Code
517.001.256
Suretest Solo aerosol tester can.
For use with SOLO 330 dispenser.
Non-flammable, ozone and
environmentally friendly. Approx 200
tests per can.
CO Detector Test Gas
Product Code
517.001.262
CO Detector Tester Solo C3 -006 for
use with Solo 330 dispenser.
800RT Detector Removal Tool
The 800RT detector removal tool fits
the SOLO range of telescopic poles
and allows 800 Series detectors to
be remotely fitted, removed and
turned to the “park” position.
M900 Address Key Extractor Tool
The M900 Address Key Extractor
Tool can be used to remove the
address key from either a 4” or 5”
detector base from ground level.
Product Code
517.001.235
M900 Address Key Extractor Tool
SOLO704
Product Code
517.001.224
SOLO704 Adaptor tube B - Adapts
SOLO100/101 pole sets for TYCO
detector changers and testers
SOLO200
Product Code
517.001.240
SOLO200 Universal detector
changer for use with various
04/10
manufacturers detectors - not
suitable for 600/800/900 series low
profile detectors. Connects directly
to the SOLO100/101 poles.
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 5 Page 1
FIRE_Ch5_Detector_Test_Equipment:Layout 1 27/04/2010 11:33 Page 2
Chapter 5 - Detector Test Equipment
SOLO TEST EQUIPMENT FOR POINT & FLAME DETECTORS
517.001.262
517.001.256
516.800.917
800 RT
DETECTOR CHANGER
Chapter 5 Page 2
Fire Catalogue
04/10
FIRE_Ch5_Detector_Test_Equipment:Layout 1 27/04/2010 11:33 Page 3
Chapter 5 - Detector Test Equipment
Features
• Approved for use in zone 1 & 2 areas (GPIIC gases)
• Adaptor plate to ensure perfect alignment
• IECEX Approved
S200+ Series Test Equipment
Technical Specification
Material:
Weight:
Supply Voltage:
Operating Temp.
Humidity:
Enclosure:
Classification:
Product Codes
Glass filled polyester
0.8kg
9Vdc
-10°C to + 50°C
95% (Non Condensing)
IP54
Atex EEx e ib IICT4. Suitable for use in
zones 1 & 2 where group IIC gases or
lesser hazards are sometimes present in
explosive concentrations.
592.001.016
592.001.014
592.001.010
T210+ Test source for use with Solo 704
Adaptor Tube B (517.001.224) and Solo
100/101 Poles (517.001.230/226)
T210+Adaptor required for the T210+ to
be used with S200 and S200 Plus Flame
Detectors
T110 PP9 Battery and Charger Kit
Manual - Vol01B-01-G5 “Detectors Fire Manual”
S100 Series Test Equipment
Product Codes
592.001.012
T110 Test Source for use with Solo
704 adaptor tube B (517.001.224)
and Solo 100/101 poles
(517.001.230/226)
592.001.010
T110 PP9 Battery and Charger kit
592.001.018
T110 Adaptor for series 600 and 800
flame detectors
04/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 5 Page 3
FIRE_Ch5_Detector_Test_Equipment:Layout 1 27/04/2010 11:33 Page 4
Chapter 5 - Detector Test Equipment
This page is left intentionally blank.
Chapter 5 Page 4
Fire Catalogue
04/10
FIRE_Ch6_System_Accesories:Layout 1 27/07/2010 10:49 Page 1
Chapter 6 - System Accessories
Batteries, PSU and Chargers
Product Codes
PS-1221
PS-1230
PS-1270
PS-1212
PS-12650
PS-12380
PS-6100
PS-12170
PS-12260
PS-1242
PS-12120
Voltage (V)
12
12
12
12
12
12
6
12
12
12
12
Ah at
20h rate
2.1
3.0
7.0
1.2
65.0
38.0
10.0
17.0
26.0
4.5
12.0
Length
178
134
151
97
348
197
151
181
166
90
151
Dimensions (mm)
Width
35
67
65
42
167
165
51
76
176
70
98
Height
60
60
94
51
178
170
94
167
112
101
94
Height including
Terminals
66
66
98
54
178
170
98
167
125
105
100
Product Codes
PS-1221
PS-1230
PS-1270
PS-1212
PS-12650
PS-12380
PS-6100
PS-12170
PS-12260
PS-1242
PS-12120
07/10
Fire Catalogue
12 Volt 2.1 Ampere hour rechargeable
sealed lead acid battery
12 Volt 3.0 Ampere hour rechargeable
sealed lead acid battery
12 Volt 7.0 Ampere hour rechargeable
sealed lead acid battery
12 Volt 1.2 Ampere hour rechargeable
sealed lead acid battery
12 Volt 65.0 Ampere hour rechargeable
sealed lead acid battery
12 Volt 38.0 Ampere hour rechargeable
sealed lead acid battery
6 Volt 10.0 Ampere hour rechargeable
sealed lead acid battery
12 Volt 17.0 Ampere hour rechargeable
sealed lead acid battery
12 Volt 26.0 Ampere hour rechargeable
sealed lead acid battery
12 Volt 4.5 Ampere hour rechargeable
sealed lead acid battery
12 Volt 12.0 Ampere hour rechargeable
sealed lead acid battery
Chapter 6 Page 1
FIRE_Ch6_System_Accesories:Layout 1 27/07/2010 10:49 Page 2
Chapter 6 - System Accessories
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Robust metal housing
Twin fused outputs
Temperature compensated charging
Deep discharge protection of batteries
Fault relay output
Size 383mm wide x 408mm high x 97mm deep
Weight 4.3 Kg (excluding batteries)
Operating temperature -5°C to +40°C
Supply voltage 230VAC 50/60Hz
Comprehensive LED status indication
Minerva MXP24/50 PSU
The MXP24/50 PSU is approved by IMQ to EN 54-4:1997 +
A1:2002 and EN60950-1:2001. The steel housing contains a
5 amp switch mode power supply and monitoring board
and has space to accommodate 2 x 12V 17Ah sealed lead
acid batteries. The 10 front panel LED's comprehensively
indicate the status of the unit.
Product Code
558.004.020
Chapter 6 Page 2
Fire Catalogue
Minerva MXP24/50-U/TSP 5A Charger &
Housing
07/10
FIRE_Ch6_System_Accesories:Layout 1 27/07/2010 10:49 Page 3
Chapter 6 - System Accessories
Door Release Equipment
Door Release Magnets
The door magnet range encompasses 2 metal and
2 ABS housed wall mounted and 1 floor mounted
release magnet sets
Features
•
•
•
•
Integral release button
Attractive design
Slimline ABS housed units
Robust floor mounted unit
Door release magnet set, Wall
Mount, Metal Housing, 24VDC
Product Code
3-59-0404-S001
Door release magnet set, Wall
Mount, Metal Housing, 230VAC
Product Code
3-59-0404-S002
Door release magnet set, Wall
Mount, ABS Housing, 24VDC
Product Code
3-87-0351
Door release magnet set, Wall
Mount, ABS Housing, 230VAC
Product Code
3-87-0352
Door release magnet set, floor
mount, ABS housing 24VDC
Product Code
3-84-0301
Floor mounting bracket for
adapting wall mounted door
magnets to floor mount
Product Code
2-34-035G-S001
Technical Specifications
3-59-0404-S001 - 89 x 89 x 70mm, 0.5Kg, 180N Holding Force, 1.15W Coil @ 24VDC
3-59-0404-S002 - 89 x 89 x 70mm, 0.5Kg, 180N Holding Force, 1.15W Coil @ 230VAC
3-87-0351 - 95 x 87 x 46mm, 0.36Kg, 200N Holding Force, 1.15W Coil @ 24VDC
3-87-0352 - 95 x 87 x 46mm, 0.36Kg, 200N Holding Force, 1.15W Coil @ 230VAC
3-84-0301 - 110 x 96 x 96mm, 0.7Kg, 200N Holding Force, 45mA Coil @ 24VDC
Door Release Power Supply
The Transformer Rectifier is a dual
purpose, smoothed power supply
providing either an energised or
de-energised output upon
activation. The output may be
activated by utilising a set of volt
free contacts from a fire or security
panel, or by providing a 12/24Vdc
trigger voltage from other
apparatus.
The transformer rectifier units are
normally used to control the
operation of other 24Vdc
equipment such as magnetic door
retainers. The units are ideal for
applications where the supply is to
be energised from a remote source.
Product Code
558.004.010
ELM 24V 4A Door Holder PSU
Technical Specification
Input:
240Vac
Output:
24Vdc
4A
Dimensions:
200H x 230W x
80Dmm
Door Release Button
Door Release Button supplied with
surface mount backbox for manual
release of door magnets or door
release units.
07/10
Product Code
519.001.008
Door Release Button
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 6 Page 3
FIRE_Ch6_System_Accesories:Layout 1 27/07/2010 10:49 Page 4
Chapter 6 - System Accessories
Auxiliary Interface Relays
Boxed Relays
Product Codes
567.005.004
Relay 5010. Supplied with 1 PCB but
can fit a maximum of 2 PCB’s each
containing up to 5 plug in relays.
Order relay (569.001.007)
separately.
568.001.002
Relay 5010 PCB (5 Relay)
Metal boxed heavy duty alarm relay
with 25A mains rated DPCO contacts.
Available with either a 240VAC 12mA
or 24VDC 50mA rated coil.
Suitable for heavy duty switching
applications.
Product Codes
567.007.008
Alarm Relay 240Vac MK4
567.007.009
Alarm Relay 24Vdc MK4
RU1-24, this is a metal boxed
auxiliary relay with 5 A Mains rated
double pole contacts with a
24 VDC 25mA coil. This compact
relay is suitable for interfacing a fire
alarm controller to low current mains
powered devices or contactors
RU1-24
Relay Boxed 24Vdc Coil 5A contacts
Relays
Product Code
609.001.015
Polarised & suppressed 24VDC
double pole C/O relay with gold clad
contacts, 2K ohm coil, 2 Amps @
30VDC (PCB Mounted)
Product Code
569.001.007
Cradle relay and retaining clip 2 C/O
26V nominal 700 ohm coil 5 amp
(used with Relay 5000 and 5010).
Fire Notice Frames
These frames are used mainly for
Fire Alarm Zone Charts and are
available to fit A4 to A1 size
drawings. These come supplied with
fitting hooks.
Chapter 6 Page 4
Product Codes
525.001.005
A4 Dimensions: 212mm x 297mm
525.001.006
A3 Dimensions: 280mm x 356mm
525.001.008
A2 Dimensions: 483mm x 367mm
525.001.007
A1 Dimensions: 483mm x 737mm
Fire Catalogue
07/10
FIRE_Ch6_System_Accesories:Layout 1 27/07/2010 10:49 Page 5
Chapter 6 - System Accessories
Fire Resistant Cable
Fire Resistant Cable
DÄTWYLER Lifeline cable is suitable for fire alarms and
emergency lighting where BS6387 and BS7629 standards
are acceptable and meets the installation and performance
requirements of:
• BS5839 Pt.1 for use in fire alarms
• BS5266 for use with emergency lighting
• IEC331 fire resistance
Lifeline is LPCB approved to BS6387 CAT CWZ and
BASEC approved to BS7629.
Lifeline is low smoke, zero halogen, has an integral
aluminium backed mylar tape screen with tinned drain wire
and requires no special terminations, tools or ferrules for
installation.
Full details of Lifeline cable can be found in the DÄTWYLER
Lifeline datasheets on the Tyco Safety Products website
(www.tycoemea.com).
DÄTWYLER offer a wide range of cable and safety cabling
systems including complete safety cable systems to
DIN4102 part 12.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Construction
Conductor:
Product Codes
Bare copper, solid or
stranded to BS 6360
Insulation:
Special double layer
insulation according to
BS 7655, E15
Inner Covering: High temperature resistant
glass fibre tape
Screening:
Al-Laminated tape with
tinned copper drain wire,
solid to BS 6360
Outer Sheath:
Flame retardant polyolefin
compound according to
BS 7655, LTS3
Technical Properties
Rated Voltage: 300/500V
Test Voltage:
2000V, 50Hz core/core
2000V, 50Hz core/screen
Operating Temp: -15oC to +90oC
Core Colours:
2 cores + earth: red, black
4 cores + earth: red,yellow,blue,black
Sheath Colour: Red or white
General Properties
Zero Halogen, no corrosive gases IEC 60754-2, BS 6425 part 1
Reduced fire propagation - IEC 603323, BS 4066 part 3
Minimum smoke emission - IEC 61034,
BS 7622
Insulation integrity - IEC 60331
(FE180), BS 6387 (cat. CWZ)
Approvals
BASEC
No. of Cores x Cross Section (n x mm2) Copper Content (Kg/Km)
2 x 1.0
19
2 x 1.5
29
2 x 2.5
48
4 x 1.0
39
4 x 2.5
96
07/10
The following DÄTWYLER Lifeline cables are held in stock
at Tyco Safety Products Letchworth warehouse, together
with suitable P clips and glands. Cables are priced per
metre but must be ordered in units of 100 metre. P clips
and glands are priced each but must be ordered in packs.
No. Cores
2 + earth
2 + earth
2 + earth
2 + earth
4 + earth
4 + earth
4 + earth
4 + earth
599.048.020
599.048.022
599.048.023
599.048.024
599.048.032
599.048.034
599.048.035
599.048.036
DÄTWYLER Lifeline cable
Core Size
Colour
1 mm
Red
1.5 mm
Red
1.5 mm
White
2.5 mm
Red
1 mm
Red
1.5 mm
Red
1.5 mm
White
2.5 mm
Red
Clips
P34 R
P34 R
P34 W
P37 R
P37 R
P40 R
P40 W
P43 R
Product Codes
599.048.001
599.048.002
599.048.003
599.048.005
599.048.009
599.048.010
DÄTWYLER Lifeline Fire Resistant P
Clips & Glands
Qty. per pack Reference
Colour
50
P34
Red
50
P34
White
50
P37
Red
50
P40
Red
10
NG1
Red
10
NG1
White
Total Weight (Kg/Km) Outer Diameter (approx. mm) Calorific Potential (KWh/m)
75
7.4
0.16
97
8.2
0.18
141
9.6
0.24
114
8.6
0.23
223
11.3
0.37
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 6 Page 5
FIRE_Ch6_System_Accesories:Layout 1 27/07/2010 10:49 Page 6
Chapter 6 - System Accessories
This page is left intentionally blank.
Chapter 6 Page 6
Fire Catalogue
07/10
FIRE_Ch7_VESDA:Layout 1 02/09/2010 09:44 Page 1
Chapter 7 - VESDA
Aspirating Smoke Detection
Vesda aspirating smoke detection provides a high sensitivity method for detection of fires at a very early stage - it is ideal
for computer rooms and other high risk and high value areas. The range of products range from the Laserfocus for
small risks up to the LaserPlus range of networkable 4 pipe panels.
Features
• Laser Based Absolute Smoke Detection
• Very Early Warning of a Potential Fire Incident
• Wide Sensitivity Range (0.025%-20% obs/m)
(0.008 - 6.4% obs/ft)
• Detection Capabilities for smaller critical areas up to 500m
• Dual Stage Dust Filtration
• Programmable Alarm Thresholds
• Reliable Air Flow Monitoring
• Easy User Interaction
• AutoLearn Smoke & Flow
• Pre-engineered Pipe Designs
LaserFOCUS Aspirating Smoke Detection
Incorporating detection methodology derived from its
VESDA predecessors - the VESDA LaserFOCUS multiple
point air sampling technology works by utilising a highly
effective aspirator that continually draws air into its laser
detection chamber via a pipe network.
Accurate assessment of the air sample using calibrated
detection and long detector life expectancy, are assured
with a patented dual stage filtration process that both
eliminates background ‘noise’ and preserves the optical
integrity of the laser technology with its clean air bleed. The
result of which is an unchallenged detection process able to
provide reliable and consistent very early warning smoke
detection performance across a diverse range of
applications.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Supply Voltage:
Current Consumption:
516.018.020
Dimensions:
Weight:
IP Rating:
Operating Temp:
Sampled Air:
Humidity:
09/10
18 to 30 Vdc
220mA quiescent
295 mA alarm
255H x 185W x 90Dmm
2 kg
IP30
0°C to + 40°C
0°C to + 40°C
5% to 95% (non condensing)
516.018.022
516.018.023
Fire Catalogue
VLF-250 Vesda Laserfocus
(with English overlay)
VIC-010 LaserFocus VesdaNetwork Card
VLF-500 Vesda Laserfocus
(with English overlay)
Chapter 7 Page 1
FIRE_Ch7_VESDA:Layout 1 02/09/2010 09:44 Page 2
Chapter 7 - VESDA
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Reduced size
Absolute smoke detection
Wide sensitivity range
Single pipe inlet
Simple display
Referencing
VESDAnet communication (VN)
Dual stage dust filter
Three alarm levels
Configurable relays
Air flow monitoring
Optional remote display and relay capability
Simple mounting design
AutoLearnTM
Marine Approved Version
LaserCOMPACTTM and MX LaserCOMPACTTM
The LaserCOMPACT and VLC800 MX Laser compact
detector has been specifically designed to provide all the
benefits of aspirating smoke detection, including very early
warning, in single small areas and where space is a
premium.
This has been achieved through the combination of
approved LaserPLUS detection technology, dual stage
filtration technology and a modified aspirator design
incorporated in a smaller enclosure with simplified display.
The LaserCOMPACT is available in two versions, one that
interfaces via relays only (RO) or across either the relays or
VESDAnetTM (VN).
The VLC 800MX Laser Compact is available with an in-built
MX interface to enable it to communicate directly with the
MX loop.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Supply Voltage:
Current Consumption:
516.018.011
516.018.010
516.018.012
Dimensions:
Weight:
Operating Temp:
Sampled Air:
18 to 30Vdc
225mA quiescent,
245mA in alarm
225H x 225W x 85Dmm
1.9Kg
-10°C to+ 39°C
-20°C to +60°C
516.018.030
516.018.031
516.018.032
Chapter 7 Page 2
Fire Catalogue
VLC-505-VN VESDA net Version (VN)
VLC-500-RO Relays Only Version (RO)
VLC800 MX Addressable Vesda Laser
compact (Compatible with MX Consys
versions 2.1 and above)
VLC-500-RO Relays Only Version (RO)
Marine
VLC-500-VN Vesdanet Version (VN)
Marine
VRT-J00 Remote Display c/w 7 relays
Marine
09/10
FIRE_Ch7_VESDA:Layout 1 02/09/2010 09:44 Page 3
Chapter 7 - VESDA
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wide sensitivity range
Laser-based light source
4 Configurable alarm levels
Purpose built Aspirator
4 In-line Inlet pipes
Flow sensor for each inlet pipe
Wide range DC power
Low-cost maintenance
Dual stage filter
Easy access to filter cartridge
7 Software configurable relays
Recessed mounting
Multiple exhausts
LaserPLUS Standard Modular Range
The detector assembly contains the laser detection
chamber, high efficiency aspirator, monitored filter
cartridge, control electronics and relay interface. The
detector assembly can be used as a “distributed” system,
with the display, programmer and VESDAnet socket
modules mounted in a remote location.
516.018.001
VLP-012 LaserPLUS Detector, programmer and
display
Alternatively, the detector assembly can be configured as a
“self-contained” system by replacing the detector’s blank
panels with the display and/or programming modules.
516.018.002
VLP-002 LaserPLUS Detector and display
516.018.013
VLP-400 LaserPLUS Detector with fire OK LED
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Supply Voltage:
Current Consumption:
516.018.001
Dimensions:
Weight:
Operating Temp:
Humidity:
09/10
18 to 30Vdc
(No display or programmer)
240mA quiescent plus 50mA
alarm (24Vdc at 3000 rpm)
225H x 350W x 125D mm
4.0Kg (including display and
programmer modules)
0°C to + 39°C
0-95% RH, non condensing
516.018.002
516.018.013
Fire Catalogue
VLP-012 LaserPLUS Detector,
programmer and display
VLP-002 LaserPLUS Detector and display
VLP-400 LaserPLUS Detector with fire OK
LED
Chapter 7 Page 3
FIRE_Ch7_VESDA:Layout 1 02/09/2010 09:44 Page 4
Chapter 7 - VESDA
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Individual pipe annunciation
Adaptive scan threshold
Wide sensitivity range (0.005 to 20% obs/m)
Laser based light source
Configurable alarm levels
Purpose built Aspirator
4 In-Line inlet pipes
Flow sensor for each pipe inlet
Low-cost maintenance
Dual stage filter
Easy access to filter cartridge
Recessed mounting
LaserPLUS Scanners
VESDA LaserPLUS is also available in a Scanner
configuration, which allows the system to distinguish and
identify the pipe carrying smoke, while sampling multiple
sectors.
The VESDA LaserPLUS will continue to sample from all
sectors to monitor the fire growth and maintain full
protection.
VLS-214/314 FD7/FD12 Scanner
Product Codes
516.018.004
VLS-214 FD7 Scanner, programmer
and display with 7 relays.
516.018.007
VLS-314 FD12 Scanner, programmer
and display with 12 relays
VLS-600/700 FD7/FD12 Scanner
Product Codes
516.018.016
VLS-600 FD7 Scanner with Fire OK LED
516.018.019
VLS-700 FD12 Scanner with Fire OK LED
VLS-204/304 FD7/FD12 Scanner
Product Codes
516.018.005
VLS-204 FD7 Scanner and display
with 7 relays.
516.018.008
VLS-304 FD12 Scanner and display
with 12 relays
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Supply Voltage:
Current consumption:
516.018.004
Dimensions:
Weight:
Operating Temp:
Humidity:
Relay Outputs:
18 to 30Vdc
(No display or programmer)
240mA quiescent plus 70mA
alarm (24Vdc at 3000 rpm)
225H x 350W x 125D mm
4.0Kg including display and
programmer modules
0°C to + 39°C
10-95% RH, non condensing
7 or 12
516.018.007
516.018.005
516.018.008
516.018.016
516.018.019
VLS-214 FD7 Scanner, programmer and
display with 7 relays.
VLS-314 FD12 Scanner, programmer and
display with 12 relays
VLS-204 FD7 Scanner and display with 7
relays.
VLS-304 FD12 Scanner and display with
12 relays
VLS-600 FD7 Scanner with Fire OK LED
VLS-700 FD12 Scanner with Fire OK LED
Datasheet - Product Code PSF105U “VESDA LaserPLUS”
Chapter 7 Page 4
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch7_VESDA:Layout 1 02/09/2010 09:44 Page 5
Chapter 7 - VESDA
Features
• Four alarm levels (Alert/Action, Fire 1 & Fire 2)
• 20 segment vertical bar graph
• Alarm threshold indicators
(Alert, Action & Fire 1)
• Audio and visual indication
• Alarm indicators
• Informative fault indicators
• Multi-mode numeric display(defaults to smoke
obscuration)
• Acknowledged push-button presses
• Multiple language supported
• Addressable to any detector
Remote Displays and Modules
A display module monitors the VESDA LaserPLUS
detector. It reports a visual representation of smoke levels,
and all alarm and fault conditions. The internal sounder
warns personnel in the local area that an alarm threshold
has been reached, or a fault has occurred.
It has a 20 segment vertical bar graph, a 2-digit numerical
display, an audible sounder and clear alarm and fault
indicators. It also has 4 push buttons to control the
detector and the mode of the display.
Displays can be located at a convenient location - either
within the detector module, or remotely on the VESDAnet.
For monitoring convenience, multiple displays can be
associated with a single detector.
VRT-400,700 & 800
Product Codes
516.018.104
VRT-400 Remote scanner display
including 7 relays
516.018.107
VRT-700 Remote scanner display no relays
516.018.108
VRT-800 Remote scanner display
with 12 relays
VRT-200,600,J00 and K00 displays
Product Codes
516.018.102
VRT-200 Remote display
including 7 relays
516.018.106
VRT-600 Remote detector displayno relays
516.018.119
VRT-J00 Compact Display c/w 7
relays
516.018.120
VRT-K00 Compact Display no relays
VRT-300
Product Code
516.018.103
VRT-300 Remote VESDAnet socket
VRT-100
Product Code
516.018.101
VRT-100 Remote programmer
Technical Specification
Supply Voltage:
Current Consumption:
09/10
18-30Vdc (when used in
detector unit, Remote unit or
19” rack)
60mA quiescent plus 20mA
alarm @24Vdc - (module
only)/90mA quiescent plus
20mA alarm @24Vdc
Dimensions:
Operating Temp:
Humidity:
Fire Catalogue
150H x 140W x 90D mm
0°C to +39°C
10-95% RH, non condensing
Chapter 7 Page 5
FIRE_Ch7_VESDA:Layout 1 02/09/2010 09:44 Page 6
Chapter 7 - VESDA
LaserPLUS Standard 19 Inch Sub-Rack Remote Display Assemblies
The 19” sub-rack is available as a
mounting option, with 4 mounting
slots for display or programming
modules.
Technical Specification
Dimensions: 128H x 482W x
120D mm
Product Codes
516.018.201
VSR-2000 19” Sub-rack with 1
detector display and 3 blanks
516.018.203
VSR-2210 19” Sub-rack, 2 detector
displays, programmer and 1 blank
516.018.204
VSR-2221 19” Sub-rack with 3
detector displays and programmer
516.018.206
VSR-2222 19” Sub-rack with 4
detector displays
LaserPLUS Components for Ordering Custom Built Remote Display Sub-racks
Sub-rack configurations other than
those available as standard can be
supplied as custom built units. The
sub-rack and cost of assembly are
included in the VSR-CUSTOM.
The configuration of the custom built
unit must be specified at time of
ordering (e.g. 2 x VSU-0 and 2 x
VSU-2 configured as VSR-0022)
Note: The order of the numbers (e.g.
0022) indicates the order in which
the sub-units will be mounted in the
sub-rack housing when looking from
the front of the unit - from left to
right.
Product Codes
516.018.260
VSU-0 Blank Sub-unit
516.018.261
VSU-1 Programmer sub-unit
516.018.262
VSU-2 Detector display sub-unit
plus 7 relays
516.018.264
VSU-4 Scanner display sub-unit plus
7 relays
516.018.265
VSU-5 Blank sub-unit with 7 relays
516.018.214
VSU-E Blank scanner sub-unit with 7
relays
516.018.268
VSU-8 Scanner display sub-unit with
12 relays
516.018.269
VSU-9 Blank display sub-unit with 12
relays
516.018.219
VSU-J Compact display sub-unit
plus 7 relays
516.018.210
VSR-CUSTOM Custom sub-rack
housing includes cost of custom
building 4 VSU sub-rack units.
LaserPLUS Standard 19 Inch Rack Remote Display Assemblies
Standard rack enclosures are
available to fit 2 (see picture) or 5
sub-rack assemblies.
Technical Specification
Dimensions:
020-050 300H x 400W x 140D mm
Product Code
516.018.303
020-050 IP65 Enclosure
LaserPLUS Ancillaries & Power Supply Unit
Product Codes
516.018.402
VHX-0200 PC link HLI plus leads
(MK2)
516.018.407
VESDA VPS-220 2A 24VDC PSU
516.018.410
VESDA VPS-250-E 5A 24VDC PSU
516.018.401
VHH-100 Hand held programmer
plus leads
A variety of other ancillaries are
available. Configuration software is
available from the Xtralis website
www.vision-fs.com.
LaserPLUS Spares
The following common VESDA
LaserPLUS spares are kept in stock
by Tyco Safety Products. Other
spares can be supplied if required.
Product Codes
516.018.501
VSP-002 Display (spare)
516.018.502
VSP-004 Scanner display (spare)
516.018.503
VSP-001 Programmer (spare)
Chapter 7 Page 6
516.018.505
VSP-019 Filter cover door (spare)
516.018.506
VSP-006 Spare detector chassis and
manifold
516.018.508
VSP-008 Spare remote termination
card 7 relays
516.018.509
VSP-009 Spare scanner chassis and
manifold
Fire Catalogue
516.018.514
VSP-014 Spare header termination
card 7 relays
516.018.515
VSP-015 Spare aspirator fan
516.018.504
VSP-005 Filter cartridge (spare)
09/10
FIRE_Ch7_VESDA:Layout 1 02/09/2010 09:44 Page 7
Chapter 7 - VESDA
Features
• Powerful fan
• Upto two x 100m pipe runs
• Pipes can be individually monitored for air flow with LED
bar graph
• MX Loop and 24 VDC connections
• Fault monitored via the MX Loop
• IP65 enclosure
• Field serviceable air filters
• Uses standard 25mm Vesda pipe & fittings
ICAM IAS800 Air Sampling Smoke Detection Systems
The ICAM IAS800 Air Sampling Smoke Detection System
provides a flexible solution to meet the unique needs of
numerous applications including industrial spaces such as
cable tunnels, tamper proof and unobtrusive requirements
for special accommodation, or can simply be used to
replace spot (point) detectors in office environments.
The system utilises a high performance aspirator and
software configurable flow monitoring circuitry. The air flow
level is displayed on a ten element bar graph that can be
adjusted for high and low flow thresholds, and flow failure is
reported as a device fault via upto two MX Technology
MIM800 addressable modules.
The IAS800 system actively draws air from the protected
area through sampling holes in a pipe network. Sampled air
is then filtered before being analyzed by upto two MX
Technology detectors.
Applications:
Ideal for areas where access is restricted, harsh
environments and areas where a point detector would be
damaged. Such as:Lift Shafts
Floor / Ceiling Voids
Cabinet Protection
Conveyor Tunnels
Hose Down Areas
Stables
Prison Cells
Areas with Low Ceilings
The IAS800 system is available in three configurations:IAS800 twin inlet pipe configuration which can be fitted with
two detectors for monitoring one or two pipe runs.
IAS801 single inlet pipe configuration which can be fitted
with one detector.
IAS802 twin inlet pipe configuration which can be fitted with
two detectors for monitoring one or two separate pipe runs
with independant fault outputs.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Supply Voltage
Current Consumption
Dimensions
Weight
Operating Temp
Humidity
Sampling Pipes
516.016.301
18 to 30Vdc
300mA
259w x 184h x 166d mm
2.77 Kg
-10 to +55°C (with detectors)
10 to 90% RH NonCondensing
25 mm dia, 100m per inlet
516.016.304
516.016.305
516.016.303
ICAM IAS800 Aspirated Smoke
Dual Detector common fault monitor
ICAM IAS801 Aspirated Smoke
Single Detector common fault monitor
ICAM IAS802 Aspirated Smoke
Dual Detector dual fault monitor
ICAM Course Filter (PK10)
Note: Detectors to be ordered separately.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 7 Page 7
FIRE_Ch7_VESDA:Layout 1 02/09/2010 09:44 Page 8
Chapter 7 - VESDA
Vesda Pipe, Fittings and Test Equipment
VESDA Aspirating Pipe & Fittings are a metric standard of 25mm external diameter with suitable adaptors available for
imperial to metric conversions. (British Standard approved pipes BS5391 Part 1 1976 and BS5391 Part 1 1976 for
fittings). The British manufactured pipe is produced in red ABS under stringent quality control approved to BS EN
ISO9001, which covers all aspects of product design, manufacture and inspection.
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Toughness and durability
Chemical resistance
Easy to joint
Low Friction
Wide temperature range
Lightweight
Red colour for easy identification
Aspirating Pipe & Fittings
Pipe 25mm diameter
VESDA aspirating pipe, printed along
its length on opposite side at 450mm
intervals. 3 m length pipe
Order in multiples of 10.
Product Code
516.018.901
Pipe 25mm diameter
Socket 25mm
Straight socket for 25mm pipe.
Order in multiples of 10.
Product Code
516.018.902
Socket 25mm
Socket union 25mm
Socket union to facilitate servicing of
pipework. Order in multiples of 1.
Product Code
516.018.903
Socket union 25mm
Socket Adaptor 25mm to 3/4”
Socket adaptor, imperial to metric, to
extend existing systems.
Order in multiples of 5
Product Code
516.018.909
Socket Adaptor 25mm to 3/4
90 degree Long Radius bend
Order in multiples of 5
Product Code
516.018.904
Long Radius bend 90°
Bend 25mm
Chapter 7 Page 8
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch7_VESDA:Layout 1 02/09/2010 09:44 Page 9
Chapter 7 - VESDA
Elbow 25mm
45 deg elbow
Order in multiples of 5
Product Code
516.018.905
Elbow 25mm
End cap 25mm
Order in multiples of 5
Product Code
516.018.906
End cap 25mm
End Cap 25mm
Equal Tee 25mm
Equal Tee 25mm
Order in multiples of 5
Product Code
516.018.907
Equal Tee 25mm
Pipe Clip 25mm
Order in multiples of 10
Product Code
516.018.908
Pipe Clip 25mm
Pipe Clip 25mm
Solvent Cement (0.25 Litre Tin)
Solvent cement
Product Code
516.018.910
Solvent cement
Capillary Tube Conical Sample Point Assembly
Capillary Tube Conical Sample Point
Assembly. 25mm socket adaptor +
2m capillary tube (tube colour - red)
Product Code
516.018.911
Capillary Tube Conical Sample Point
Assembly
Capillary Tube Flush Sample Point Assembly
Capillary Tube Flush Sample Point
Assembly. 25mm socket adaptor +
2m capillary tube (tube colour - red)
Product Code
516.018.912
Capillary Tube Flush Sample Point
Assembly
Capillary Tube 10 mm
Capillary Tube 10 mm
10mm o/d x 30m length
(tube colour - red)
Product Code
516.018.915
Capillary Tube 10 mm
Pipe Cutter
Product Code
516.018.918
Pipe Cutter
Pipe Ties (Red)
Order in multiples of 100.
Product Code
516.018.920
Pipe Ties (Red)
Pipe Cutters
Pipe Ties
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 7 Page 9
FIRE_Ch7_VESDA:Layout 1 02/09/2010 09:44 Page 10
Chapter 7 - VESDA
Sampling Point Label (1 reel)
Sampling point label. Order in
multiples of 100.
Product Code
517.017.005
Sampling point label.
Pipe Label (1reel)
Pipe Label. Order in multiples of 100.
Product Code
517.017.006
Pipe Label
Pipework designs for Vesda Systems must be verified by the use of the “Aspire” pipework Design Software Tool. Available
for download from the Xtralis Website at www.vision-fs.com.
Test Equipment
Wire Burn Test Box
Wire burn test box designed to heat
up a measured length of special wire
to produce smoke, used to test the
transport time and performance of
Vesda aspirating smoke detectors.
•
•
•
•
•
•
Built in timer
Insulated terminals
Selectable input voltage
Illuminated power on indicator
Robust enclosure
Supplied with UK power lead
Technical Specification
Input Voltage
110-120 or 220240VAC
Output Voltage 6.3VAC @ 20A
IP rating
IP30
Timer
1 to 3 mins
Dimensions
170w x 120d x
135h (mm)
Weight
2.75Kg
Product Code
516.018.921
Wire Burn Test Box
Smoke Test Wire
Smoke test wire for use with the wire
burn test box.
Chapter 7 Page 10
Technical Specification
Size - 10/0.1mm, 0.078 mm2 CSA
Length – 100m
Weight – 0.25Kg
Fire Catalogue
Product Code
516.018.923
Smoke Test Wire-Vesda 251-001
09/10
FIRE_Ch8_Fire_Phones_Disable_Refuge:Layout 1 18/02/2010 14:23 Page 1
Chapter 8 - Fire Phones & Disable Refuge
Fire Phones & Disable Refuge
Features
• Only three main functional building blocks simplify
the system design
• Compliant with BS5839 Pt 9:2003
• Compatible with enhanced fire rated cable
• System can control & monitor up to 265 lines
• Up to 8 master handsets per system
• Large clear display on master handsets
• Optional Lockable and Weatherproof Outstations
• Battery backup for continued operation in the event
of a mains failure
Emercall Fire Telephone and Disabled Refuge System
The Emercall Fire Telephone and Disabled Refuge Call
System meets the recommendations of BS5839 part 9:
2003 which specifies the operation of such systems. An
Emergency Voice Communication System (EVCS) is
defined as a fixed bidirectional full duplex secure
communication system for use in emergencies, and covers
the operation of both fire telephone systems and disabled
refuge systems.
A disabled refuge is defined as a location for people who
are mobility impaired who will impede the general egress
from the building, or need assistance in leaving the
building. This obviously includes wheelchair users who may
have used the lift, but also covers the elderly, pregnant
women over 6 months, people with arthritis, in fact anyone
who cannot walk 200 metres without a break.
An EmerCall EVCS System comprises of three system
building blocks: control handsets (both main and repeater
types), 8 way exchanges and Type A outstation handsets as
defined by the Standard.
The Exchange unit is a compact wall mount enclosure
which links the outstations to the control handsets and
contains the following:
• AC mains supply with a 1.5A monitored maintained
battery charger
• 8 telephone line interfaces
• Connection matrix
• Fault relay output (either Local Fault or General Fault)
• 2 Network interfaces with supply addition
• Line Fault Indication (8 LED's per line)
• Supply status (3 LED's: AC Present, DC Present, Supply
Fault)
• General fault LED
Outstation handsets are supplied as type A as defined by
the Standard and the choice of outstation handsets should
be made in line with the guidelines of the Standard.
The Control handsets are supplied in multifunction steel
and aluminium enclosures which can be wall, desk or rack
mounted and contain the following items:
• Monitored phone handset
• A 4 line 20-character LCD display for displaying calls,
faults and status
• 12 key keypad for dialling
• 3 menu keys for menu navigation
• 4 Indicator LED's (General Fault, Supply Fault, CPU Fault
and Supply Healthy)
• 2 network interfaces with supply extraction
03/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 8 Page 1
FIRE_Ch8_Fire_Phones_Disable_Refuge:Layout 1 18/02/2010 14:23 Page 2
Chapter 8 - Fire Phones & Disable Refuge
The Type A Outstation Handset comprises a steel enclosure
which is either flush mounted or surface mounted (separate
cases are provided for each type) and has the following
features:
The Type B Outstation Access Point comprises a steel
enclosure which is either flush or surface mounted. It
provides secure bi-directional full duplex voice
communication with the following main features:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Monitored phone handset
Telecoil in handset
High volume ringer
Optional lock
Optional strobe (requires additional supply and cables)
BS5839 pt 9:2003 compliant
Hands free operation
High volume ringer
Braille signage
Duplex speech
Red or green front
EMERCALL MASTER HANDSET
A BS5839 Pt 9:2003 compliant
monitored master telephone handset.
The stylish master console case is
available as a desk, rack or wall
mount option. The wall mount option
is also available with semi flush
bezels.
controls up to 256 lines (32 EmerCall
2572002 exchanges), 16 character
unique name per line, dual Network
ports, remote powered, wall, desk or
rack mount, eight status LED's, lockable door.
Product Codes
2572020
EmerCall Master Handset - wall
mount
2572021
Semi Flush Bezel for 2572020
2572001
EmerCall Master Handset - desk
mount
2572007
Rack Mount Kit for 2572001
dry contact for fault or "in use"
indication, dual network ports,
provides remote power for EmerCall
Master Handset 2572001, twelve
status LED's, compact design for riser
mounting.
Product Code
2572002
EmerCall 8 Line Exchange
A Large high contrast display (4 x 20
character), 12 key quick dial keypad,
full duplex system, up to eight
masters per system, directory dial
function, full system event log (fault
and configuration),
EMERCALL 8 LINE EXCHANGE
A BS5839 Pt 9:2003 compliant 8 line
telephone exchange unit. Controls up
to 8 independent lines, mains
powered, built in monitored 1A
charger for 12V SLA batteries, full
duplex audio, up to 32 exchanges per
system, full line monitoring, serial port
for configuration or updates,
EMERCALL TYPE A
The EmerCall Type A outstation
handsets as defined by BS5839 Pt 9
can be used as a fire telephone or
disabled refuge call point.
Product Codes
2572003
EmerCall Type A Flush Outstation
Handset with push door
2572004
EmerCall Type A Flush Outstation
Handset with locking door
2572013
EmerCall Type A Flush Outstation
Handset with push door - stainless
steel
2572005
EmerCall Type A Surface Outstation
Handset with locking door
2572006
EmerCall Type A Surface Outstation
Handset with push door
2572010
EmerCall Type A Surface Outstation IP66
2572015
EmerCall Type A Surface Outstation IP66 - stainless steel
Intended for use by firemen or
building marshals.
BS5839 Pt 9:2003 compliant,
compact design, high volume ringer,
Status LED, 20mm cable glands,
telecoil for hearing impaired users,
magnetic push catch or locking door,
fully monitored, flush or surface
mount, stainless steel option.
For outdoor applications an IP66
protected outstation is also available.
EMERCALL TYPE B
The EmerCall Type B hands free
outstation as defined by BS5839 Pt 9
can be used in a disabled refuge call
point. It can only be used as a fire
telephone when it is impractical to
use a Type A outstation.
Chapter 8 Page 2
BS5839 Pt 9:2003 compliant, hands
free operation, compact design, high
volume ringer, flashing status LED,
braille signage, duplex speech, 20mm
cable glands, fully monitored, stainless steel option.
Fire Catalogue
Product Codes
2572009
EmerCall Type B Outstation
2572016
Flush Bezel for 2572009 - stainless
steel
03/10
FIRE_Ch8_Fire_Phones_Disable_Refuge:Layout 1 18/02/2010 14:23 Page 3
Chapter 8 - Fire Phones & Disable Refuge
System Design
03/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 8 Page 3
FIRE_Ch8_Fire_Phones_Disable_Refuge:Layout 1 18/02/2010 14:23 Page 4
Chapter 8 - Fire Phones & Disable Refuge
This page is left intentionally blank.
Chapter 8 Page 4
Fire Catalogue
03/10
FIRE_Ch9_Water_Leak_Detection:Layout 1 07/05/2010 09:24 Page 1
Chapter 9 - Water Leak Detection
Water Leak Detection Alarms
The Water Leak detection system is a water detection
system designed to be used in situations where not just
flooding but also undue dampness could cause damage or
ultimately become dangerous.
The system comprises an electronic monitoring and alarm
control panel connected to sensors located in the area
requiring protection and can be custom made with a variety
of types of detection sensor to suit the characteristics of the
areas to be covered.
This system has been designed for ease of installation and
modern micro-electronics ensure a high degree of
reliability.
Typical Applications:
•
•
•
•
Computer Rooms, Telecommunications and Office Areas
Electrical Plant and Tank Areas
Valuables, Antiques and Artifacts
In general, wherever the presence of water could be a
potential problem to people, equipment, perishable
stock, data/information archives and record stores,
hospital theatres and so on.
There are also sensors for the detection of non-conductive
fluids such as diesel/oil.
Features
• Suitable for computer rooms
• Wide range of sensors
• Relay contacts to interface to BMS or fire alarmcontrollers
DETEK Water Flood Detection Controllers
Controller electronics are housed in a robust cabinet and
provide accurate sensing for water leakage and
comprehensive alarm facilities. The system is ideal for all
types of applications utilising a mixture of sensors on a single control panel to give optimum flexibility. All systems
have a test facility to enable simple regular confidence
checking of the equipment. Lockable cabinets constructed
in mild steel with stove enamelled finish for surface mounting. 20mm Knockouts are provided for ease of cable entry.
Indications of status on each zone, wiring fault and supply
healthy. Mains fail battery back-up indication where
applicable. The 85dBA pulsed audible alarm has a fully
functional local mute facility.
Approvals:
• Electro Magnetic Compatibility - All of the control panels
and sensors have been performance tested to meet the
requirements of EN55022 for emissions and EN50092
for immunity.
• British International Standards - The equipment is
manufactured in accordance with EN ISO 9001
procedures.
• Electrical Safety - Manufactured in accordance with
Electrical Equipment (Safety) Regulations 1994 - Low
Voltage Directive (SI 1994/3260).
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Dimensions:
508.200.004
508.200.005
508.200.006
Supply:
04/10
160H x 220W x 62D mm
(Single Zone)
270H x 362W x 84D mm
(Multi Zone)
Single phase 240VAC, 25VA
Max. Relay Contacts:
Two sets of volt free change
over contacts for alarm and
one set for wiring fault or
power loss. These may be
used to link into Building
Management Systems or for
remote alarms and beacons
up to 2A, 50Va.c./d.c.
Fire Catalogue
1 Zone - water/flood control panel
2 Zone - water/flood control panel
4 Zone - water/flood control panel
Chapter 9 Page 1
FIRE_Ch9_Water_Leak_Detection:Layout 1 07/05/2010 09:24 Page 2
Chapter 9 - Water Leak Detection
Sensor Cable
The Sensor cable comprises of high flexibility conductors
insulated by Helagaine mono-filament braiding. Cable or
tape sensors are suitable for general protection under false
floors, or can be fastened directly to pipework enabling
coverage in ceiling void areas.
The cables can be connected together, up to 100m, to
cater for larger areas. For each zone a ‘start of line’ and an
‘end of line’ module is required.
Sensor Pads
Sensor pads are constructed from glass fibre with an
anti-corrosive nickel plated surface. Pads will detect a few
cc’s of liquid and are either face up for location under
vulnerable points or face down for general coverage.
Probe Sensors
Probe sensors are the least sensitive and are often
employed as water level sensors. In general the sensor is
enclosed in a protective cover which also provides a
means for fixing and 20mm gland entry. The probe is
designed for vertical mounting at skirting level though may
be mounted in voids or sumps. A screw allows 16mm
height adjustment after the sensor is installed.
CD5 & CD10 Sensing Cable
Technical Specification
Sensor Cable Dimensions: 8mm dia
Product Codes
516.200.010
CD/5 metre length of sensing cable
516.200.011
CD/10 10 metre length of sensing
cable
SOL Start of Line for Sensing Cable
Product Code
516.200.012
SOL Start of Line for Sensing Cable
EOL End of Line for Sensing Cable
Product Code
516.200.013
EOL End of Line for Sensing Cable
SFD Sensor Pad - Face Down
Product Code
516.200.006
SFD Sensor Pad - Face Down
Technical Specification
Sensor Pads Dimensions:
115H x 160Wmm
SFU Sensor Pad - Face Up
Technical Specification
Sensor Pads Dimensions:
115H x 160Wmm
Product Code
516.200.016
SFU Sensor Pad - Face Up
SFD/C Cover for Sensor Pad
Technical Specification
Sensor Pads Dimensions:
115H x 160Wmm
Chapter 9 Page 2
Product Code
516.200.007
SFD/C Cover for Sensor Pad
Fire Catalogue
04/10
FIRE_Ch9_Water_Leak_Detection:Layout 1 07/05/2010 09:24 Page 3
Chapter 9 - Water Leak Detection
SPS/V Vertical Mount Probe Sensor c/w cover
Technical Specification
Probe Sensor Dimensions:
85H x 62W x 62Dmm
Product Code
516.200.004
SPS/V Vertical Mount Probe Sensor
c/w cover
FF1 Fixing Clips for Sensing Cable
Product Code
516.200.014
FF1 Fixing Clips for Sensing Cable
CDT Warning Labels for Sensing Cable
Product Code
516.200.015
CDT Warning Labels for Sensing
Cable
04/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 9 Page 3
FIRE_Ch9_Water_Leak_Detection:Layout 1 07/05/2010 09:24 Page 4
Chapter 9 - Water Leak Detection
This page is left intentionally blank.
Chapter 9 Page 4
Fire Catalogue
04/10
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 1
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Special Hazards
Introduction
Tyco Safety Products manufacturers and provides a wide
range of equipment suitable for use in hazardous areas
where normal equipment cannot be safely used. The range
extends from IS detectors for use on conventional systems
to flameproof and I.S. flame detectors for use in the most
demanding of environments.
A complete range of Barriers, Housings, Callpoints and
Sounders are available to fully support the product range.
Electrical equipment supplied for use in Hazardous Areas
must comply with rigid requirements to ensure that its
introduction into the area does not increase the existing
risk. Thorn Security Limited have designed Intrinsically Safe
(I.S.) systems and equipment for use in Hazardous Areas
which can be connected to Fire Detection Systems installed
in Safe Areas.
There are two I.S. systems used by Thorn Security Limited.
System 620 for use in conventional fire detection circuits
and System 800 for use with MINERVA MX digital
addressable circuits. The control equipment of the fire
detection system must be connected either via a Shunt
Diode Safety Barrier or by an Isolating Interface to System
620 and System 800.
Two Sounder Systems (one earthed and one isolated) are
available for use with System 620 and System 800.
APPLICATION - GENERAL
The System Designer must be familiar with BS EN 60079-14:
2003, EN 50, EN 50020 and ATEX certification and have
successfully completed an appropriate recognised course in
Intrinsic Safety.
The nature of the Hazard must be defined by the customer
and a survey carried out to determine the proximity of the
safe area to establish cable runs. The probability of a
flammable mixture being present is defined by a Zone
Number. Flammable gases are classified in Groups and their
minimum spontaneous ignition temperature is categorised
by Class. Thorn Security equipment marked
EExe ia IIC T5 would be suitable for use in worst case
conditions, e.g. Zone 0 (ia), Hydrogen (IIC), T5 (100 deg C).
The Fire Alarm Equipment and Safety Barriers should be
placed as near as possible to the containment wall of the
Hazardous Area. This minimises the cable lengths between
the barrier and the Hazardous Area and thus the capacity to
store energy.
In order that an Installation will comply with the ATEX
certification designated for each system it is essential that
the certified devices are connected with cables of the
specified limits. These limits have been certified for specific
classifications of hazard in order that energy storage is
limited.
Safety Barriers are incorporated into the circuit feeding the
Hazardous Area to limit the voltage excursion and the
current. The limit of voltage and current will prevent a fault
within the I.S. circuit exceeding the ignition conditions.
THE FITTING OF SAFETY BARRIERS, ISOLATING
INTERFACES OR SOUNDER DRIVERS DOES NOT IN
ITSELF MAKE A CIRCUIT TO WHICH THEY ARE
CONNECTED INTRINSICALLY SAFE.
Design of the system requires that the designer has all
the information concerning the installation correctly
documented.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 10 Page 1
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 2
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
APPLICATION - HAZARDOUS AREA
SHUNT-DIODE SAFETY BARRIERS AND INTERFACE UNITS
A Hazardous Area is defined as one where in the presence
of a flammable mixture, ignition may cause an explosion.
There is a risk of an explosion when substances (whether
liquid, gas, vapour, dust, powder, or solid) are mixed with air
to form a flammable atmosphere.
A Shunt-Diode Safety Barrier, Isolating I.S. Interface Unit,
or Isolating Sounder Driver protects the integrity of an
Intrinsically Safe circuit under 'Fault' conditions. The
over-voltage protection provided by a Shunt-Diode Safety
Barrier is with reference to the safety barrier earth
connection. It is therefore imperative that a HIGH INTEGRITY
EARTH is used for this type of barrier.
To prevent the possibility of ignition in flammable
atmospheres special precautions for the construction and
use of electrical apparatus is required. One method of
construction and use is defined as INTRINSICALLY SAFE.
APPLICATION - INTRINSIC SAFETY
To preclude the risk of an explosion, equipment in the
Hazardous Area must not be capable of causing ignition
under normal operating, or specific fault conditions. Limiting
the energy which can be stored in, and released by,
electronic circuitry and cables in the Hazardous Area is
achieved by using Intrinsically Safe equipment and by
placing restrictions on the cable parameters.
To complete the explosion protection concept of a circuit a
Safety Barrier must be connected between the Hazardous
Area equipment and the source of power in the Safe Area.
The electrical power which may be supplied or drawn from a
Safe Area (i.e. an area with no definable hazard) is limited by
using Shunt-Diode Safety Barriers or Isolating I.S. Interface
Units.
Connection of the Hazardous Area equipment to the Safety
Barrier must comply with the limitations listed in the System
Certification. These limits have been certified for specific
classifications of hazard in order that energy storage in the
cables is limited. If the Electrical Energy in a circuit is less
than the value required to ignite a potentially explosive
mixture then the circuit is said to be INTRINSICALLY SAFE.
APPLICATION - GALVANIC ISOLATORS
A High Integrity Earth is a current sink of nominally zero
impedance capable of passing a fault current without
compromising the function of the Shunt-Diode Safety
Barrier. Connection to this earth and the barrier earth must
not be more than 1 ohm and not less than 4mm2 cross
section area.
Several types of safety barrier are commercially available
and include Single circuit and Dual circuit Shunt-diode, and
galvanically isolating types. The Shunt-diode type requires a
High Integrity Earth connection and the galvanically
Isolating type operates in a fully floating electrically isolated
condition; no High Integrity I.S. earth is required.
A Shunt-Diode Safety Barrier DOES NOT make a circuit to
which it is connected Intrinsically Safe.
CERTIFICATION
The design and construction of the equipment that may be
installed in a Hazardous Area is controlled by a scheme of
inspection and certification to the EU ATEX Directive
94/9/EC. The inspection and certification is carried out by an
approved ATEX notified body.
Designers are licensed to reproduce the marks on
equipment that complies with the Certification listed in its
License Number.
Only ATEX approved barriers/isolators and intrinsically safe
hazardous area equipment may be used.
Galvanic isolators protect the integrity of an Intrinsically Safe
circuit under "Fault" conditions.
Galvanic isolators operate in a fully floating electrically
isolated condition, no High Integrity I.S. earth is required.
Chapter 10 Page 2
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 3
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Special Hazard Flame Detectors
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
ATEX, ICEX & FM approved
Fast, reliable flame detection using multi-infrared detection
Simplifies alarm handling for remote control room situations
Provides immediate visual ID of alarm location
Robust stainless steel housing with heated window
Automatic monitoring of detector functionality
256 cell infrared sensor array monitoring the field of view to
separately identify flame and non flame sources
Range of integral interface options
Masking of part of field of view with software configuration
tool
60m detection range with 90° field of view
Remote video monitoring with fire location and detector
information
Automatic optical path monitoring
History Log stored in detector
FV300 Array Based Flame Detectors
The FlameVision FV300 is a range of detectors that use a
256 cell multi-infrared array, to detect flame and provide
positional information so that the location of a flame within
the detector’s field of view can be communicated.
Additionally, an inbuilt CCTV camera can transmit a
“detector’s eye view” of the protected area to a CCTV
monitor. Superimposed onto the CCTV picture will be the
positional data highlighting exactly where the source of
alarm is coming from.
An angle of view of 90 degrees on the horizontal plane has
been achieved with little or no reduction in sensitivity over
the entire field. A pan fire covering one-tenth of a square
metre can be detected by the FlameVision FV300 at a range
of 60 metres. Such a small fire at that range would not
normally be visible on a CCTV picture. The superimposed
positional data on the CCTV display highlights and identifies
the source of the alarm. This can save precious time and
allow executive actions to take place at the earliest
opportunity thus minimising potential fire losses.
Markets:
Range of Interfaces:
The FlameVision FV300 detectors are intended for
applications demanding a high level of protection and where
a rapid response to fire is important.
As standard the FV300 is supplied with the following
interfaces:
Typical applications are:
Refineries
Drilling and production plants
Fuel loading facilities
Compressor stations
LNG/LPG processing & storage
Gas turbines
Chemical production
Aircraft hangars
Waste management/transfer
Sports stadiums
Tank farms
Printing industry
Warehousing
Munitions storage
FV300 Flame Detector Model Nos.
No camera
PAL Format camera
NSTC Format camera
09/10
• Fire and fault relays, programmable as normally open or
normally closed
• 4 to 20mA analogue current output, proportional to the
flame detection signal (sink or source)
• RS485 serial data port suitable for network connection
using a MODBUS protocol. This can be used to
communicate the positional co-ordinates of a flame within
the field of view of the detector
• Video output compatible with twisted pair video cable
Flame Vision Models:
There are six FlameVision models in the FV300 detector
range. There are models with and without cameras. Each
model is also supplied either with a sealed back-box and a
pre-connected 3m length of cable or with two threaded
cable gland entries.
Cable gland entries
FV311S
FV311SC
FV311SC-N
Sealed back-box
FV312S
FV312SC
FV312SC-N
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 10 Page 3
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 4
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Mechanical Characteristics
516.300.006
Dimensions
Height:
138.8 mm
Width:
152.8 mm
Depth:
91.7 mm
Weight:
3.96 kg
Mounting bracket weight: 1.54 kg
516.300.008
Materials
Enclosure:
516.300.057
Detection window:
Camera window:
Guard/label plate:
Mounting bracket:
516.300.007
516.300.055
Stainless Steel 316L, ANC4BFCLC
to BS 3146: Part 2
Sapphire
Toughened glass
Stainless Steel 316S16 to BS 1449:
Part 2
Stainless Steel 316S16 to BS 1449:
Part 2
Screws etc. exposed
to the elements:
Stainless Steel 316 A4
Electronic modules
Fibreglass substrate
516.300.056
517.300.001
517.300.002
517.300.005
517.300.006
517.300.021
517.300.022
FV311S Flameproof Detector - cable gland
entries - no camera
FV311SC Flameproof Detector - cable
gland entries - PAL camera
FV311SC-N Flameproof Detector - cable
gland entries - NTSC camera
FV312S Flameproof Detector - sealed
back box - no camera
FV312SC Flameproof Detector - sealed
back box - PAL camera
FV312SC-N Flameproof Detector - sealed
back box - NTSC camera
MB300 Mounting Bracket
WH300 Stainless Steel Weather Hood
JB300 Exe Junction Box
MK300 Field Spares Kit
WT300 Walk-test Controller
CTI300 Off-line Configuration Tool Kit
Electrical access
FV311 Series detectors: Standard M20 gland holes (two)
FV312 Series detectors: Multi twisted pair screened cable
Environmental Temp. Humidity, Enclosure Protection
and Pressure
Operating temp. range
without camera:
Operating temp.
range with camera:
Maximum withstand
temp:
Storage temp. range:
Relative humidity:
Enclosure protection:
Normal operating
atmospheric press:
Heat radiation from sun:
Chapter 10 Page 4
- 40°C to + 80°C
- 10°C to + 55°C
120°C (for 10minutes)
- 40°C to + 80°C
Up to 99% (non condensing)
Tested to IP66 and IP67
910 mbar to 1055 mbar
0 to 1kWm2 typical
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 5
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Features
• Triple waveband infrared solar blind flame detection for
optimum false alarm immunity
• Unrivalled black body rejection over a wide range of
source temperatures
• Range adjustable to 50 metres for a 0.1m2 petrol pan fire
• Discrimination of optical faults (dirty windows) from other
faults by the built-in self test feature
• Housing designed for easy installation of cabling
• Models also available with relay or 4-20mA outputs
• Patented dual filter for complete solar blindness
• 100° field of view on IS versions
• 90° field of view on Flameproof versions
• IECEX Approved
S200 Plus Triple IR Solar Blind Flame Detector
Unlike other flame detectors on the market the MINERVA
S200 PLUS is available in both Intrinsically Safe (EEx ia) and
Flameproof (EEx d) models.
The flameproof models are suffixed by the letter "f" and are
ATEX Certified EEx d IIC T6. The detectors are suitable for
zones 1 and 2 where group IIC gases or lesser hazards can
be intermittently present in explosive concentrations.
The intrinsically safe models are suffixed by the letter " i "
and are ATEX Certified EEx ia IIC T5. As part of an
intrinsically safe circuit, it is suitable for zones 0,1 and 2
where group IIC gases or lesser hazards can be
continuously present in explosive concentrations.
Technical Specification
Product Codes
Detector Material:
Dimensions:
Weight:
Gland Entry:
Range:
517.001.266
517.001.263
517.001.184
Operating Temp:
Response Time:
Sensitivity:
Relative Humidity:
Enclosure:
Stainless Steel 316L/316
167H x 167W x 89D MM
4.5Kg
2 x 20mm
0.1m2 petrol at 50m
0.4m2 petrol at 60m
-40 to +80°C
Field Selectable 3,6 and 12s
3 range settings
95% (100% intermittent)
IP 66 and IP 67
S200+ Spares Kit & Sealant
S200+ Weather Protection Assembly
S200+ Detector Mounting Bracket
Datasheet - Product Code PSF102U “Minerva S200 Plus Series”
Approvals
Various models are certified by a number of approval
bodies including those listed below.
ATEX Approved models have a suffix ‘1’ as the third digit.
FM Approved models have a suffix ‘2’ as the third digit.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 10 Page 5
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 6
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
S200 Plus Triple IR Solar Blind Flame Detector
Additional Features
• Flexible mounting and angular adjustment
• 2 x 20mm field cable entries
• IP66/67 housing designed for external use
• Rugged 316 stainless steel housing and mounting bracket
• Operating temperature range of -40 to + 80°C
• Variable response times and sensitivity settings
• Remote self test and range setting
• True window test in detection area (i.e. not in the edge of the
window)
• Terminals provided for Remote LED connection where relevant
• BASEEFA (CENELEC) certified
• Approved to EN54 Pt 10 (Except for S271 & FV282F)
• IEC 61508 Approved (SIL2)
• FM, DNV and LRS certified
• Very low power consumption (0.35mA)
• Models available with Conventional or Analogue Addressable
interface (requires 2 core cable only)
Approvals
Interface
Conventional
S231i+
4
S231f+
4
S232f+
4
4-20mA
ATEX
MZX Addressable
FM
Ex ‘d’
516.037.004
516.037.003
4
S241f+
4
4
4
S261f+
S271i+
4
S271f+
4
4
516.038.004
516.038.003
4
516.040.002
516.041.004
4
Fire Catalogue
516.037.015
4
4
4
Product Codes
Ex ‘d’
4
4
Chapter 10 Page 6
Ex ‘ia’
4
S241i+
FV282F+
Relay
516.041.003
4
516.040.014
09/10
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 7
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
System 800 Fire Detection for Hazardous Areas
Features
•
•
•
•
•
Addressable I.S. MX Technology
Compatible with S271i+ flame detector
Compatible I.S. callpoint.
Atex certified intrinsically safe Ex II 1 GD System
Suitable for use in Zone 0, 1, 2, 20, 21 & 22
System 800 Fire Detection for Hazardous Areas
A complete range of ATEX and ICEX certified detectors suitable
for use in Zone 0, 1, 2, 20, 21 & 22 Areas. MX digital
addressable for use on Minerva MX Fire Controllers.
There is a risk of fire or explosion in all areas containing
flammable substances in the form of liquids, gasses, dust or
materials. Where these combustible materials are mixed with air
in sufficient concentration they form a flammable atmosphere
and the areas containing them are designated Hazardous
Areas. When a source of ignition, such as a spark, is applied in
a hazardous area, an explosion could take place. Electrical
equipment supplied for use in Hazardous Areas must comply
with requirements to ensure that its introduction into the area
does not increase the existing risk. System 800 is an MX
TechnologyTM Intrinsically Safe (I.S) system for use in Hazardous
Areas which can be connected to the MX Fire Detection
Systems installed in the Safe Areas.
The System designer must be familiar with ATEX certification
and have successfully completed an appropriate recognised
course in Intrinsic Safety. Design of the system requires that
the designer has all the information concerning the
installation correctly documented. The nature of the hazard
must be defined by the customer and a survey carried out to
determine the proximity of the safe area to establish cable
runs.
In order that an Installation will comply with the ATEX
certification designated for each system, it is essential that
the certified devices are connected with cables of the
specified limits. These limits have been certified for specific
classifications of hazard in order that energy storage is
limited.
The number of devices connected to the barrier and located
in the Hazardous Area must always be limited to not more
than the listed maximum.
The use of the MX designer Software tool will ensure correct
loop loading and it’s use is essential to the design process.
System 800 is for use in MX Technology Addressable Fire
detection circuits.
Datasheet PSF129U
Manual 17A-02-DETEx
The probability of a flammable mixture being present is
defined by a zone number. Flammable gasses are classified
in Groups and their minimum spontaneous ignition
temperature is categorised by Class. Tyco Safety Products
supplied equipment marked EEx ia IIC T5 would be suitable
for use in worst case conditions. E.G. Zone 0 (ia), Hydrogen
(IIc), T5 (100 deg C). The Fire Alarm Equipment and Safety
Barriers should be placed as near as possible to the
containment wall of the Hazardous Area. This minimises the
cable lengths between the barrier and the Hazardous Area
and thus the capacity to store energy.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 10 Page 7
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 8
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
801PHEx/811PHExn Smoke and Heat Detector
The 801PHEx/811PHExn Optical
Smoke & Heat Detectors form part of
the 800Ex Series of MX Addressable
Fire Detectors. The detector plugs
into the 5BEX base.
The mode of detector may be:
• Optical smoke only detector
(sensitivity - High, Normal or Low)
• HPO smoke detector (sensitivity
High, Normal or Low)
• Heat only rate-of-rise (A1R)
detector (no sensitivity selection)
• Heat fixed temperature 60°C (A2S
no sensitivity selection)
• Optical (sensitivity High, Normal or
Low) combined with heat fixed
temperature 60°C (A2S)
• HPO (sensitivity High, Normal or
Low) combined with heat fixed
temperature 60°C (A2S)
Technical Specification
ATEX Code:
Ex II 1GD/3G
Cenelec Code:
Ex ia IIC T5/Ex iaD 20 T100°C/
EExnA II T4
Weight:
0.2Kg detector and base (approx)
Operating Temp. Range:
-25°C to +70°C
Storage Temp:
-40°C to +70°C
Relative Humidity:
95% non- condensing
Product Codes
516.800.530
801PHEx Optical Smoke + Heat
Detector
516.800.534
811PHExn Optical Smoke + Heat
Detector
Manual Vol 17A-02-PHExn
17A-02-PHEx
801CHEx/811CHExn CO & Heat Detector
The 801CHEx/811CHExn Carbon
Monoxide plus Heat Detector form
part of the 800Ex Series of MX
Addressable Fire Detectors. The
detector plugs into the 5BEX base.
The mode of detector may be:
• Heat only detector (A1R or A2S)
(sensitivity: High, Normal or Low)
• Compensated Carbon Monoxide
detector (sensitivity: High Normal
or Low)
• Compensated Carbon Monoxide
detector (sensitivity: High or
Normal) combined with heat (A1R)
Technical Specification
ATEX Code:
Ex II 1GD/3G
Celenec Code:
Ex ia IIC T5/Ex iaD 20 T100°C/
EExnA II T4
Weight:
0.2Kg detector and base (approx)
Operating Temp. Range:
0°C to +55°C/-20°C to +40°C
Storage Temp:
-20°C to +55°C
Relative Humidity:
95% non condensing.
Product Codes
516.800.531
801CHEx Carbon Monoxide + Heat
Detector
516.800.535
811CHExn Carbon Monoxide + Heat
Detector
Technical Specification
ATEX Code:
Ex II 1GD/3G
Celenec Code:
Ex ia IIC T5/Ex iaD 20 T100°C/
EExnA II T4
Weight:
0.2Kg detector and base (approx)
Operating Temp. Range:
-25°C to +70°C
Storage Temp:
-40°C to +70°C/-40°C to +80°C
Relative Humidity:
95% non-condensing
Product Codes
516.800.532
801HEx Heat Detector
516.800.536
811HExn Heat Detector
Technical Specification
ATEX Code:Ex II 1GD
Cenelec Code: Ex ia IIC T4/
Ex iaD 20 T135°C
Weight:
0.2Kg detector and base (approx)
Operating Temp.Range:
-20°C to +70°C
Storage Temp:
-40°C to +80°C
Relative Humidity:
90% non-condensing
Product Codes
516.800.066
801FEx I.R. Flame Detector
516.800.067
811FEx Marine I.R. Flame Detector
Manual Vol 17A-02-CHExn
17A-02-CHEx
801HEx/811HExn Heat Detector
The 801HEx/811HExn Heat
Detectors form part of the 800Ex
Series of MX Addressable Fire
Detectors. The detector plugs into
the 5BEX base.
The mode of detector may be:
• EN54-5 A1R, rate-of- rise normal
ambient
• EN54-5 A2S, fixed 60°C
• EN54-5 CR, rate-of-rise high
ambient;
Manual Vol 17A-02-HExn
17A-02-HEx
801FEx Flame Detector
The 801FEx point type flame
detector forms part of the MX
Technology®range of digital
addressable fire detectors. The
detector plugs into the 5BEX base.
The 801FEx is a full featured solar
blind flame detectors and can detect
a 0.1m2 fire at a range of 20m.
Chapter 10 Page 8
Fire Catalogue
Manual Vol 17A-02-FEX
09/10
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 9
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
IS28 Banshee Sounder
The IS28 MK4 intrinsically safe
banshee sounder has been
developed for use in hazardous
areas.
Up to a maximum of four sounders
may be connected to one I.S.
sounder driver. Each IS28 banshee
has an output of 94dBA at one
metre, this sound output will reduce
to approximately 90dBA when four
sounders are fitted to a circuit.
Features
• ATEX Certification number
ITS03ATEX21311X to II GD
• EEx ia IIC T5
• ICEX Approved
Product Code
576.501.013
IS28 MK 4 Banshee BS5839 Low
Frequency ATEX Certified
Intrinsically Safe - Grey Sounder
CP840EX/CP830Exn Break Glass Callpoint
The CP840Ex and CP830Exn
Weatherproof Break Glass Callpoint
is designed to monitor and signal
the condition of the switch contact
associated with the break glass.
• ATEX Code: Ex II1GD/3G
• Cenelec Code: Ex ia IIC T5/Ex iaD
20 T100°C/EEx nL IIC T4
Product Codes
514.800.513
CP840Ex MX Digital Addressable
Breakglass Callpoint
514.800.514
CP830Exn MX Digital Addressable
Breakglass Callpoint
Manual Vol 17A-02-WCP830Exn
17A-02-CPEX
IF800Ex Interface Module
The Intrinsically Safe IF800EX
Interface Module is designed to
monitor fire contacts such as
sprinkler flow switches. The IF800Ex
is contained within a grey
compression moulded glass filled
polyester box with 2 x 20mm cable
gland holes.
The electronic components are
mounted on a double sided printed
circuit board built into a potted
module formed from a plastic
moulding. Connectivity is via two
terminal blocks fitted to the PCB.
Product Code
514.001.062
IF800Ex MX Digital Addressable
Interface Module Assembly
Manual Vol 17A-02-IFEX
• ATEX Code: Ex II 1GD
• Cenelec Code: EEx ia IIC T5
EXI800 Interface Module & Galvanic Isolators
The EXI800 Interface Module, used
with a galvanic isolator, provides a
path for an MX panel to transparently
communicate to slave devices
(800Ex Detectors, IF800Ex Interface
Module or CP840Ex Addressable
Break Glass Callpoint) connected to
the Intrinsically Safe loop. The
interface reduces the standard MX
loop supply voltage and signalling
currents to levels that are
acceptable for hazardous areas.
The EXI800 can detect a short
circuit of the left-loop, the right-loop,
or the IS spur and will isolate the
offending circuit from the other loop
connections. The IS loop output of
the EXI800 interfaces with the
Pepper+Fuchs KFDO-CS-Ex1.54
Galvanic Isolator supplying loop
voltage and signalling currents to the
Intrinsically Safe Loop. The EXI800
is supplied complete with one
service tool EX dongle that is
required to activate address
programming using the standard MX
service tool. The MTL 5021 Isolating
sounder driver enables an
intrinsically safe sounder device
located in the hazardous area, to be
controlled from the safe area. The
MTL 5021 has one channel and is
suitable for connecting suitable
certified loads in Zone 0, IIC, T4-6
hazardous areas.
Product Codes
514.001.063
EXI800 Interface Module
517.001.259
Pepper+Fuchs KFD0-CS-EX1.54
Galvanic Isolator
557.203.008
Spare Service Tool Ex Dongle
517.001.245
MTL 5021 I. S. Sounder Driver
Enclosures are usually selected on
the number of units they will
accommodate. The following table
shows the capacity of each of the
enclosure types.
Product Codes
517.001.248
DX070 Enclosure
517.001.247
DX170 Enclosure
Manual Vol 17A-02-EXI
IS Barrier Enclosure
The MTL’DX’ Series enclosure
equipment will house the EXI800
20mm pitch), Pepper+Fuchs KFDOCS-Ex1.54 Galvanic Isolator (20mm
pitch) and MTL 5021 I.S. Sounder
Driver 16.2mm pitch). The units are
DIN rail mounted with 70mm of rail
supplied with the DX070 and 170mm
of rail with the DX170.
Enclosure
MTL5000 isolators 16mm Pitch
MTL7000 barriers 7.5mm Pitch
DX070
4(2*)
9(5*)
DX170
10 (8*)
22(18*)
* Use these figures when two IMB57 mounting brackets for tagging/earth rail accessories are included.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 10 Page 9
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 10
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Features
• Glass Reinforced Polyester Enclosure – light, strong and
not subject to corrosion.
• Resettable Element.
• Explosion protected EExe (ATEX Approved).
• In line and end of line resistors.
• Red Epoxy Finish.
• 7 x terminals.
• Lift flap for extra protection against inadvertent operation.
• 1 x changeover switch.
• Captive cover screws.
• Key operated test facility – simple but secure.
• 1 x M20 bottom cable entry.
BG MIM800 Callpoint EX II 2 GD
An Ex II 2 GD Dust Approved & Increased Safety (EExemd)
Resettable Manual Alarm Call Point for use with the EExd
Flameproof MIM800 input module in EExd housing on an
Addressable Detection & Releasing System in gas and dust
explosive risks.
Please note that the above part is only compatible with
Consys Version 17.0 and above when used with
577.800.067.
Technical Specification
Product Code
Protection:
514.001.107
Explosion Protected
EExed(Increased Safety)
Certification:
ATEX approved Ex II 2 GD
BAS02ATEX2105X
EExemdIICT4
CENELEC EN50014
EN50019
EN50018
EN50028
Suitable for use in Zones 1 & 2
Voltage:
Up to 250V
Certified Temperature: -20oC to +50oC
Ingress Protection:
IP66 & 67
Terminals:
7 x 2.5mm²
Switch Ratings(1 x Changeover):
DC 0-30V 5A (Resistive) or 3A
(Inductive)
DC 30-50V 1A Resistive or Inductive
AC 0-254V 5A Resistive or Inductive
Cable Entries:
1 x M20 Bottom
Weight:
1.2Kg
Material:
Anti Static U.V. Resistant Glass
Reinforced Polyester
Finish:
Red Epoxy Paint
Resistors:
Alarm: 100 Ohm
EOL: 250 Ohm
Labelling:
Burning House Symbol
Dimensions (W X H X D):
120mm x 126mm x 75mm
Chapter 10 Page 10
Fire Catalogue
EX II 2 GD Dust Approved & Increased
Safety (EExemd) Resettable Manual
Alarm Callpoint
09/10
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 11
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Features
•
•
•
•
•
Copper Free Metal Alloy Aluminium Housing
Explosion Protected to EExd (ATEX Approved)
9 x Terminals
3 x M20 Cable Entries
Fast Interrupt Mode for Call Points
MIM800 Input Module in EExd Housing
An EExd Flameproof MIM800 Addressable Module for
extending the monitoring of Call Points and other Alarm
Inputs on an MX, ZX and MZX Addressable System in gas
and dust explosive risks.
Please note that the above part is only compatible with
Consys Version 17.0 and above when used with
514.001.107.
Technical Specification
Protection:
Certification:
Voltage:
Certified Temperature:
Ingress Protection:
Terminals:
Cable Entries:
Weight:
Material:
Dimensions
(W X H X D):
09/10
Product Code
Explosion Protected EExd
(Flameproof)
Ex II 2 GD LOM02ATEX2037
EExdIICT6
CENELEC EN50014
EN50018
EN50019
EN50281-1-1
EN60439-1
Suitable for use in Zones 1 and 2
to IEC 60079-10
Suitable for use in Zones 21 and 22
to EN50281-3
40Vdc
-20oC to +55oC
IP67
9 x 2.5mm²
3 x M20
0.8 Kg
Metal Alloy Aluminium - Copper
Free
577.800.067
MIM800 Input Module in EExd Housing
108mm x 98mm x 90mm
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 10 Page 11
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 12
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Features
• Allows the DDM800 to be mounted in a Hazardous Area.
• Allows the monitoring of Call Points and other Alarm
Inputs (including 4-20mA devices) designed for use in
Hazardous Areas on an MX, ZX and MZX Addressable
System in gas and dust explosive risks.
• Approved for use in Gas Zone 1 and 2.
• Approved for use in Dust Zone 21 and 22.
• Copper Free Metal Alloy Aluminium Housing.
• Explosion Protected to EExd (ATEX Approved).
• 5 x M20 Cable Entries (3 x bottom and one each side).
DDM800 Fire & Gas Detector Module in EExd Housing
A DDM800 Fire and Gas Detector Module in a EExd
Housing for use in special hazardous area applications.
The DDM800 Universal Fire and Gas Detection Module is a
detector module designed to interface a wide range of
conventional fire detectors to MZX Technology® control
panels.
The DDM800 is supported by MXConsys® Version 15 and
above and Issue 6 MXDesigner. It is recommended that
MXDesigner is used for all system designs using DDM800
modules. For detailed design and application details,
please refer to document "DDM800 Universal Fire & Gas
Detector Module Product Application and Design
Information" reference 17A-02-DDM.
Additionally the option is available to connect two 4 to
20mA devices and to configure the alarm thresholds within
the control panel.
Technical Specification
Product Code
Protection:
577.800.066
Certification:
Voltage:
Certified Temperature:
Ingress Protection:
Terminals:
Cable Entries:
Weight:
Material:
Dimensions
(W X H X D):
Chapter 10 Page 12
Explosion Protected EExd
(Flameproof)
Ex II 2 GD LOM02ATEX2037
EExdIICT6
CENELEC EN50014
EN50018
EN50019
EN50281-1-1
EN60439-1
Suitable for use in Zones 1 and 2 to
IEC 60079-10
Suitable for use in Zones 21 and 22
to EN50281-3
40Vdc
-20oC to +55oC
IP67
12 x 2.5mm²
5 x M20
1.3 Kg
Metal Alloy Aluminium - Copper
Free
DDM800 Fire & Gas Detector Module in
EExd Housing
150mm x 150mm x 104mm
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 13
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
System 620 Fire Detection for Hazardous Areas
Features
•
•
•
•
•
•
Conventional I.S. system
Suitable for worst case (EEx ia IIC T5)
High Performance Optical (HPO) smoke detector
Compatible with S231i+ flame detector
Compatible I.S. callpoint
Suitable for use in Zone 0,1,2,20,21& 22
System 620 Fire Detection
A complete range of ATEX and ICEX certified detectors
suitable for use in Zones 0,1,2,20,21 & 22 areas for use on
conventional panels. There is a risk of fire or explosion in all
areas containing flammable substances in the form of
liquids, gasses, dust or materials. Where these combustible
materials are mixed with air in sufficient concentration they
form a flammable atmosphere and the areas containing
them are designated Hazardous Areas. When a source of
ignition, such as a spark, is applied in a hazardous area, an
explosion could take place. Electrical equipment supplied
for use in Hazardous Areas must comply with requirements
to ensure that its introduction into the area does not
increase the existing risk. System 620 is an Intrinsically Safe
(I.S.) system for use in Hazardous Areas which can be
connected to a conventional fire Alarm Controller installed in
the Safe Area.
The number of devices connected to the barrier and located
in the Hazardous Area must always be limited to not more
than the listed maximum.
The System Designer must be familiar with ATEX
certification and have successfully completed an
appropriate recognised course in Intrinsic Safety. Design
of the system requires that the designer has all the
information concerning the installation correctly
documented. The nature of the hazard must be defined by
the customer and a survey carried out to determine the
proximity of the safe area to establish cable runs.
Datasheet - PSF122U
When a mixture of devices is connected to any one zone the
numbers must be reduced in proportion to the ratio of the
load presented to the barrier. When a System includes the
use of an S231i+, it must be remembered that the load it
presents to the circuit is twice that of a detector. A mixture of
large and small load devices connected to a zone will
require a calculation for the number of allowed detectors.
System 620
System 620 is for use in conventional fire detection circuits.
Two Sounder Systems, (one earthed and one isolated), are
available and either can be used with System 620.
The probability of a flammable mixture being present is
defined by a Zone Number. Flammable gases are classified
in Groups and their minimum spontaneous ignition
temperature is categorised by Class. Tyco Safety Products
supplied equipment marked EEx ia IIC T5 would be suitable
for use in worst case conditions. Eg. Zone 0 (ia), Hydrogen
(IIc), T5 (100 deg C). The Fire Alarm Equipment and Safety
Barriers should be placed as near as possible to the
containment wall of the Hazardous Area. This minimises the
cable lengths between the barrier and the Hazardous Area
and thus the capacity to store energy.
In order that an Installation will comply with the ATEX
certification designated for each system it is essential that
the certified devices are connected with cables of the
specified limits. These limits have been certified for specific
classifications of hazard in order that energy storage is
limited.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 10 Page 13
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 14
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
High Performance Optical Smoke
The MR601TEX has been developed
to overcome the slower response of
the optical detectors to hot burning
fires, by increasing the sensitivity of
the optical detector when it is
associated with a rapid change in
temperature. In this way it is intended
to become a detector which can
cover some of the risks currently
covered by ion chamber detectors.
Smoke detectors will not detect
burning alcohol or other clean
burning liquids which do not
generate smoke particles.
If environmental conditions rule out
the use of smoke detectors, then a
heat detector of the type
MD601Ex/MD611Ex may provide an
acceptable, though less sensitive,
alternative. For general use, and
particularly where the ambient
temperature may be low, a 'Rate-ofRise' heat sensor is to be preferred.
This type of sensor reacts to
abnormally high rates of change of
temperature and provides the fastest
response over a wide range of
ambient temperatures. A fixed
temperature limit is also incorporated
in these detectors.
In many environments, e.g. kitchens
and boiler rooms, sudden, large
changes in temperature are
considered 'normal'. Rate-of-rise
detectors are generally not suitable in
these cases and fixed temperature
[static] types should be used.
ATEX Code:
Ex II 1GD
Cenelec Code:
Ex ia IIC T5/
Ex iaD 20 T100°C
Operating Temp Range:
-10°C to +55°C
Storage Temp:
-20°C to +55°C
Relative Humidity:
90% noncondensing
Product Code
516.054.011.Y (Vol 01B-04-D12)
MR601TEX Conventional High
Performance Optical Smoke Detector
Heat Detectors
ATEX Code :
Cenelec Code:
Ex iaD 20 T100°C
Ex II 1GD
Ex ia IIC T5/
Operating Temp Range:
-10°C to +55°C
Storage Temp:
-20°C to +55°C
Relative Humidity:
90% noncondensing
Product Codes
516.052.051.Y (Vol 01B-04-D11)
MD601EX Conventional Rate of Rise
Heat Detector
516.052.041.Y (Vol 01B-04-D11)
MD611EX Conventional Fixed
Temperature Heat Detector
Flame Detectors
Flame detectors, unlike smoke and
heat detectors, do not rely on
convection to transport the fire
products to the detector nor do they
rely on a ceiling to trap the products.
They can therefore be used to
protect large open areas without
sacrificing speed of response to
flaming fires. In order to ensure full
coverage however, flame detectors
do require direct line of sight to all
parts of the protected area.
Infra-red flame detectors such as the
601FEx are designed to respond
rapidly to fires which involve
Chapter 10 Page 14
clean-burning fuels such as alcohol
or methane, i.e. fires which would not
be detected by smoke detectors. The
601FEx Flame Sensor, by virtue of its
operating wavelength and flicker
discrimination is insensitive to normal
environmental influences. For
outdoor use a solar-blind detector
[e.g. the S200 Plus] should be used.
The 601FEx Flame detector should,
normally, only be used inside
buildings to supplement heat and
smoke detectors.
Fire Catalogue
ATEX Code:
Ex II 1GD
Cenelec Code:
Ex ia IIC T4/
Ex iaD 20 T135°C
Operating Temp Range:
-10°C to +55°C
Storage Temp:
-20°C to +55°C
Relative Humidity:
90% noncondensing
Product Codes
516.600.066 (Vol 01C-02-D10)
601FEx Infra-Red Flame Detector
516.600.067 (Vol 01C-02-D10)
601FEx-M Infra-Red Flame Detector
(Marine)
09/10
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 15
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Enhanced Carbon Monoxide Fire & Heat Detector
The MDU601EX detector is a
combined CO and Rate of Rise Heat
Detector where the sensitivity of the
CO detector is enhanced in
response to a fast rate of change of
temperature.
ATEX Code:
Ex II 1GD
Cenelec Code:
Ex ia IIC T5/
Ex iaD 20 T100°C
Operating Temp Range:
-10°C to +55°C
Storage Temp:
-20°C to +55°C
Relative Humidity:
90% non-condensing
Product Code
516.061.001.Y (Vol 01B-04-D14)
MDU 601EX Enhanced Carbon
Monoxide Fire & Heat Detector
5BEX Detector Base and Ancillaries
ATEX Code:
Product Codes
517.050.023
5BEX 5” Universal Ex Base
517.050.603
DHM-5B deckhead mounting
517.001.120
System 601 EOL Unit (Pk 10)
Ex II 1GD
Cenelec Code: Ex ia IIC T5/
Ex iaD 20 T100°C
Operating Temp Range:
-10°C to +55°C
Storage Temp:
-20°C to +55°C
Relative Humidity:
90% non-condensing
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 10 Page 15
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 16
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Features
• Intrinsically Safe
• Weatherproof to IP67
• Compatible with System 620
Intrinsically Safe Callpoint - ATEX Approved
The MCP220Ex is a conventional callpoint for use on the
ATEX Certified System.
Technical Specification
Product Code
Dimensions:
Weight:
Material:
Conventional:
Colour:
ATEX Code:
CENELEC:
514.001.109
ATEX Cert:
IP Rating:
Chapter 10 Page 16
93H x 98W x 66Dmm
270g
PC/ABS
Yes
Red
Ex II 1GD
EX ia IIC T4 Ga
/EX iaD T135°c Da
SIRA 06ATEX2131X
IP67
Fire Catalogue
MCP220Ex Red Callpoint intrinsically safe
for use with ATEX certified conventional
system 620.
09/10
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 17
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Features
• Intrinsically safe
• Weatherproof to IP66/IP67
• Robust GRP Housing
BG3 Intrinsically Safe Conventional Callpoint -Atex Approved
This manual fire alarm call point is designed in accordance
with the latest European Callpoint Standard (EN54-11).
Units are supplied in self coloured GRP with a ‘Burning
House’ duty label as standard.
Weatherproof to IP66/IP67 and available certified
intrinsically safe, simple apparatus manufactured from
glass reinforced polyester (GRP) which provides a robust,
corrosion free construction and ensures effective and
reliable operation in harsh industrial and offshore
environments.
Technical Specification
Product Code
Model:
Protection:
514.001.059
BG3I
Explosion Protected EExia
(Intrinsically Safe)
Certification:
CENELEC EN50014, 020
BASEEFA EExia IIC T4
Cert No. BAS00ATEX1067X
Suitable for use in Zones 0,1 & 2
Voltage:
Up to 28V (IS)
Certified Temp: -55°C to +55°C
Ingress Protection: IP66 & IP67
European Standard
for Callpoints:
EN54-11
Terminals:
6 X 4.0mm2
Cable Entries:
2 X M20 Bottom
Weight:
0.5Kg
Material:
UV resistant glass reinforced polyester
Finish:
Natural Red GRP
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Intrinsically Safe Callpoint (BG3I4NBN)
Chapter 10 Page 17
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 18
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Features
• Polyester Enclosure – light, strong and not subject to
corrosion.
• Break Glass.
• Explosion protected EExe (ATEX Approved).
• In line and end of line resistors.
• Red.
• 9 x terminals.
• Lift flap for extra protection against inadvertent operation.
• 1 x changeover switch.
• Captive cover screws.
• No hammer required – the glass is covered by a
membrane thus protecting the operator from glass
fragments.
• Key operated test facility – simple but secure.
• 2 x M20 bottom cable entries.
BG Conventional Callpoint EX II 2 GD
This EX II 2 GD Dust Approved & Increased Safety
(EExemd) Conventional Break Glass Manual Alarm Call
Point is fitted with a 470 ohm Alarm Level Resistor and a
4K7 ohm EOL Resistor for use with Tyco Conventional
Detection Circuits including the DIM800 and DDM800 MX
Modules.
It is also fitted with a removable link which allows it to be
connected on its own or with other Conventional Devices to
a Tyco Conventional Detection Circuit.
Technical Specification
Product Code
Protection:
514.001.108
Explosion Protected EExed
(Increased Safety)
Certification:
ATEX approved Ex II 2 GD
BAS02ATEX2105X
EExedmIICT4
CENELEC EN50014
EN50019
EN50018
EN50028
Suitable for use in Zones 1 & 2
Voltage:
Up to 250V
Certified Temperature: -20oC to +50oC
Ingress Protection:
IP66 & 67
Terminals:
9 x 2.5mm – up to 60V
Switch Ratings(1 x Changeover):
DC 0-30V 5A (Resistive) or 3A
(Inductive)
30-50 1A Resistive or Inductive
AC 0-254V 5A Resistive or
Inductive
Cable Entries:
2 x M20 Bottom
Weight:
1.2Kg
Material:
Anti Static U.V. Resistant Glass
Reinforced Polyester
Finish:
Red Epoxy Paint
Resistors:
Alarm: 470 Ohm
EOL: 4K7 Ohm
Labelling:
Burning House Symbol
Chapter 10 Page 18
Fire Catalogue
EX II 2 GD Dust Approved & Increased
Safety (EExemd) Conventional Break
Glass Manual Alarm Callpoint
09/10
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 19
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Banshee IS28
Product Code
IS28VCL MK4 Banshee BS5839 Low Frequency ATEX and
ICEX certified intrinsically safe grey sounder - 94dBA,
10mA. Certificate Number : ITS03ATEX21311x EXII 1GD
EExia IIC T5.
576.501.013
IS28VCL MK4 Banshee
Features
• Robust GRP Body
• Suitable for offshore and petrochem
• Certificated Intrinsically Safe
XB8 Intrinsically Safe Beacon
This ruggedised, intrinsically safe and weatherproof
beacon is intended for use in potentially explosive
atmospheres, and has been designed with high ingress
protection to cope with the harsh environmental conditions
found offshore and onshore in the oil, gas and
petrochemical industries.
Please refer to MEDC for guidance on cable capacitance
and barriers.
Technical Specification
Product Code
Certification:
540.001.038
CENELEC EN50014, 20 & 39
BAS02ATEX1258X
EExia IIB T4
Zones 0,1 & 2
Material:
UV stable glass reinforced
polyester body. Clear
polycarbonate cover/lens.
Retained stainless steel cover
screws.
Finish:
Painted Red
Tube Type:
Xenon discharge
Lens Colour:
Clear
Terminals:
8 x 2.5mm2
Flash Rate:
1 flash per second
Cable Entries:
Up to 3 x M20 via knockouts
Tube Energy:
0.5 Joules
Weight:
1.4kg
Certified Temperature: -55°C to + 60°C
Ingress Protection:
IP66 & IP67
Tube Life:
>1 x 106 Flashes
Voltage:
24V via suitable barrier
Current Consumption: 71mA max nominal
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Intrinsically Safe Xenon Beacon
(XB8BB024CNR)
Chapter 10 Page 19
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 20
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Features
• For use in hazardous areas
• Robust GRP construction
• Powerful Output, up to 115dBA
DB3 Flameproof Horn Sounder
This lightweight all GRP flameproof sounder is intended for
use in potentially explosive gas and dust atmospheres and
has been designed with high ingress protection to cope
with the harsh environmental conditions found offshore and
onshore in the oil, gas and petrochemical industries.
The flamepaths, flare and the body, are manufactured
completely from a UV stable glass reinforced polyester.
Stainless steel screws and sinter are incorporated thus
ensuring a corrosion free product. A tapered flamepath is
used to overcome the problems of assembly of parallel
spigot flamepaths.
Technical Specification
Terminals:
Mounting:
Cable Entries:
Tone Selection:
Certification:
UL Listed:
GOST Certification:
Material:
Sound Output:
Nominal Output (dBA)
93
105
108
111
112
114
115
Chapter 10 Page 20
6 x 2.5mm2
Stainless steel bracket with ratchet
facility
2 x 20mm EExd.
27 user selectable tones.
CENELEC EN50014,18,19
BASEEFA Cert. No.
BAS00ATEX2097X, EExd IIC 100°C
(-55 t. amb + 55°C)T5. Zones 1
and 2.
Class I Div 2, Groups A-D
Class II Div 2, Groups F & G
Class I Zones 1 & 2, AExd IIC T4.
Listing No. E203310.
1Exd IIC T4 & 1Exde IIC T4
Cert. No. A-0759
Russian Fire Alarm Approved
(VNIIP0)
GOST ‘K’ Certification Exd IIC T4
Chinese (C&ST) Certification Exd
IICT4
Body & horn in anti-static, UV
stable, glass reinforced polyester.
Swivel bracket & captive cover
screws in stainless steel.
115dB(A) +/- 3dB(A)(tone
dependent).
*Output measured with 24V input voltage. Tone set to
970Hz continuous.
Weight:
Ingress Protection:
Voltage:
Current
Consumption:
6.0kg approx
IP66 & IP67
Up to 48Vdc
380mA at 24Vdc
Certified Temperature:
EExd
UL
GOST Exd
DB3
-20°C
-55°C
-20°C
to +70°C to +70°C to +50°C
Product Code
576.501.043
Flameproof Horn Sounder
(DB3D048N2BNR)
Input Current (mA)*
50
100
150
200
250
300
350
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 21
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Features
• Robust Corrosion Resistant GRP body
• High Power (5 Joule)
• Certificated Flameproof
XB11 Flameproof Xenon Beacon
These certified beacons have been designed for use in
potentially explosive gas and dust atmospheres and harsh
environmental conditions. The glass reinforced polyester
enclosures are suitable for use offshore or onshore, where
light weight combined with corrosion resistance is required.
The beacon housing is manufactured completely from a
U.V. stable, glass reinforced polyester. Stainless steel
screws and mounting bracket are incorporated ensuring a
totally corrosion free product.
Technical Specification
Product Code
Voltage:
Tube Energy:
Peak Current
Consumption (mA):
Effective Intensity (Cd):
Peak Intensity (Cd):
Power Consumption
(Watts):
Note:
540.001.039
Weight:
Certified Temperature:
Ingress Protection:
Terminals:
Entries:
Certification:
24Vdc
5 Joules
Flameproof Xenon Beacon
(XB11B02406RNBNNNR)
320
29
22213
8
The Cd figures are for a clear
lens @ 1Hz flash rate. For red
lens multiple by 0.15
2.5Kg
EExd -55°C to + 70°C (T4)
-55°C to + 55°C (T5)
-55°C to + 40°C (T6)
IP66 & IP67
6 x 2.5mm2
2 x 20mm ISO EExd.
BASEEFA EExd IIB
135°C (-55 to AMB +70°C)T4
100°C (-55 to AMB + 55°C)T5
85°C (-55 to AMB + 40°C)T6
Cert. No. 99 ATEX 2195X.
CENELEC EN50014 and
EN50018
Material
Body: Glass reinforced polyester
Lens: Glass
Cover Screws + Backstrap:
Stainless steel 316
Finish: Red
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 10 Page 21
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 22
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
The following section relates to a range of intrinsically safe barrier and isolator equipment for use with Tyco Safety
Products manufactured fire detection systems. It essentially encompasses the relevant MTL 5000 and MTL 7000
series barriers plus the associated housing options as an alternative to existing MTL 700 series equipment.
On all issues of intrinsically safe systems design, please refer to Manual 26A for guidance.
Intrinsically Safe Barriers - Atex Approved
Galvanic Isolators - MTL 5000
The MTL 5061 is a two channel
interface for use with conventional
fire and smoke detectors located in
hazardous areas. This galvanic
isolator is CE marked, and replaces
the MTL 3043 barrier option. It is
suitable for connecting loads in Zone
0, IIC, T4-6 hazardous areas if
suitably certified.
The MTL 5021 Isolating sounder
driver enables an intrinsically safe
sounder device located in the
hazardous area, to be controlled
from the safe area. The MTL 5021
barrier is designed as a CE marked
replacement for the existing MTL
3021 barrier. It has one channel and
is suitable for connecting loads in
Zone 0, IIC, T4-6 hazardous area if
suitably certified.
When designing new systems or
upgrading existing MTL 3000 series
systems to MTL 5000 series, please
use the appropriate MTL “DX” series
enclosure equipment (16.2mm
pitch).
Product Codes
517.001.244
MTL 5061 2 channel galvanic
isolator for conventional detector
zone - used on BASEEFA Approved
System 601
517.001.245
MTL 5021 I.S. Sounder driver
One secondary replaceable fuse for
each barrier channel is provided and
is lower in value than the safety
related fuse. Fuses are packaged in
small mouldings which can be
latched in a disconnect position to
break the safe and hazardous areas
during commissioning, maintenance
and fault finding, thus avoiding the
need for additional disconnect
terminals.
Please note that this barrier is a
direct alternative for the MTL 728+
barrier.
Zener Barriers - MTL 7700
The MTL 7700 Series intrinsically
safe shunt-diode safety barriers are
innovative devices designed to
provide exceptionally high packing
densities, straightforward installation
and simplified connection,
commissioning and maintenance
facilities. The MTL 7700 Series
include secondary replaceable
fuses. These are useful where there
is the possibility of faults occurring
during commissioning, which would
otherwise blow the barriers’ internal
safety fuses.
Product Code
517.001.301
MTL 7728 + Zener Safety Barrier for
conventional detection circuits
designed in accordance with System
601
Zener Barriers - MTL 700
The MTL700 series are 1 or 2
channel devices which pass the
electrical signal from fire detectors to
the control panel or from the control
panel to the output device. The
barriers limit the amount of energy
to a level that cannot ignite explosive
atmospheres. The over-voltage
protection provided by a ShuntDiode Safety Barrier is with
reference to the safety barrier earth
connection. It is therefore imperative
that a HIGH INTEGRITY EARTH is
used for this type of barrier
(14.2mm pitch).
Chapter 10 Page 22
Product Codes
517.001.201
MTL728 Single Channel Zener
Safety Barrier
517.001.202
MTL788 Dual Channel Zener Safety
Barrier
546.004.005
Intrinsically safe sounder circuit
interface module
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 23
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Safety Enclosures
UC Series Enclosures
The UC series of enclosures
provides a simple but effective
means of mounting and protecting
the MTL3000 series units, in safe
areas. A standard lightweight
enclosure with transparent lid, which
can accommodate 4 units. The
polycarbonate enclosure is impact
resistant, flame retardant and
dustproof to IP65.
Product Code
517.001.196
UC2 4 Way Barrier Housing
MT Series Enclosures
The MT series of enclosures
provides a simple, effective means
of mounting and protecting MTL700
Series barriers in safe areas or
low-risk hazardous areas. Three
lightweight polycarbonate enclosures
with see through lids accommodate
up to 2, 5 and 12 barriers in the safe
area. All the enclosures are supplied
ready fitted with a nickel plated brass
busbar mount, so barriers can be
installed and wired up immediately
without special tools.
Product Codes
517.001.198
MT2 2 Way Zener Barrier Housing.
517.001.199
MT5 5 Way Zener Barrier Housing.
517.001.200
MT12 12 Way Zener Barrier Housing
The ERL7 earth rail is a nickel plated
3 x 10mm rail (1 metre long),
suitable for a do-it-your self
mounting arrangement. It will
accommodate up to 2.5 ETM7 earth
terminals per barrier location for
terminating earth returns and cable
screens from the hazardous area.
Product Codes
517.001.205
ERL7 Earth rail for I.S. systems
517.001.206
ETM7 Earth termination connection
system
517.001.207
IMB7 Insulating mounting block
517.001.120
System 601 EOL Unit (PK10)
Ancillaries
The IMB7 mounts on a flat surface or
top hat rail (35mm) or G-profile rail
and acts as a convenient method for
mounting the earth busbar.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 10 Page 23
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 24
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
Features
• Continuous detection despite extremely large monitoring
area.
• Easy and rapid installation of the maintenance free sensor
cable.
• Very high resistance to extreme ambient influences
(immune against heat, cold, humidity, corrosion, strong
winds and draft).
• Undiminished operation under electromagnetic
interference.
• Unprecedented security against false alarms.
• Very high sensor cable service life of up to 30 years.
• Temperature profile over the complete measurement
range delivers exact information of location, size and
spread of fire.
• Very low maintenance costs as maintenance and trouble
shooting can be done from the control unit.
• VdS certified to EN 54 part 5
• One controller unit will drive up two 8 km spurs or one 8
km loop.
• Easy integration into existing installations.
• Each sensor cable divided into up to 256 zones.
• Individual configuration of 5 alarm criteria per zone.
• Network connection through Modbus, TCP/IP, FTP and
SCPI interfaces.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Fibre Optic Linear Heat Detection System
The MZX SensorLaser™ Plus guarantees fast and
continuous fire detection even in difficult and varying
ambient conditions. This linear heat detection system
enables long and heavily fragmented facilities such as traffic
and supply tunnels, cable routes and conveyor belts as well
as large scale buildings such as production halls, cold
stores and multi storey car parks to be monitored at all
times. The MZX SensorLaser™ Plus is ideal for use in areas
that are hard or impossible to access after installation, e.g.
false floors, since maintenance and troubleshooting can be
carried out from the control unit.
The fibre optic sensor cable itself is maintenance free and,
thanks to its particularly robust characteristics, offers a high
level of security against false alarms. The sensor cable is
insensitive to dust, dirt, moisture, high temperatures (up to
approx. 90 °C), pressure and the action of vibration and
wind as well as corrosive atmospheres. Because of its
purely passive, optical analysis process, the MZX
SensorLaser™ Plus is even immune from electromagnetic
interference caused by generators, energy routes, cables or
electric motors.
The MZX SensorLaser™ Plus delivers precise information
about the location, size and spread of a fire even under
ambient conditions that would cause other fire detection
systems to fail.
The MZX SensorLaser™ Plus enables a measuring range of
up to 8 km per sensor cable. Up to 2 spurs each with an 8
km measurement range, or 1 loop with an 8 km range can
be connected. Since the ambient conditions in a monitoring
area of this size can vary enormously, each sensor cable
can be divided into up to 256 zones. Several alarm criteria
can be freely defined in each zone. This level of precision
adjustment allows the MZX SensorLaser™ Plus to provide a
high level of resistance to false alarms and precise fire
detection despite contrary and variable ambient conditions.
The accessible laser radiation emitted by the Class 1M laser
is not hazardous to the eyes (provided there are no other
optical instruments in the path of the beam), while operation
is absolutely fail-safe even in the event of a break in the
cable. In addition, the sensor cable can be used in
explosive atmospheres (ATEX zones) up to zone 0 without
any additional measures being required. In contrast to
conventional fibre optic systems, the low laser output of <
20mW ensures that the measuring system has a long
service life.
Zone Configuration
Ambient conditions (temperatures) can fluctuate sharply
over a measuring range of many hundreds of metres. This
makes it essential to divide the measuring range into zones
that can be adapted optimally to the ambient conditions on
the basis of differing alarm criteria. This ensures high
detection reliability and also security against false alarms.
The MZX SensorLaser™ Plus allows the measuring range to
be very finely divided into zones. Up to 256 zones can be
defined for each sensor cable, with up to 5 alarm criteria
configurable in each zone. Another 2 alarm criteria respond
when there is a temperature drop, enabling them to be used
e.g. in tunnels to warn of black ice.
Chapter 10 Page 24
Fire Catalogue
09/10
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 25
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Fibre Optic Linear Heat Detection System Con’t.
Control Unit
With ten product variants, permitting measuring ranges of 1
to 8 km, the MZX SensorLaser™ Plus can be configured to
suit the particular project.
Sensor Cable
The sensor cables offered are optimised for a rapid
response time. The sheathing is flame retardant, halogen
free and resistant to dust, dirt, moisture, corrosive
atmospheres and most organic solvents. Both types of
sensor cable offer adequate protection against rodents and
are designed for a service life of 30 years.
There are two different types of sensor cable for differing
project requirements. The MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Safety
cable can be used under normal ambient conditions. It is
particularly flexible and extremely versatile.
Where the sensor cable is expected to be exposed to high
mechanical stresses, we recommend that the MZX
SensorLaser™ Plus Steel Wire Armoured cable be used.
This sensor cable, which was specifically developed for
heavy duty applications, is particularly suitable where high
tensile forces and high lateral pressures can occur.
The cable length will be individually cut to the customer
specified length and 2 connectors are fitted for easy
handling. The cable should be commissioned in multiples
of one metre and therefore the order for the cable has to be
placed per metre.
Every order for sensor cable must include the
corresponding connectors, which will be assembled by the
supplier. The cable with pre assembled connectors offers
fast commissioning of the system without any additional
splicing.
Plastic Clamps
The plastic of these clamps is UV resistant, halogen free
and particularly robust in ambient conditions.
Steel Clamps
The clamps in these sets are made of stainless steel or zinc
plated steel and are rubber protected. The rubber
protection guarantees that the sensor cable is not damaged
if friction occurs. For every clamp 2 x nuts are included for
fixing to the anchor.
Connection Cable
Connection to the MZX Fire Alarm Panel is by means of the
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Connection Set. This set consists
of 3 x cables. For connection of the Fire Alarm Panel to one
end of the sensor cable a D-Sub connector is included. The
other end of the sensor cable is desoldered which provides
a quick connection into the MZX System without any
soldering effort.
Enhanced Communication
The MZX SensorLaser™ Plus iBox allows the 20 relay
outputs supplied as standard to be expanded up to 2 x 256
outputs so that each zone can be assigned its own relay
output. This could, for instance, be used to control fire
extinguishing systems. The iBox also enables connection to
SCADA or process control systems via Modbus TCP or
Modbus RTU.
The number of relays can be extended using the MZX
SensorLaser™ Plus Relay Controller Set. This set consists
of a pre-programmed field bus controller, one Digital Output
Module and an End module. It also comes with 8 x relays
and accessories for easy wiring.
Mounting Materials
For professional mounting of the sensor cables four
different types of mounting sets are available. These sets
are designed for different applications. They can be used
for the mounting of the sensor cable to the wall and the
ceiling. Every set contains 100 x clamps, 100 x anchors and
1 x SDS drill bit.
LAN (10/100M)
Modbus / TCP/IP
SCPI/FTP
Modbus/TCP/IP/SCPI/FPT SCPI
SCADA
System
Controller Unit
Supervisory Control
and Data Acquisition
Interface Box
PC Work Station
20 Relay Outputs
1 Fault
19 Alarms
MZX Panel
Relay Controller
Set
Relay Extension
Set
By means of the Relay Controller Set and the Relay Extension Set an
additional 256 relays per sensor cable can be connected.
09/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 10 Page 25
FIRE_Ch10_Special_Hazards:Layout 1 02/09/2010 10:15 Page 26
Chapter 10 - Special Hazards
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Fibre Optic Linear Heat Detection System Con’t.
Complies with the essential requirements of the following
applicable European Directives and carries the CE marking
accordingly:
• The Low Voltage Directive 73/23/EEC amended by
93/68/EEC
• The EMC Directive 2004/108/EC
Conforms with the following product standards:
EMC
IEC61326:1997+A1:1998+A2:2000
EN61326:1997+A1:1998+A2:2001
CISPR11:1997+A1:1999 / EN55011:1998+A1:1999
IEC61000-4-2:2001/EN61000-4-2:1995+A1:1998+A2:2001
IEC61000-4-3:2002/EN61000-4-3:2002
IEC61000-4-4:2001/EN61000-4-4:1995+A1:2001+A2:2001
IEC61000-4-5:2001/EN61000-4-5:1995+A1:2001
IEC61000-4-6:1995+A1:2000 /EN61000-4-6:1996+A1:2001
IEC61000-4-8:2001/EN61000-4-8:1993+A1:2001
IEC61000-4-11:1994+A1:2000
EN61000-4-11:1994+A1:2001
Canada: ICES-001:1998
SAFETY
IEC61010-1:2001/EN61010-1:2001
IEC60825-1:2001/EN60825-1:1994+A11:1996+A2:2001
Canada:CAN/CSA-C22.2No.61010-1:2004
USA:UL61010-1:2004;FDA21CFR1040.10+Laser Notice
No.50
Product Codes
516.016.310
Technical Specification
Operating temperature range:
-10°C to +60°C (2 channel
options: from -5°C)
Storage temperature range:
-40°C to +80°C
Operating humidity range:
0% to 95% RH (2 channel options:
15% to 85% RH) non condensing
Dimensions (H x W x D):
88 x 448 x 364 mm (19” rack)
Weight:
9 kg
Fibre types:
MM 50/125 μm graded index MM
62.5/125 μm graded index
Dynamic range:
30 dB (2-way loss)
Sensing temperature range:
-273°C to +700°C depending on
sensor coating
Optical connector:
E2000; 8° angled
Number of channels:
1, 2 depending on channel option
Computer interface:
USB, LAN
Relay board:
4 inputs / 20 outputs
Power supply:
10 V to 30 Vdc
Power consumption:
15 W typically, at 20°C ambient
temperature < 40 W (entire
operating conditions)
Measurement times:
from 10s to 30s
Available spatial resolution settings:
1 m; 1.5 m; 3 m; 5 m; 8 m
Available measurement modes:
Single ended/Dual ended;
including fibre break recovery
Internal data storage capability:
150 traces total
Power Supply (option) operating conditions:
0°C to +50°C; non condensing;
indoor use only
Laser class (IEC 60825-1: 2001):1M
516.016.311
516.016.312
516.016.313
516.016.333
516.016.334
516.016.314
516.016.315
516.016.316
516.016.317
516.016.318
516.016.319
516.016.320
516.016.321
516.016.322
516.016.322.C
516.016.323
516.016.323.C
516.016.324
516.016.325
516.016.326
516.016.327
516.016.328
516.016.329
516.016.330
516.016.331
516.016.332
Chapter 10 Page 26
Fire Catalogue
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus 1/1 – 1 km
range, 1 sensor cable.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus 1/2 – 1 km
range, 2 sensor cables.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus 2/1 – 2 km
range, 1 sensor cable.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus 2/2 – 2 km
range, 2 sensor cables.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus 3/1 – 3 km
range, 1 sensor cable.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus 3/2 – 3 km
range, 2 sensor cables.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus 4/1 – 4 km
range, 1 sensor cable.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus 4/2 – 4 km
range, 2 sensor cables.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus 8/1 – 8 km
range, 1 sensor cable.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus 8/2 – 8 km
range, 2 sensor cables.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Connection Set.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus iBox
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Relay Controller
Set.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Power Supply.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Safety Cable
(per metre).
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Safety
Connector.
MZX Steel Wire Armoured SensorLaser™
Plus Cable (per metre).
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Steel Connector.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Setting Tool.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Relay Extension
Set.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Zinc Plastic
Clamp Set.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Steel Plastic
Clamp Set.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Steel Zinc Clamp
Set.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Stainless Steel
Clamp Set.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Spare Unit.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Demo Unit.
MZX SensorLaser™ Plus Demo Box.
09/10
FIRE_Ch11_Useful_Information:Layout 1 14/07/2010 10:32 Page 1
Chapter 11 - Useful Information
MX Addressable Detector , Mode Selection & Design Charts
1. First select the environment
2. Then select the fire loading or risk being protected
Table 1- 801PC Detector
These charts are designed to assist with the selection of
the best detector for the risk.
07/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 11 Page 1
FIRE_Ch11_Useful_Information:Layout 1 14/07/2010 10:32 Page 2
Table 2 - 800 Series Detectors
Chapter 11 - Useful Information
Chapter 11 Page 2
Fire Catalogue
07/10
FIRE_Ch11_Useful_Information:Layout 1 14/07/2010 10:32 Page 3
Chapter 11 - Useful Information
Table 3 - Series 600 Detectors
Conventional Detector Selection & Design Charts
07/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 11 Page 3
Chapter 11 Page 4
912SB UNIVERSAL UL SOUNDER BASE
602SB 2 WIRE LINE POWERED SOUNDER BASE
602SBD 2 WIRE LINE POWERED DIODE SOUNDER BASE
802SB MX LOW POWERED SOUNDER BASE
812SB LOOP POWERED UL SOUNDER BASE
516.800.911
516.800.912
577.001.036
577.001.038
516.800.910
516.800.913
Fire Catalogue
602SB 2 WIRE LINE POWERED SOUNDER BASE
602SBD 2 WIRE LINE POWERED DIODE SOUNDER BASE
802SB MX LOW POWERED SOUNDER BASE
812SB LOOP POWERED UL SOUNDER BASE
516.800.912
577.001.036
577.001.038
516.800.910
516.800.913
1.2mA
1.2mA
1.2mA
1.2mA
6.8mA
6.8mA
6.8mA
6.8mA
6.8mA
6.8mA
601SB CONVENTIONAL SOUNDER BASE
601SBD CONVENTIONAL DIODE SOUNDER BASE
901SB UNIVERSAL SOUNDER BASE
912SB UNIVERSAL UL SOUNDER BASE
602SB 2 WIRE LINE POWERED SOUNDER BASE
602SBD 2 WIRE LINE POWERED DIODE SOUNDER BASE
802SB MX LOW POWERED SOUNDER BASE
812SB LOOP POWERED UL SOUNDER BASE
577.001.035
577.001.037
516.800.911
516.800.912
577.001.036
577.001.038
516.800.910
516.800.913
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
,
YES
YES
YES
YES
912SB UNIVERSAL UL SOUNDER BASE
516.800.911
1.2mA
1.2mA
YES
YES
NO
NO
YES
YES
NO
NO
CURRENT CONSUMPTION AT
90 dBA (MAXIMUM VOLUME)
LOOP
LOOP
DETECTION CIRCUIT
DETECTION CIRCUIT
24Vdc
24Vdc
24Vdc
24Vdc
WHITE
WHITE
YELLOW
YELLOW
BLUE
BLUE
GREEN
GREEN
PARK CLIP
COLOUR
YES
YES
MARCH TIME BEEP(26)
21mA
21mA
CURRENT CONSUMPTION AT
100dBA (FIXED VOLUME)
DETECTOR REQUIRED
TO OPERATE
DUTCH SLOW TEMPORAL 4 SLOW SWEEP (3) MARCH TIME BEEP(25)
SWEEP (7)
901SB UNIVERSAL SOUNDER BASE
577.001.037
CURRENT CONSUMPTION AT
68 dBA (MINIMUM VOLUME)
MX ONLY
MX ONLY
MZX-c ONLY
MZX-c ONLY
MINERVA ADDRESSABLE/MX
MINERVA ADDRESSABLE/MX
CONVENTIONAL ONLY
POWERED FROM
PART NO. DESCRIPTION
601SB CONVENTIONAL SOUNDER BASE
601SBD CONVENTIONAL DIODE SOUNDER BASE
577.001.035
PART NO. DESCRIPTION
901SB UNIVERSAL SOUNDER BASE
577.001.037
CONVENTIONAL ONLY
601SB CONVENTIONAL SOUNDER BASE
601SBD CONVENTIONAL DIODE SOUNDER BASE
577.001.035
CONTROL PANEL COMPATIBILITY
PART NO. DESCRIPTION
.
FIRE_Ch11_Useful_Information:Layout 1 14/07/2010 10:32 Page 4
Chapter 11 - Useful Information
MKII Sounder Base Application Table
07/10
07/10
912SB UNIVERSAL UL SOUNDER BASE
602SB 2 WIRE LINE POWERED SOUNDER BASE
602SBD 2 WIRE LINE POWERED DIODE SOUNDER BASE
802SB MX LOW POWERED SOUNDER BASE
812SB LOOP POWERED UL SOUNDER BASE
516.800.911
516.800.912
577.001.036
577.001.038
516.800.910
516.800.913
(2) (3) (7) (9) (11) (14) (25) (26) = ROSHNI TONE NUMBER
901SB UNIVERSAL SOUNDER BASE
577.001.037
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
601SB CONVENTIONAL SOUNDER BASE
601SBD CONVENTIONAL DIODE SOUNDER BASE
577.001.035
FAST
SWEEP (2)
PART NO. DESCRIPTION
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
YES
TEMPORAL 3 ALTERNATING 2(11) ALTERNATING 2 (9) CONTINUOUS(14)
YES
YES
CONTINUOUS
FIRE_Ch11_Useful_Information:Layout 1 14/07/2010 10:32 Page 5
Chapter 11 - Useful Information
MKII Sounder Base Application Table
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 11 Page 5
FIRE_Ch11_Useful_Information:Layout 1 14/07/2010 10:32 Page 6
Chapter 11 - Useful Information
Sounder Tone Tables
Tone Information
No.
Banshee 12V
2nd Tone
dBa (Typ)
mA(Typ)
Banshee 24V
Description
Frequency and Timing
dBA(Typ) mA(Typ)
12345
1
Banshee LF Buzz
800Hz ato 950Hz swept at 120Hz*
4
94
6
100
12
00000
2
Banshee LF Fast Sweep
800Hz to 950 swept at 9Hz*
4
94
6
100
12
10000
3
Banshee LF Slow Sweep
800Hz to 950Hz swept at 3Hz*
4
94
6
100
12
01000
4
Banshee LF Continuous
Continuous at 850Hz*
4
95
6
101
12
11000
5
Banshee LF Fast Sweep (New)
830Hz to 970Hz swept at 9Hz*
4
95
6
101
12
00100
6
Medium Sweep LF
800Hz to 970Hz swept at 1 Hx*
7
95
6
102
12
10100
7
Continuous LF
Continuous at 970Hz*
7
97
6
103
12
01100
8
Backup Alarm LF
Intermittent at 950Hz 1s on, 1s off*
4
97
4
103
7
11100
9
Alternate LF
Alternating 800Hz/1000Hz,0.5s each sound*
4
94
8
101
14
00010
10
Medium Sweep LF
800Hz/1000Hz swept at 0.5s*
4
95
5
101
12
10010
11
Alternate LF
Alternating tones 800/950Hz*
4
96
6
103
14
01010
12
Banshee/Bedlam HF buzz
2400Hz to 2900Hz at 120Hz
15
102
12
110
25
11010
13
Banshee/Bedlam HF Fast Sweep
2400Hz to 2900Hz at 9Hz
15
103
12
110
25
00110
14 Banshee/Bedlam HF Slow Sweep
2400Hz to 2900Hz at 3Hz
15
103
12
110
25
10110
15
Banshee/Bedlam HF Continuous
16 Banshee/Bedlam HF Fast Sweep (New)
Continuous at 2900Hz at 3Hz
15
105
12
112
30
01110
2450Hz to 3100Hz swept at 9Hz
15
103
12
110
25
11110
00001
17
Back up Alarm LF
Intermittent at 2900Hz 1s on 1s off
15
105
7
112
15
18
Alternate LF
Alternating tones 2400/2900Hz at 3Hz
15
104
12
110
25
10001
19
Slow Whoop
500Hz rising to 1200Hz over 3.5, silence 0.5s, repeat
4
96
6
101
12
01001
20
Din Tone (DK)
1200Hz falling to 500Hz over 1s, silence 10ms, repeat
4
93
6
101
14
11001
21
French Fire Sound
554Hz for 100ms and 440Hz for 400ms
4
90
5
96
10
00101
22
Australian Alert SIgnal
420Hz repeating 0.625s on, 0.625s off
4
88
3
94
6
10101
23
Australian Evacuation Signal
4
96
6
103
12
01101
24
US Temporal Tone LF
4
96
3
103
6
11101
25
US Temporal Tone HF
26
Swedish Tone (Fire)
27
28
500Hz rising to 1200Hz over 3.75s on, 0.25s off
950Hz for 0.5s on 0.5s off, for 3 phases, silence for 1.5s & repeat
2900Hz for 0.5s on 0.5s off, for 3 phases, silence for 1.5s & repeat
15
105
6
112
12
00011
Intermittent 660Hz 150ms on, 150ms off
26
81
4
87
7
10011
Swedish Tone (all Clear)
Continuous 660Hz
27
84
5
89
14
01011
ISO8201LF
Intermittent 970Hz 500ms on, 550ms off*
28
96
4
103
7
11011
00111
29
ISO8201HF
Intermittent 2900Hz 500ms on, 500ms off
29
106
8
112
15
30
BT Banshee (FP1063.1)
Yodel 800Hz/1000Hz, 0.25s each frequency*
31
93
8
101
14
10111
31
BT Banshee (FP1063.1)
Continuous 1000Hz*
31
95
8
102
17
01111
32
Bell Tone
Bell Tone*
32
96
8
101
17
11111
*Tone meets frequency requirements of BS5839 Pt. 1 1988
Chapter 11 Page 6
Fire Catalogue
07/10
FIRE_Ch11_Useful_Information:Layout 1 14/07/2010 10:32 Page 7
Chapter 11 - Useful Information
Fulleon Sounder Tone Compatibility Table
Fulleon Tone
Tone Number
CONTINUOUS TONE (970HZ)
14
2 Wire Symphoni
24V Symphoni
Sounder Base
601SB/601SBD
602SB/602SBD
SWITCH A B
SWITCH 1 2 3 4 5
SWITCH 1 2 3 4
10
10010
111X
(880Hz)
PULSED/INTERMITTENT TONE (970HZ@ 1HZ)
25
11
00111
011X
(880Hz@1Hz)EURO ONLY
ALTERNATING TONE (970HZ/800HZ@2HZ)
1
01
(CLOSEST MATCH)
(990HZ/650HZ@2HZ)
11111
N/A
DUTCH SLOW WHOOP
(500Hz-1200Hz-3s on/0.5s off)
7
N/A
11001
000X
SLOW SWEEP (800Hz/970Hz@1Hz)
3
N/A
11101
010X
FAST SWEEP (800Hz/970HZ@7HZ)
2
N/A
11110
100X
TWO TONE/ALTERNATING (800HZ/970HZ@1HZ)
11
N/A
10101
110X
(660Hz/880Hz@1Hz)EURO ONLY
Fulleon Sounder Tone Table
No.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
07/10
TONE
ALT TONES 800/970 at 1/4 Hz
SWEEPING 800/970Hz at 7Hz
SWEEPING 800/970Hz at 1Hz
CONTINUOUS at 2850Hz
SWEEPING 2400-2850Hz at 7Hz
SWEEPING 2400-2850Hz at 1Hz
SLOW WHOOP
SWEEP 1200-500 at 1Hz
ALT TONES 2400/2850 2Hz
INT TONE OF 970Hz at 1Hz
ALT TONES 800/970 Hz at 1Hz
INT TONE at 2850 Hz at 1Hz
970Hz at 1/4 SEC. ON 1 SEC. OFF
CONTINUOUS AT 970Hz
554 FOR 100ms and 440Hz FOR 400ms
INT 660Hz 150ms ON/150ms OFF
INT 660Hz 1.8s ON/1.8s OFF
INT 660Hz 6.5s ON/13s OFF
CONTINUOUS 660Hz
ALT 554/440Hz at 1Hz
INT 660Hz 1Hz
INT 2850Hz 150ms ON 100ms OFF
SWEEP 800-970Hz at 50Hz
SWEEP 2400-2850Z at 50 Hz
INTERMITTENT 970Hz 500ms ON 500ms OFF
INTERMITTENT 2850HZ 500ms ON 500ms OFF
CONTINUOUS AT 4kHz
ALTERNATING TONES 800/970 AT 2Hz
ALTERNATING TONES 988/645 AT 2Hz
ALTERNATING 510/610 at 1Hz
SWEEPING 300-1200 at 1Hz
CONTINUOUS AT 4kHz
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 11 Page 7
FIRE_Ch11_Useful_Information:Layout 1 14/07/2010 10:32 Page 8
Chapter 11 - Useful Information
Features
• Selecting the category of protection and coverage.
• How to configure detector zones and alarm zones within
premises.
• Which type of fire detection system?
• Detector suitability.
• Detector coverage.
• Manual break glass call points.
• Limitation of false alarms.
• Means of giving warning to occupants.
• Control and indicating equipment.
• Power supplies.
• Cabling considerations.
• Communication with the fire service.
• System installation.
• Documentation.
• Standards and Specifications.
• Associated Ancillary Equipment.
• Networking and Graphics.
• Installation.
• Commissioning.
• Training.
• Maintenance.
Consultants Guide
A Fire Detection System Consultants Guide for consultants
designing systems to BS5839-1:2002.
Product Code
CGUK-01
Chapter 11 Page 8
Fire Catalogue
Consultants Guide
07/10
FIRE_Ch11_Useful_Information:Layout 1 14/07/2010 10:32 Page 9
Notes
07/10
Fire Catalogue
Chapter 11 Page 9
Fire_Cat_Iss7_Covers:Layout 1 07/09/2010 10:05 Page 2
European Distribution Centre - Echt, Holland
(Warehousing / Distribution / Purchasing /
Customer Service / Call Centre Helpdesk)
Voltaweg 20
6101 XK
Echt
Holland
Tel: +31 475 371 666
Fax: +31 475 371 660
E-mail: tfseu.service@tycoint.com
European TSP Technical Support Call Centre
Toll Free: 0800 CALL TYCO or
(0800 22 55 89 26)
9:00 AM to 5:00 PM EET, CET & GMT
UK Only: 08701 238 787
UK Distribution Centre
(Warehousing / Distribution / Purchasing)
Dunhams Lane
Letchworth
Hertfordshire
SG6 1BE
United Kingdom
Tel: +44 (0) 1462 667 700
Fax: +44 (0) 1462 667 777
E-mail: tfsuk.service@tycoint.com
www.tycoemea.com
© 2010 Tyco International PMC001 Issue 7.7 / 09.10
The right is reserved to modify or withdraw any product or service without notice
a vital part of your world
Was this manual useful for you? yes no
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the work of artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Download PDF

advertising